Contents

BMW 335i Sedan 3 Series 2011 Owner's Manual PDF

1 of 278
1 of 278

Summary of Content for BMW 335i Sedan 3 Series 2011 Owner's Manual PDF

The Ultimate Driving Machine

Owner's Manual for Vehicle

328i 328i xDrive

335i 335i xDrive

335is M3

Owner's Manual for Vehicle Congratulations, and thank you for choosing a BMW.

Thorough familiarity with your vehicle will provide you with enhanced control and security when you drive it. We therefore have this request:

Please take the time to read this Owner's Manual and familiarize yourself with the information that we have compiled for you before starting off in your new vehicle. It contains important data and instructions intended to assist you in gaining maximum use and satisfaction from your BMW's unique range of technical features. The manual also contains information on maintenance designed to enhance operating safety and contribute to maintaining the value of your BMW throughout an extended service life.

This manual is supplemented by a Service and Warranty Informa- tion Booklet for US models or a Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models.

We wish you an enjoyable driving experience.

BMW Group

2010 Bayerische Motoren Werke Aktiengesellschaft Munich, Germany Reprinting, including excerpts, only with the written consent of BMW AG, Munich. US English II/10, 03 10 500 Printed on environmentally friendly paper, bleached without chlorine, suitable for recycling.

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Contents

The quickest way to find special topics is to consult the index, refer to page 258.

Using this Owner's Manual 4 Notes 7 Reporting safety defects

At a glance 10 Cockpit 16 iDrive 21 Letters and numbers 22 Voice activation system

Controls 26 Opening and closing 42 Adjustments 52 Transporting children safely 55 Driving 75 Controls overview 88 Technology for driving comfort and

safety 101 Lamps 106 Climate 111 Practical interior accessories

Driving tips 126 Things to remember when driving

Navigation 134 Navigation system 135 Destination entry 144 Destination guidance 151 What to do if

Entertainment 154 On/off and tone 157 Radio 160 Satellite radio 165 CD/DVD player and CD changer 172 Music collection 177 External devices

Communications 184 Telephone 196 Contacts 198 BMW Assist

Mobility 206 Refueling 208 Wheels and tires 222 Under the hood 227 Maintenance 229 Care 233 Replacing components 238 Giving and receiving assistance

Reference 246 Technical data 251 Short commands for the voice activation

system 258 Everything from A to Z

N o

te s

4

Notes

Using this Owner's Manual We have tried to make all the information in this Owner's Manual easy to find. The fastest way to find specific topics is to refer to the detailed index at the back of the manual. If you wish to gain an initial overview of your vehicle, you will find this in the first chapter.

Should you sell your BMW some day, please remember to hand over the Owner's Manual as well; it is an important component of your vehi- cle.

Additional sources of information Should you have any other questions, your BMW center will be glad to advise you at any time.

Information on BMW, e.g. on technical aspects, can also be found on the Internet at www.bmwusa.com.

Symbols used Indicates precautions that must be fol- lowed precisely in order to avoid the pos-

sibility of personal injury and serious damage to the vehicle.<

Indicates information that will assist you in gaining the optimum benefit from your

vehicle and enable you to care more effectively for your vehicle.<

Refers to measures that can be taken to help protect the environment.<

< Marks the end of a specific item of informa- tion.

* Indicates special equipment, country-spe- cific equipment and optional accessories, as well as equipment and functions not yet available at the time of printing.

"..." Identifies Control Display texts used to select individual functions.

{...} Verbal instructions to use with the voice activation system.

{{...}} Identifies the answers generated by the voice activation system.

Symbols on vehicle components Indicates that you should consult the rel- evant section of this Owner's Manual for

information on a particular part or assembly.

5

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

The individual vehicle When you ordered your BMW, you chose vari- ous items of equipment. This Owner's Manual describes the entire array of options and equip- ment available with a specific BMW model.

Please bear in mind that the manual may con- tain information on accessories and equipment that you have not specified for your own vehicle. Sections describing options and special equip- ment are marked by asterisks* to assist you in identifying possible differences between the descriptions in this manual and your own vehi- cle's equipment.

If equipment in your BMW is not described in this Owner's Manual, please refer to the accom- panying Supplementary Owner's Manuals.

Editorial notice BMW pursues a policy of continuous, ongoing development that is conceived to ensure that our vehicles continue to embody the highest quality and safety standards combined with advanced, state-of-the-art technology. For this reason, it is possible in exceptional cases that features described in this Owner's Manual could differ from those on your vehicle.

For your own safety

Maintenance and repair Advanced technology, e.g. the use of modern materials and powerful electron-

ics, requires specially adapted maintenance and repair methods. You should therefore have the corresponding work on your vehicle per- formed only by your BMW center or at a work- shop that works according to BMW repair pro- cedures with correspondingly trained personnel. If this work is not carried out prop- erly, there is a danger of subsequent damage and related safety hazards.<

Parts and accessories For your own safety, use genuine parts and accessories approved by BMW.

When you purchase accessories tested and approved by BMW and Original BMW Parts, you simultaneously acquire the assurance that they have been thoroughly tested by BMW to ensure optimum performance when installed on your vehicle.

BMW warrants these parts to be free from defects in material and workmanship.

BMW will not accept any liability for damage resulting from installation of parts and accesso- ries not approved by BMW.

BMW cannot test every product made by other manufacturers to verify if it can be used on a BMW safely and without risk to either the vehi- cle, its operation, or its occupants.

Original BMW Parts, BMW Accessories and other products approved by BMW, together with professional advice on using these items, are available from all BMW centers.

Installation and operation of accessories not approved by BMW, such as alarms, radios, amplifiers, radar detectors, wheels, suspension components, brake dust shields, telephones, including operation of any mobile phone from within the vehicle without using an externally mounted antenna, or transceiver equipment, for instance, CBs, walkie-talkies, ham radio or sim- ilar accessories, may cause extensive damage to the vehicle, compromise its safety, interfere with the vehicle's electrical system or affect the validity of the BMW Limited Warranty. See your BMW center for additional information.<

Maintenance, replacement, or repair of the emission control devices and sys-

tems may be performed by any automotive repair establishment or individual using any certified automotive part.<

N o

te s

6

California Proposition 65 warning California law requires us to issue the following warning:

Engine exhaust and a wide variety of automobile components and parts,

including components found in the interior fur- nishings in a vehicle, contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects and reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm.

Battery posts, terminals and related accesso- ries contain lead and lead compounds. Wash your hands after handling.

Used engine oil contains chemicals that have caused cancer in laboratory animals. Always protect your skin by washing thoroughly with soap and water.<

Service and warranty We recommend that you read this publication thoroughly.

Your BMW is covered by the following warran- ties:

> New Vehicle Limited Warranty

> Rust Perforation Limited Warranty

> Federal Emissions System Defect Warranty

> Federal Emissions Performance Warranty

> California Emission Control System Limited Warranty

Detailed information about these warranties is listed in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models or in the Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models.

Your vehicle has been specifically adapted and designed to meet the particular operating con- ditions and homologation requirements in your country and continental region in order to deliver the full driving pleasure while the vehicle is operated under those conditions. If you wish to operate your vehicle in another country or region, you may be required to adapt your vehi- cle to meet different prevailing operating condi- tions and homologation requirements. You should also be aware of any applicable warranty limitations or exclusions for such country or region. In such case, please contact Customer Relations for further information.

7

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Reporting safety defects

For US customers The following only applies to vehicles owned and operated in the US.

If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration, NHTSA, in addition to notifying BMW of North America, LLC, P.O. Box 1227, Westwood, New Jersey 07675-1227, Telephone 1-800-831-1117.

If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your center, or BMW of North America, LLC.

To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Adminis- trator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov

For Canadian customers Canadian customers who wish to report a safety-related defect to Transport Canada, Defect Investigations and Recalls, may call 1- 800-333-0510 toll-free from anywhere in Can- ada or 1-613-993-9851 from the Ottawa region and from other countries, or contact Transport Canada by mail at: Transport Canada, ASFAD, Place de Ville, Tower C, 330 Sparks Street, Ottawa, ON, K1A 0N5.

You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.tc.gc.ca

At a glance This overview of buttons, switches and displays is intended to familiarize you with your vehicle's

operating environment. The section will also assist you in becoming acquainted with the

control concepts and options available for operating the various systems.

C o

ck p

it

10

Cockpit

Around the steering wheel: controls and displays

4 Folding exterior mirrors in and out* 50

5 Adjusting exterior mirrors, automatic curb monitor* 50

1 Convertible: opening and closing windows jointly 35

2 Convertible: opening and closing rear windows 35

3 Opening and closing front windows 35

6 Parking lamps 101

Low beams 101

Automatic headlamp control* 101 Adaptive light control* 102 High-beam assistant* 103

7 Fog lamps* 104

A t

a g

la n

ce

11

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

9 Instrument cluster 12

12 Ignition lock 55

13 Buttons on the steering wheel

15 Horn, entire surface

16 Adjusting the steering wheel 51

18 Releasing the hood 222

19 Opening the trunk lid 31

8 Turn signals 64

High beams, headlamp flasher 103

High-beam assistant* 103

Roadside parking lamps* 103

Computer 76

Settings and information about the vehicle 79

10 Windshield wipers 65

Rain sensor* 65

11 Switching the ignition on/off and starting/stopping the engine 55

Telephone*:

Accepting and ending a call; dial- ing* the selected phone number; redialing if no phone number is selected

Volume

Activating/deactivating voice activation system* 22

Changing the radio station Interrupting a traffic bulletin Selecting a music track Scrolling through the redial list

Next entertainment source

Recirculated-air mode 108

14 Steering wheel heating* 51

17 Cruise control* 66

Active cruise control* 68

C o

ck p

it

12

Instrument cluster

1 Speedometer

2 Indicator lamps for turn signals

3 Indicator and warning lamps 13

4 Displays for active cruise control* 68

5 Tachometer 75

6 Engine oil temperature 76

7 Display for

> Clock 75

> Outside temperature 75

> Indicator and warning lamps 84

8 Display for

> Position of automatic transmission* 58

> Gear indicator in 7-gear Sports automatic transmission with double clutch* 60

> Computer 76

> Date of next scheduled service, and remaining distance to be driven 80

> Odometer and trip odometer 75

> High-beam assistant* 103

> Checking engine oil level* 223

> Settings and information 79

> There is a Check Control message 84

9 Fuel gauge 76

10 Resetting the trip odometer 75

A t

a g

la n

ce

13

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Indicator and warning lamps

The concept

Indicator and warning lamps can light up in a variety of combinations and colors.

Several of the lamps are checked for proper functioning and light up temporarily when the engine is started or the ignition is switched on.

Text messages

Text messages at the top edge of the Control Display describe the meanings of the indicator and warning lamps.

Supplementary text messages

You can call up more information on the Control Display, e.g. on the cause of a malfunction and on how to respond, via Check Control, refer to page 84.

In urgent cases, this information will be shown as soon as the corresponding lamp comes on.

Indicator lamps without text messages The following indicator lamps notify you that certain functions are active:

High beams/headlamp flasher 103

Fog lamps* 104

Lamp flashes: DSC or DTC is regulating the propul- sive forces in order to maintain driving stability 90

parking brake applied 57

Canada: parking brake applied 57

engine malfunction with adverse effect on emissions 228

Canada: engine malfunction with adverse effect on emissions 228

C o

ck p

it

14

Around the center console: controls and displays

A t

a g

la n

ce

15

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

1 Coupe: microphone for voice activation system* and for telephone* in hands-free mode Convertible: microphone on steering col- umn

2 SOS: initiating an Emergency Request call* 238

3 Reading lamps 105

4 Coupe: glass roof, electric* 37

5 Interior lamps 105

6 Passenger airbag status lamp* 99

7 Control Display 16

8 Hazard warning flashers

9 Dynamic Traction Control DTC 90

10 Central locking system 30

11 Automatic climate control

12 CD/DVD drive* 165

13 Changing the audio and entertainment sources

14 Selecting AM or FM waveband

15 Changing

> Radio station 157

> Track 165

17 Controller 16 Can be turned, pressed, or moved in four directions

18 Buttons on the controller 16 Selecting menus directly

20 Programmable memory keys 20

21 Switching entertainment audio sources on/ off and adjusting volume 154

22 Ejecting a CD/DVD* 165

Air distribution to the windshield 107

Air distribution to the upper body area 107

Air distribution to the footwell 107

Automatic air distribution and flow rate 107

Cooling function 108

Automatic recirculated-air control AUC and recirculated-air mode 108

Maximum cooling 107

ALL program 108

Air volume 108

Defrosting windows 108

Rear window defroster 108

Heated seats* 47

16 Park Distance Control PDC* 88

Coupe: Roller sun blind* 114

Coupe: Hill Descent Control HDC* 90

19 Convertible: Opening and closing retractable hardtop 38

iD ri

ve

16

iDrive

iDrive integrates the functions of a large num- ber of switches. This allows these functions to be operated from a single central position. The following section provides an introduction to

basic menu navigation. The control of the indi- vidual functions is described in connection with the relevant equipment.

Controls

1 Control Display

2 Controller with buttons You can use the buttons to open the menus directly. The controller can be used to select the menu items and create settings.

> Move in four directions, arrow 3

> Turn, arrow 4

> Push, arrow 5

Operate the controller only when traffic and road conditions allow this, to avoid

endangering the car's occupants and other road users by being distracted.<

A t

a g

la n

ce

17

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Buttons on the controller

Operating principle With the ignition at radio readiness or beyond, refer to page 55, the following message is dis- played on the Control Display:

To hide the message: Press the controller. The main menu is displayed.

The message is automatically hidden after approx. 10 seconds.

Opening the main menu Press the MENU button. The main menu is displayed.

All iDrive functions can be called up via the main menu.

Selecting a menu item The menu items shown in white can be selected.

1. Turn the controller until the desired menu item is highlighted.

2. Press the controller.

A new menu is displayed or the function is exe- cuted.

Menu items in the Owner's Manual In the Owner's Manual, menu items that can be selected are set in quotation marks, e.g. "Settings".

Changing between panels After selecting a menu item, e.g. "Radio", a new menu is displayed on a panel. The panels can overlap.

Button Function

MENU Open the main menu

RADIO Open the Radio menu

CD Open the CD/Multimedia menu

NAV Open the Navigation menu

TEL Open the Telephone menu

BACK Display the previous menu

OPTION Open the Options menu

iD ri

ve

18

Move the controller to the left or right to change between the panels.

White arrows pointing to the left or right indi- cate that additional panels can be opened.

Open the Options menu Press the OPTION button. The "Options" menu is displayed.

Another possibility: move the controller to the right repeatedly until the "Options" menu appears.

The "Options" menu contains the following:

> Screen settings, refer to page 19.

> Control options for the selected menu.

Adjusting settings 1. Select a field.

2. Turn the controller until the desired setting is displayed.

3. Press the controller to confirm the setting.

The scroll bar on the right side indicates whether additional menu items or set-

tings can be selected that are currently not vis- ible.<

Example: setting the clock 1. Press the MENU button.

The main menu is displayed.

2. Turn the controller until "Settings" is high- lighted, and then press the controller.

3. Turn the controller until "Time/Date" is highlighted, and then press the controller.

A t

a g

la n

ce

19

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

4. Turn the controller until "Time:" is high- lighted, and then press the controller.

5. Turn the controller to set the hours and press the controller.

6. Turn the controller to set the minutes and press the controller.

Status information

1 Time

2 Display for:

> Reception strength of the wireless network, depends on the mobile phone

> Incoming, outgoing or missed call

> SMS* received

3 Display for:

> Entertainment: Radio, CD/DVD, external devices

> Telephone*: Name of the mobile phone paired with the vehicle

4 Sound output is switched off or display for traffic bulletins*:

> "TI": Traffic bulletins are switched on.

> No display: Traffic bulletins are switched off.

Other displays: Status information is temporarily hidden during Check Control message displays or entries via the voice activation system*.

Switching the Control Display off/on 1. Press the OPTION button.

2. "Switch off control display"

Press the controller to switch on.

Professional navigation system: split screen Additional information, e.g. from the computer, can be displayed on the right side of the split screen.

On the split screen, this information remains visible even when you change to another menu.

Switching the split screen on and off 1. Press the OPTION button.

2. "Split screen"

The split screen is activated.

iD ri

ve

20

Selecting the display for the split screen content When the split screen is switched on, you can select the content displayed on the screen.

1. Move the controller to the right repeatedly until the split screen content is selected.

2. Select the display.

Programmable memory keys Certain iDrive functions can be stored on the programmable memory keys and called up directly, e.g. radio stations, navigation destina- tions, phone numbers and entry points into the menu.

Storing functions 1. Highlight the function via the iDrive.

2. ... Press the desired key for longer than two seconds.

Example for programmable memory keys Switch the voice instructions for the navigation on/off.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

3. Select the symbol using the controller.

4. ... Press the desired key for longer than two seconds.

Executing a function ... Press the button.

The function is executed immediately. This means, for example, that the number is dialed when a phone number is selected.

Displaying memory key assignments Touch the button with a finger. Do not wear gloves or use objects.

Displaying brief information ... Touch the button.

The key assignment is displayed at the top edge of the screen.

Displaying detailed information ... Touch the button for an

extended period.

A t

a g

la n

ce

21

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Letters and numbers

Entering letters and numbers 1. Turn the controller: select the letters or

numbers.

2. Select additional letters or numbers if needed.

3. "OK": confirm the entry.

Switching between letters and numbers Depending on the menu, you can switch between entering letters and numbers:

Wordmatch concept during navigation Entry of names and addresses: the selection is narrowed down every time a letter is entered and letters may be added automatically.

Destination search: the entries are continuously compared to the data stored in the vehicle.

> The only letters offered for entering addresses are those for which data are available.

> Town/city names can be entered with the spelling used in any of the languages available on the Control Display.

Symbol Function

Press the controller: delete one letter or number

Press the controller for an extended period: delete all letters or numbers

Enter a blank space

Symbol Function

Entering letters

Entering numbers

V o

ic e

ac ti

va ti

o n

s ys

te m

22

Voice activation system

The concept The voice activation system allows you to con- trol operation of various vehicle systems with- out removing your hands from the steering wheel.

Most menu items on the Control Display can be voiced as commands. It is not necessary to use the controller.

The voice activation system transforms your oral commands into control signals for the selected systems and provides support in the form of instructions or questions.

Coupe: the voice activation system uses a spe- cial microphone located in the area of the inte- rior rearview mirror, refer to page 14.

Convertible: the voice activation system uses a special microphone located in the area of the steering column.

Precondition Via iDrive, select the language in which the voice activation system is operating, so that the spoken commands can be identified. Selecting the language for iDrive, refer to page 87.

Symbols in the Owner's Manual

Saying commands

Activating voice activation system 1. Press the button on the steering wheel.

This symbol on the Control Display and an acoustic signal indicate that the voice activation system is ready to receive spo- ken commands.

2. Say the command. The command appears on the Control Dis- play.

This symbol appears on the Control Display when you can enter additional commands. If no further commands are possible, continue by operating the item of equipment via iDrive.

*

{...} Say the specified commands word for word. {{...}} Indicates responses of the voice acti- vation system.

A t

a g

la n

ce

23

R e

fe re

n ce

C o

n tr

o ls

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

C om

m un

ic at

io ns

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

M o

b il

it y

Terminating or canceling voice activation system Press the button on the steering wheel or

In dialogs that call for a text of your choice, the procedure can only be canceled using the but- ton on the steering wheel.

Possible commands The commands available in each case depend on the menu item selected on the Control Dis- play. To have the available commands read aloud:

For example, if "CD" is selected, the commands for operating CD/Multimedia are read aloud.

Calling up functions immediately via short commands Short commands enable you to perform certain functions immediately, irrespective of which menu item is selected, refer to page 251.

Example: selecting the track of a CD 1. If necessary, switch on entertainment audio

output.

2. Press the button on the steering wheel.

Setting the voice dialog You can set whether the system should use the standard dialog or a shorter variant. In the shorter variant of the voice dialog, the prompts and responses from the system are abbrevi- ated.

1. "Settings"

2. "Language/Units"

3. "Speech mode:"

4. To select the setting:

> "Default"

> "Short"

Notes To operate the phone by voice, refer to page 192.<

For voice commands, bear in mind the follow- ing:

> Do not use the voice activation system to initiate an Emergency Request. In stressful situations, the voice and vocal pitch can change. This can unnecessarily delay the establishment of a telephone connection.

> Pronounce the commands and digits smoothly and at normal volume, avoiding excessive emphases and pauses. This also applies when spelling out and saying a full word during destination entry.

> When selecting a radio station, use the standard pronunciation of the station name.

> For entries in the voice-activated phone book, only use names in the language of the voice activation system and no abbreviations.

> Keep the doors, windows and glass roof closed to prevent interference from outside noise.

> Avoid ambient noise in the vehicle while speaking.

{Cancel}

{Voice commands} or {Help}

3. Select the music track, e.g.: {C D track 4} System says: {{Track 4}}

Controls This chapter is intended to provide you with

information for complete control of your vehicle. All features and accessories that are useful for

driving and your safety, comfort and convenience, are described here.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

26

Opening and closing

Remote control

Each remote control contains a rechargeable battery that is automatically recharged when it is in the ignition lock while the car is being driven. Use each remote control at least twice a year for longer road trips in order to maintain the batteries' charge status. In cars with Comfort Access*, the remote control contains a replaceable battery, refer to page 35.

The settings called up and implemented when the car is unlocked depend on which remote control is used to unlock the car, refer to Per- sonal Profile, next column.

In addition, information about service require- ments is stored in the remote control, refer to Service data in the remote control, page 227.

Integrated key

Press button 1 to release the key.

The integrated key fits the following locks:

> Glove compartment, refer to page 114

> Driver's door, refer to page 29

New remote controls Your BMW center can supply new remote con- trols with integrated keys as additional units or as replacements in the event of loss.

Personal Profile

The concept You can set many of your BMW's functions to suit your personal needs and preferences. Without any action on your part, Personal Profile ensures that most of these settings are stored for the remote control currently in use. When you unlock the car, the remote control used for the purpose is recognized and the settings stored for it are called up and imple- mented.

This means that your personal settings will be activated for you, even if in the meantime your car was used by someone else with another remote control and the corresponding settings. The individual settings are stored for a maxi- mum of four remote controls. They are stored for two remote controls if Comfort Access* is in use.

Personal Profile settings For more information on specific settings, refer to the specified pages.

> Assignment of programmable memory keys, refer to page 20

> Response of the central locking system when the car is unlocked, refer to page 27

> Automatic locking of the vehicle, refer to page 30

> Automatic call-up* of the driver's seat position, refer to page 48

> Triple turn signal activation, refer to page 65

C o

n tr

o ls

27

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> Settings for the display on the Control Display and in the instrument cluster:

> 12h/24h format of the clock, refer to page 83

> Date format, refer to page 84

> Brightness of the Control Display, refer to page 87

> Language on the Control Display, refer to page 87

> Units of measure, refer to page 80

> Show visual warning for Park Distance Control PDC*, refer to page 89

> Light settings:

> Welcome lamps, refer to page 101

> Pathway lighting, refer to page 102

> Daytime running lights, refer to page 102

> High-beam assistant, refer to page 103

> Automatic climate control: activating/deac- tivating AUTO program, cooling function and automatic recirculated-air control, set- ting temperature, air volume and distribu- tion, refer to page 107 ff

> Entertainment:

> Tone control, refer to page 154

> Speed-dependent volume control, refer to page 155

Central locking system

The concept The central locking system functions when the driver's door is closed.

The system simultaneously engages and releases the locks on the following:

> Doors

> Trunk lid

> Fuel filler flap

> Convertible: glove compartment

Operating from outside > Via the remote control

> Via the door lock* > In cars with Comfort Access*, via the

handles on the driver's and front passenger doors

In addition, if the remote control is used, the welcome lamps, interior lamps and the door's courtesy lamps* are switched on or off. The alarm system* is also armed or disarmed. For further details of the alarm system,refer to page 32.

Operating from inside By means of the button for central locking, refer to page 30.

In the event of a sufficiently severe accident, the central locking system unlocks automatically. In addition, the hazard warning flashers and inte- rior lamps come on.

Opening and closing: Using the remote control

Persons or animals in a parked vehicle could lock the doors from the inside. You

should therefore take the remote control with you when you leave the vehicle so that the latter can be opened from outside.<

Convertible: to operate the retractable hardtop with the remote control, the

doors and trunk lid must be closed and the cargo area partition must be folded down and engaged on both sides. Refer also to page 39.<

Unlocking Press the button. The interior lamps, the courtesy lamps* and the welcome lamps come on.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

28

Setting unlocking characteristics You can set whether only the driver's door or the entire vehicle is to be unlocked when the button is pressed for the first time.

1. "Settings"

2. "Door locks"

3. "Unlock button"

4. Select a menu item:

> "All doors" Press the button once to unlock the entire vehicle.

> "Driver's door only" Pressing the button once unlocks the driver's door and fuel filler flap. Press the button twice to unlock the entire vehicle.

5. Press the controller.

Coupe: convenient opening Hold the button down. The windows and the glass roof* are opened.

Convertible: convenient opening* When you are close to the vehicle, the remote control for Comfort Access can be used to open the retractable hardtop.

Hold the button down. The windows and the retractable hardtop are opened if the doors are closed.

If you continue pressing the button, the win- dows move up.

Watch during the opening process to ensure that no one is injured. Releasing

the button interrupts the opening process.<

Locking Press the button.

Convertible: convenient closing* When you are close to the vehicle, the remote control for Comfort Access can be used to close the retractable hardtop and the windows.

Hold the button down. The retractable hardtop and the windows are closed.

Watch during the closing process to ensure that no one is injured. Releasing

the button interrupts the closing process.<

Switching on interior lamps While the car is locked: Press the button. You can also use this function to locate your vehicle in parking garages etc.

Unlocking the trunk lid Press the button for approx. 1 second.

The trunk lid opens a short distance, regardless of whether it was locked or unlocked.

The trunk lid swings back and up when opened. Ensure that there is sufficient

clearance. To avoid locking yourself out by accident, do not place the remote control in the cargo area. A previously locked trunk lid is locked again after closing. Before and after each trip, check that the trunk lid has not been inadvertently unlocked.<

Convertible: convenient loading* When you are close to the vehicle, the remote control for Comfort Access can be used to par- tially raise the open hardtop for more conve- nient loading of the cargo area.

1. Briefly press the button and, within one second, press again and hold until the retractable hardtop stops in an intermediate position. The trunk lid opens slightly.

2. Open the trunk lid, press the cargo area partition upward and stow the cargo in the cargo area.

C o

n tr

o ls

29

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

3. Press down the cargo area partition until it engages on both sides and close the trunk lid.

4. Press the button for a longer period to fold the retractable hardtop back in.

Confirmation signals You can activate or deactivate the confirmation signals.

1. "Settings"

2. "Door locks"

3. "Flash when lock/unlock"

4. Press the controller.

Flashing when locking/unlocking the vehicle is switched on.

Malfunctions The remote control may malfunction due to local radio waves. If this occurs, unlock and lock the car at the door lock with the integrated key.

Coupe: in vehicles without an alarm system* or Comfort Access*, only the driver's door can be locked and unlocked with the integrated key via the door lock.

Convertible: if hardtop movement via the remote control is interrupted briefly, the move- ment will be completed more quickly if you keep the corresponding button pressed continu- ously.

If the car can no longer be locked with a remote control, the battery in the remote control is dis- charged. Use the remote control on an extended trip to recharge the battery, refer to page 26. The remote control for Comfort Access* contains a battery that may have to be changed, refer to page 35.

For US owners only The transmitter and receiver units comply with part 15 of the FCC/Federal Communications Commission regulations. Operation is gov- erned by the following:

FCC ID: LX8766S LX8766E LX8CAS

Compliance statement: This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

> This device must not cause harmful inter- ference, and

> this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

Any unauthorized modifications or changes to these devices could void the

user's authority to operate this equipment.<

Opening and closing: Using the door lock

You can set the way in which the car is unlocked, refer to page 27.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

30

Coupe In vehicles without an alarm system* or Comfort Access*, only the driver's door

can be locked via the door lock.<

To lock all doors, the fuel filler flap and the trunk lid at once:

1. With the doors closed, lock the vehicle using the button for the central locking system in the interior, refer to page 30.

2. Unlock and open the driver's or front passenger door, refer to page 31.

3. Lock the vehicle.

> Lock the driver's door using the inte- grated key in the door lock, or

> press down the lock button of the front passenger door and close the door from the outside.

Convenient operation Coupe: if the vehicle is equipped with an alarm system* or Comfort Access*, you can also operate the windows and the glass roof* via the door lock.

Convertible: you can operate the windows and the retractable hardtop via the door lock.

Hold the key in the position for unlocking or locking.

During each closing procedure, and when opening the retractable hardtop, watch

the process and ensure that no one becomes trapped. Releasing the key stops the opera- tion.<

Manual operation In the event of an electrical malfunction, you can lock and unlock the driver's door by turning the integrated key to the corresponding limit posi- tions in the door lock.

Opening and closing: From inside

This button serves to unlock or lock doors and the trunk lid, but does not activate the anti-theft system. The fuel filler flap remains unlocked.

Automatic locking You can also set the situations in which the car locks:

1. "Settings"

2. "Door locks"

3. Select the desired function:

> "Lock if no door is opened" The central locking system locks the vehicle after a short time, unless a door has been opened.

> "Lock after start. to drive" The central locking system locks the vehicle when you drive away.

The function is switched on and is stored for the remote control currently in use.

C o

n tr

o ls

31

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Unlocking and opening doors > Either unlock the doors together using the

button for the central locking system and then pull the door handle above the armrest or

> pull on the door handle of each door twice: the first time unlocks the door, the second time opens it.

Locking > Use the central locking button to lock all of

the doors simultaneously, or

> press down the safety lock button of a door. To prevent you from being locked out, the open driver's door cannot be locked using the lock button.

Persons or animals in a parked vehicle could lock the doors from the inside. You

should therefore take the remote control with you when you leave the vehicle so that the latter can be opened from outside.<

Trunk lid In order to avoid damage, make sure there is sufficient clearance before opening the

trunk lid.<

Opening from inside

Press the button: the trunk lid opens unless it has been locked.

Opening from outside

Press the button, see arrow, or the button on the remote control for a longer period. The trunk lid will open slightly. It can now be swung upwards.

In the event of a malfunction, please con- tact your BMW center or a workshop that

works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel.<

Coupe: locking or unlocking separately

The switch is located in the glove compartment.

1 Locking the trunk lid

2 Unlocking the trunk lid

Locking separately Push the switch in the direction of arrow 1. The trunk lid is locked and cannot be unlocked using the central locking system. If you give the remote control without the inte- grated key to someone else while the glove compartment is locked, the trunk lid cannot be opened. This is an advantage when valet park- ing, for example. Locking the glove compart- ment, refer to page 114.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

32

Unlocking separately Push the switch in the direction of arrow 2.

Emergency release

Pull the lever in the cargo area. The trunk lid is unlocked.

Closing The handle recesses on the interior trim of the trunk lid make it easier to pull down.

Make sure that the closing path of the trunk lid is clear; otherwise, injuries may

result.<

Coupe

Convertible To close the trunk lid, press it down lightly. The lid is closed automatically.<

Alarm system*

The concept The vehicle alarm system responds:

> When a door, the hood or the trunk lid is opened

> To movements inside the vehicle: Interior motion sensor, refer to page 33

> When the car's inclination changes, for instance if an attempt is made to jack it up and steal the wheels or to raise it prior to towing away

> When there has been an interruption of power supply from the battery

The alarm system signals unauthorized entry attempts for a short time by means of:

> An acoustic alarm

> Switching on the hazard warning flashers

> Flashing the high beams

Arming and disarming When you lock or unlock the vehicle, either with the remote control or at the door lock, the alarm system is armed or disarmed at the same time.

You can open the trunk lid even when the alarm system is armed, by pressing the button on the remote control, refer to page 28. The lid is locked and monitored again as soon as you close it.

Panic mode* You can trigger the alarm system if you find yourself in a dangerous situation:

Press the button for at least three seconds.

To switch off the alarm: press any button.

Switching off an alarm > Unlock the car with the remote control,

refer to page 27.

> Insert the remote control all the way into the ignition lock.

C o

n tr

o ls

33

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Indicator lamp displays

> The indicator lamp under the inside rear- view mirror flashes continuously: the sys- tem is armed.

> The indicator lamp flashes after locking: doors, hood or trunk lid are not properly closed. Even if you do not close the alerted area, the system begins to monitor the remaining areas, and the indicator lamp flashes continuously after approx. 10 seconds. The interior motion sensor and the tilt alarm sensor are not activated.

> The indicator lamp goes out after unlocking: your vehicle has not been disturbed while you were away.

> If the indicator lamp flashes after unlocking until the remote control is inserted in the ignition, but for no longer than approx. 5 minutes: your vehicle has been disturbed while you were away.

Tilt alarm sensor The tilt of the vehicle is monitored. The alarm system reacts, e.g. to attempts to steal a wheel or tow the vehicle.

Interior motion sensor

Coupe In order for the interior motion sensor to func- tion properly, the windows and glass roof must be completely closed*.

Convertible The interior of the car is monitored up to the height of the seat cushions. Thus the alarm sys- tem is activated together with the interior motion sensor even if the hardtop is open. The alarm can be triggered unintentionally by falling objects such as leaves, refer to Avoiding unin- tentional alarms.

Avoiding unintentional alarms The tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor may be switched off at the same time. This pre- vents unintentional alarms, e.g. in the following situations:

> In duplex garages

> During transport on car-carrying trains, boats/ships or on a trailer

> When animals are to remain in the vehicle

Switching off tilt alarm sensor and interior motion sensor Press the button on the remote control again as soon as the vehicle is locked.

The indicator lamp lights up briefly and then flashes continuously. The tilt alarm sensor and the interior motion sensor are switched off until the next time the vehicle is unlocked and subse- quently locked again.

Comfort Access* Comfort Access enables you to enter your vehi- cle without needing to hold the remote control in your hand. All you need to do is wear the remote control close to your body, e.g. in your jacket pocket. The vehicle detects the corre- sponding remote control within the immediate vicinity or in the passenger compartment.

Comfort Access supports the following func- tions:

> Unlocking/locking the vehicle

> Unlocking the trunk lid separately

> Engine starting

> Convenient closing

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

34

Functional requirement > The vehicle or the trunk lid can only be

locked when the vehicle detects that the remote control currently in use is outside of the vehicle.

> The vehicle cannot be locked or unlocked again until after approx. 2 seconds.

> The engine can only be started when the vehicle detects that the remote control cur- rently in use is inside the vehicle.

Comparison to the standard remote control In general, there is no difference between using Comfort Access or pressing the buttons on the remote control to carry out the functions men- tioned above. You should therefore first famil- iarize yourself with the instructions on opening and closing starting on page 26.

Special features regarding the use of Comfort Access are described below.

If you notice a brief delay while opening or closing windows, the glass roof or retract-

able hardtop, the system is checking whether a remote control is inside the vehicle. Please repeat the opening or closing procedure, if nec- essary.<

Unlocking

Grasp the handle on the driver's or front pas- senger door completely, arrow 1. This corre- sponds to pressing the button.

Locking Touch the surface, arrow 2, with your finger for approx. 1 second. This corresponds to pressing the button.

To preserve the battery, please make sure that the ignition and all electrical

consumers are switched off before locking the vehicle.<

Coupe: convenient closing For Convenient closing, keep your finger on the surface, arrow 2.

Convertible: window and convertible top operation With the ignition at radio readiness or beyond, you can open and close the windows and the convertible top when a remote control is located inside the vehicle.

Unlocking the trunk lid separately Press the button on the outside of the trunk lid. This corresponds to pressing the button.

If the vehicle detects that a remote con- trol has been accidentally left inside the

locked vehicle's cargo area after the trunk lid is closed, the lid will reopen. The hazard warning flashers flash and an acoustic signal* sounds.<

Switching on radio readiness Radio readiness is switched on by pressing the start/stop button, refer to page 55.

Do not depress the brake or the clutch; otherwise, the engine will start.<

Starting the engine You can start the engine or switch on the igni- tion when a remote control is inside the vehicle. It is not necessary to insert a remote control into the ignition lock, refer to page 55.

C o

n tr

o ls

35

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Switching off the engine in cars with automatic transmission The engine can only be switched off when the selector lever is in position P, refer to page 57. To switch the engine off when the selector lever is in position N, the remote control must be in the ignition lock.

Malfunction Comfort Access may malfunction due to local radio waves. If this happens, open or close the vehicle via the buttons on the remote control or using the integrated key. To start the engine afterward, insert the remote control into the ignition lock.

Warning lamps The warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when you attempt to start the engine: the engine cannot

be started. The remote control is not inside the vehicle or is malfunctioning.

Take the remote control with you inside the vehicle or have it checked. If necessary, insert another remote control into the ignition lock.

The warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights up while the engine is running: the remote control is no

longer inside the vehicle. After the engine is switched off, the engine can only be restarted within approx. 10 seconds.

The indicator lamp in the instrument cluster comes on and a message appears on the Control Display:

replace the battery in the remote control.

Replacing the battery The remote control for Comfort Access con- tains a battery that will need to be replaced from time to time.

1. Take the integrated key out of the remote control, refer to page 26.

2. Remove the cover.

3. Insert the new battery with the plus side fac- ing up.

4. Press the cover on to close.

Take the old battery to a battery collec- tion point or to your BMW center.<

Windows To prevent injuries, watch the windows while closing them.

Take the remote control with you when you leave the car; otherwise, children could operate the electric windows and possibly injure them- selves.<

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

36

Coupe: opening, closing

> Press the switch to the resistance point: The window opens as long as you press the switch.

> Press the switch beyond the resistance point: The window opens automatically. Press the switch again to stop the opening move- ment.

You can close the windows in the same manner by pulling the switch.

Convertible: opening, closing

Individually

> Press the switch to the resistance point: The window opens as long as you press the switch.

> Press the switch beyond the resistance point: The window opens automatically. Press the switch again to stop the opening move- ment.

You can close the windows in the same manner by pulling the switch. The rear windows do not close automatically.

Jointly

> Press the switch to the resistance point: All windows open as long as you press the switch.

> Press the switch beyond the resistance point: All windows open automatically. Press the switch again to stop the opening movement.

> Pull the switch: All windows close as long as you pull the switch.

After switching off the ignition When the remote control is removed or the igni- tion is switched off, you can still operate the windows for approx. 1 minute as long as no door is opened.

Convenient operation For information on Convenient operation via the remote control or the door lock, refer to page 27 or 30. For information on Convenient closing with Comfort Access, refer to Locking on page 28.

Pinch protection system If the closing force exceeds a specific value as a window closes, the closing action is interrupted and the window reopens slightly.

Despite the pinch protection system check and clear the window's travel path

prior to closing it; otherwise, the safety system might fail to detect certain kinds of obstruc- tions, such as thin objects, and the window would continue closing.

C o

n tr

o ls

37

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Do not install any accessories that might inter- fere with window movement. Otherwise, the pinch protection system could be impaired. Convertible: the rear windows are not equipped with pinch protection. Therefore, watch them closely when closing to avoid personal injury.<

Closing without pinch protection If there is an external danger, or if ice on the win- dows, etc., prevents you from closing the win- dows normally, proceed as follows:

1. Pull the switch past the resistance point and hold it there. Pinch protection is limited and the window reopens slightly if the closing force exceeds a certain value.

2. Pull the switch again past the resistance point within approx. 4 seconds and hold it there. The window closes without pinch protection.

Coupe: glass roof*, electric To prevent injuries, watch the glass roof while closing it.

Take the remote control with you when you leave the car; otherwise, children could operate the roof and possibly injure themselves.<

Raising Press the switch.

> The closed glass roof is raised and the sliding visor opens slightly.

Opening, closing > Press the switch backwards to the resis-

tance point. The glass roof and the sliding visor open together as long as you hold the switch in this position.

> Press the switch backwards past the resis- tance point. The glass roof and the sliding visor open automatically. Briefly press the switch again to stop the opening movement.

You can close the glass roof in a similar manner by pressing the switch forwards. The sliding visor remains open and can be closed by hand.

For information on Convenient operation via the remote control or door lock, refer to page 27 or 30.

After switching off the ignition When the remote control is removed or the igni- tion is switched off, you can still operate the roof for approx. 1 minute as long as no door has been opened.

Pinch protection system If the glass roof encounters an obstruction dur- ing closing from approximately the middle of the opening in the roof, or during closing from the raised position, the closing movement is interrupted and the glass roof is opened again slightly.

Despite the pinch protection system check and clear the roof's travel path prior

to closing it; otherwise, the safety system might fail to detect certain kinds of obstructions, such as very thin objects, and the roof would con- tinue closing.<

Closing without pinch protection If there is an external danger, press the switch forward past the resistance point. The roof closes without pinch protection.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

38

Following interruptions in electrical power supply After a power failure, there is a possibility that the glass roof can only be raised. The system must be initialized. BMW recommends having this work done by your BMW center.

Closing manually* In the event of an electrical malfunction, you can move the glass roof manually:

1. Unclip the front of the cover of the interior lamps using the screwdriver from the onboard vehicle tool kit, refer to page 233.

2. Insert the screwdriver into the openings on each side to press the clips.

3. Remove the control unit.

4. Unplug the motor. Considerably less effort will be required for manual operation.

5. Insert the Allen wrench* supplied with the onboard vehicle tool kit, refer to page 233, into the opening provided. Move the glass roof in the desired direction.

6. Reinstall the control unit and reattach the lamp cover.

Convertible: retractable hardtop The retractable hardtop combines reliable weather protection with simple and convenient operation.

The following tips will enhance your driving pleasure in your Convertible:

> It is advisable that you close the retractable hardtop when you park the vehicle. Not only does the closed hardtop protect the vehicle interior against unanticipated weather dam- age, it also offers theft protection. However, even when the hardtop is closed, valuables should only be stored in the locked cargo area.

> Do not attach roof rack systems to the retractable hardtop, and in particular do not attach magnetic racks.

> Do not attach rack systems to the trunk lid, and in particular do not attach magnetic racks.

> When the retractable hardtop is operated, the trunk lid swings back and up. Before operating the retractable hardtop, ensure that there is enough clearance, e.g. when parked in front of a wall.

C o

n tr

o ls

39

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> If you open the hardtop while it is wet, e.g. after driving in the rain, water may drip into the cargo area. If necessary, remove items from the cargo area beforehand to avoid water stains or soiling.

Do not place any objects on the retract- able hardtop or on the trunk lid; other-

wise, they could fall during movements of the retractable hardtop and cause damage or injury. Never move the retractable hardtop when the rollover protection system is in the activated position. Driving when the hardtop is not fully opened or closed may result in damage or injury. Do not reach into the mechanism during the opening or closing procedure. Keep children away from the swiveling area of the retractable hardtop.<

The retractable hardtop cannot be moved at temperatures below +147/106. A

message appears on the Control Display.<

The retractable hardtop can only be opened and closed when the vehicle is

stationary. To avoid causing damage, do not drive off until the hardtop has stopped mov- ing.<

Before opening and closing > Comply with the safety precautions

described above.

> Ensure that the cargo area partition is folded down and engaged on both sides, refer to page 119; otherwise, it will not be possible to open the retractable hardtop.

> Do not place any objects next to or on the cargo area partition and close the storage compartment on the left side of the cargo area.

> Do not exceed the maximum loading height under the cargo area partition; refer to the label in the cargo area showing a line indi- cating the maximum height.

> Ensure that the trunk lid is closed.

> The vehicle should be parked on fairly level ground. Excessive angle is indicated by a lamp.

Opening and closing When the vehicle is stationary and at radio readiness or beyond, refer to page 55:

If possible, conserve the battery by only operating the retractable hardtop when

the engine is running. Before closing the retractable hardtop, remove all foreign objects from the windshield frame as these could prevent the hardtop from closing properly.<

1 Push button: open the retractable hardtop. Pull button: close the retractable hardtop.

2 LEDs

The side windows move down when the switch for hardtop operation is pulled or

pushed.<

LEDs In the following situations, a message appears on the Control Display or an acoustic signal sounds in addition to the LED lighting up:

> While the hardtop is being operated, the left LED lights up green. It goes out as soon as the top is fully opened or closed.

> If the right-hand LED flashes red when you release the switch, the opening or closing action has not yet finished.

> If the right LED lights up red when the switch is pressed, the cargo area partition is folded up, the trunk lid is not closed, the vehicle is standing on a strong incline or there is a malfunction. The retractable hard- top cannot be moved.

O p

en in

g a

n d

c lo

si n

g

40

Interruption The automatic sequence of movements is interrupted if the switch for hardtop operation is released. The sequence can be continued in the desired direction by pushing or pulling the switch.

A hardtop that is not fully opened or closed is a safety hazard.

Do not interrupt and resume the closing proce- dure several times in close succession as this could damage the mechanism.<

If the hardtop is not fully opened or closed, the trunk lid cannot be opened

and the windows cannot be moved.<

Convenient operation with remote control or via door lock Refer to pages 28 and 30.

Wind deflector* The wind deflector keeps air movements in the passenger compartment to a minimum when the hardtop is open and provides an even more comfortable ride, particularly at high speeds.

Installation The wind deflector is stored in a protective cover in the cargo area. Brief instructions for operation can be found on the protective cover.

1. Remove the wind deflector from the protec- tive cover and unfold it, arrows 1.

2. Press together the top and bottom parts of the wind deflector until the catch engages, arrow 2.

3. Push the fastening pin, arrow 3, into the opening provided on the right side of the vehicle until it snaps into place. Remove the protective caps beforehand, if necessary.

4. Push the fastening pin, arrow 4, into the opening provided on the left side of the vehicle until it snaps into place.

5. Turn the rotary handle in the direction of arrow 5 as far as the first stop to insert the right fastening pin into the holders.

6. Turn the rotary handle in the direction of arrow 6 as far as the symbol to insert the left fastening pin into the holders.

7. Fold up the top section of the wind deflec- tor.

With the wind deflector installed: do not recline the front-seat backrests too far if

the seat is to be slid all the way back, as this would damage the wind deflector.<

Only turn the rotary handle within the range between the two symbols; other-

wise, the cable system inside the wind deflector could be damaged.<

C o

n tr

o ls

41

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Removing the wind deflector Proceed in the reverse order as used for instal- lation.

Protective caps are provided in the vehicle for the holders of the wind deflector.

Folding

Slide the red release lever towards the middle of the wind deflector and push the two halves apart.

Loading function Cargo can still be loaded on the rear seat of the vehicle even if the wind deflector has been installed.

1. Lower all windows.

2. Fold down the top section of the wind deflector, arrow 1.

3. Turn the rotary handle to position , arrow 2.

Fold both sections of the wind deflector forward and rest them against the front seats, arrow 3.

To protect the seat cushions or to use the bag holders, you can fold the rear backrest down, refer to page 119.

A d

ju st

m en

ts

42

Adjustments

Sitting safely The ideal sitting position can make a vital con- tribution to relaxed, fatigue-free driving. In con- junction with the safety belts, the head restraints and the airbags, the seated position has a major influence on your safety in the event of an accident. To ensure that the safety sys- tems operate with optimal efficiency, we strongly urge you to observe the instructions contained in the following section.

For additional information on transporting chil- dren safely, refer to page 52.

Airbags Always maintain an adequate distance between yourself and the airbags. Always

grip the steering wheel on the rim, with your hands in the 3 o'clock and 9 o'clock positions, to minimize the risk of injury to the hands or arms in the event of the airbag being triggered off. No one and nothing should come between the airbags and the seat occupant. Do not use the cover of the front airbag on the front passenger side as a storage area. Make sure that the front passenger is sitting correctly, e.g. not resting feet or legs on the dashboard; otherwise, leg injuries can occur if the front air- bag deploys. Make sure that passengers keep their heads away from the side airbag and do not lean against the cover of the head airbag; otherwise, serious injuries can result if the airbag deploys.<

Even if you follow all the instructions, injuries resulting from contact with airbags cannot be fully excluded, depending on the circum- stances. The ignition and inflation noise may provoke a mild hearing loss in extremely sensi- tive individuals. This effect is usually only tem- porary.

For airbag locations and additional information on airbags, refer to page 98.

Head restraint A correctly adjusted head restraint reduces the risk of neck injury in the event of an accident.

Adjust the head restraint in such a way that its center is at approx. ear level.

Otherwise, there is an increased risk of injury in the event of an accident.<

Head restraints, refer to page 45.

Safety belt Before every drive, make sure that all occupants wear their safety belts. Airbags complement the safety belt as an additional safety device, but they do not represent a substitute.

Your vehicle has four seats, each of which is equipped with a safety belt.

Never allow more than one person to wear a single safety belt. Never allow

infants or small children to ride in a passenger's lap. Make sure that the belt in the lap area sits low across the hips and does not press against the abdomen. The safety belt must not rest against the throat, run across sharp edges, pass over hard or frag- ile objects or be pinched. Fasten the safety belt so that it sits as snugly as possible against the lap and shoulder without being twisted. Other- wise, the belt could slide over your hips and injure your abdomen in the event of a frontal collision. Avoid wearing bulky clothing and regularly pull the belt in the upper-body area taut; otherwise, its restraining effect could be impaired.<

Safety belts, refer to page 49.

C o

n tr

o ls

43

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Seats

Note before adjusting Never attempt to adjust your seat while the vehicle is moving. The seat could

respond with unexpected movement, and the ensuing loss of vehicle control could lead to an accident. On the front passenger seat as well, do not incline the backrest too far to the rear while the vehicle is being driven; otherwise, there is a danger in the event of an accident of sliding under the safety belt, eliminating the protection normally provided by the belt.<

Comply with the instructions on head restraint height on page 45, and on damaged safety belts on page 49.

Manual adjustment Observe the adjustment instructions on page 43 to ensure the best possible per-

sonal protection.<

Longitudinal direction Pull lever 1 and slide the seat to the desired position. After releasing the lever, move the seat gently forward or back to make sure it engages prop- erly.

Height Pull lever 2 and apply your weight to the seat or lift it off, as necessary.

Backrest

Pull lever 3 and apply your weight to the back- rest or lift it off, as necessary.

Tilt*

Pull the lever and apply your weight to the seat or lift it off, as necessary.

Thigh support*

Pull the lever and move the thigh support forward or back.

A d

ju st

m en

ts

44

Electrical adjustment Observe the adjustment instructions on page 43 to ensure the best possible per-

sonal protection.<

1 Longitudinal direction

2 Height

3 Angle

4 Backrest

5 Convertible: head restraints

Coupe: the head restraints are adjusted manu- ally, refer to Head restraints below.

Lumbar support*

You can also adjust the contour of the backrest to obtain additional support in the lumbar region.

The upper hips and spinal column receive supplementary support to help you maintain a relaxed, upright sitting position.

> Increase or decrease curvature: press the switch at the front or rear, respectively.

> Shift curvature up or down: press the switch at the top or bottom, respectively.

Backrest width*

You can change the width of the backrest to suit your individual preferences by adjusting the lat- eral-support pads.

Press the front or rear end of the switch. Backrest width decreases or increases accord- ingly.

Longitudinal adjustment from outside/ behind*

To move the front seats forward or backward from outside or from one of the rear seats: with the door open, press the front end 1 or rear end 2 of the switch.

C o

n tr

o ls

45

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Head restraints

Correctly adjusted head restraint A correctly adjusted head restraint reduces the risk of neck injury in the event of an accident.

Adjust the head restraint in such a way that its center is at approx. ear level. Oth-

erwise, there is an increased risk of injury in the event of an accident. Only remove a head restraint if no one will be sitting on the seat in question. Reinstall the head restraint before transporting anyone on that seat. Otherwise, the passenger will be without protection from the head restraint.<

Height Adjust the head restraint so that its center is approximately at ear level.

Distance Adjust the distance so that the head restraint is as close as possible to the back of the head.

Front active head restraints In a rear collision of a sufficient strength, the active head restraint reduces the distance to the head.

Do not use seat or head restraint covers that could impair the function of the active

head restraint. Otherwise, the protective func- tion of the active head restraint will not be ensured and its full potential in reducing the risk of injury in the event of a rear collision may not be realized. In the event of malfunctions, deactivation or triggering of the active head restraints, have the testing, repair and removal executed only by a BMW center or a workshop that works accord- ing to repair procedures of BMW with corre- spondingly trained personnel and that has the required explosives licenses. Unprofessional attempts to work on the system could lead to failure in an emergency or to undesired airbag activation, either of which could result in per- sonal injury.<

For technical reasons, the head restraint cannot be removed.<

Coupe: front seats

Height adjustment

> To raise: pull up.

> To lower: press the button, arrow 1, and slide the head restraint down.

Convertible: front seats

Height adjustment

> To raise: press the button upward.

> To lower: press the button downward.

A d

ju st

m en

ts

46

Adjusting the distance to the back of the head

> Forward: pull up.

> Back: press the button and push the head cushion toward the rear.

Do not insert objects behind the head cushion; otherwise, the head restraint

may not function properly.<

Coupe: rear seats

Height adjustment

> To raise: pull up.

> To lower: press the button, arrow 1, and slide the head restraint down.

Removing 1. Pull up as far as it will go.

2. Press the button, arrow 1, tilt the rear seat backrest slightly forward and pull the head restraint all the way out.

Only remove the head restraints if no pas- sengers will be sitting in the rear. Reinstall

head restraints before transporting passengers in the rear.<

Entering the rear seats

Coupe: seat with manual longitudinal adjustment

Easy entry The easy entry feature includes a memory func- tion for the longitudinal adjustment and back- rest angle.

1. Pull the lever and swing the backrest for- ward.

2. Push the seat forward.

Previous position Push the seat backward and swing the backrest back.

When pushing the seat into its rearmost position, make sure that no one is injured

and that no objects are damaged. Before driving off, engage both seats and back- rests so that they are locked in place. Other- wise, there is a risk of an accident due to unex- pected movement.<

C o

n tr

o ls

47

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Seat with electrical longitudinal adjustment

Coupe

Convertible Seat backrest warning lamp: Comes on when a seat backrest is not engaged. In addition, a message

appears on the Control Display.

Easy entry The easy entry feature includes a memory func- tion for the longitudinal adjustment and back- rest angle.

1. Pull lever 1 and swing the backrest forward.

2. Press the front end 2 of the switch until the seat has moved into the desired position.

Previous position Press the rear end 3 of the switch until the seat automatically stops in its previous position, and fold the backrest back. If you release the switch before the previous seat position is reached, the seat will stop at its current position.

When sliding the seat backward, make sure no one is injured and no objects are

damaged. Before driving off, engage both seats and back- rests so that they are locked in place. Other- wise, there is a risk of an accident due to unex- pected movement.<

Heated seats*

Press the button once per temperature level. Three LEDs indicate the highest temperature.

To switch off: Press button longer.

If you continue driving within approx. the next 15 minutes, the seat heating is automatically activated at the previously set temperature.

The temperature is lowered or the heating is switched off entirely to save on battery power. The LEDs stay lit.

A d

ju st

m en

ts

48

Seat and mirror memory* You can store and call up two different combi- nations of driver's seat and exterior mirror positions.

Settings for the backrest width and lumbar support are not stored in memory.

Storing

1. Switch on radio readiness or the ignition, refer to page 55.

2. Adjust the seat and exterior mirrors to the desired positions.

3. Press the button. The LED in the button lights up.

4. Press the desired memory button 1 or 2: the LED goes out.

The driver's seat and exterior mirror posi- tions are stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Call-up Do not call up the memory while you are driving; otherwise, unexpected seat

movement could result in an accident.<

Comfort function 1. Unlock and open the driver's door or switch

on radio readiness, refer to page 55.

2. Briefly press the desired memory button 1 or 2.

The adjusting procedure is halted immediately when you touch a seat adjustment switch or one of the memory buttons.

Safety feature 1. Close the driver's door and switch the igni-

tion on or off, refer to page 55.

2. Press the desired memory button 1 or 2 and keep it pressed until the adjustment process has been completed.

If the button was pressed accidentally: Press the button again; the LED goes out.

Call-up with the remote control The driver's seat position last set is stored for the remote control currently in use.

You can select whether or not the seat is reset to that position automatically.

When this Personal Profile function is used, first make sure that the footwell

behind the driver's seat is free of obstacles. Failure to do so could cause injury to persons or damage to objects as a result of a rearward movement of the seat.<

The adjusting procedure is halted immediately when you touch a seat adjustment switch or one of the memory buttons.

Selecting automatic call-up 1. "Settings"

2. "Door locks"

3. "Last seat position auto."

The function for automatically calling up the last seat position is switched on and is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Switching off automatic call-up Deactivate "Last seat position automatic".

C o

n tr

o ls

49

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Safety belts Observe the adjustment instructions on page 43 to ensure the best possible per-

sonal protection.<

Before every drive, make sure that all occupants wear their safety belts. Airbags complement the safety belt as an additional safety device, but they do not represent a substitute.

Closing Make sure you hear the latch plate engage in the belt buckle.

The upper belt anchor is suitable for adults of any stature as long as the seat is adjusted prop- erly, refer to page 43.

Opening 1. Grasp the belt firmly.

2. Press the red button in the buckle.

3. Guide the belt into its reel.

"Fasten safety belts" reminder for driver's and front passenger seat

The indicator lamps light up and an acoustic signal sounds. In addition, a message appears on the Control Display. Check whether the safety

belt has been fastened correctly.

The "Fasten safety belts" reminder is issued as long as the driver's safety belt has not been fas- tened. The "Fasten safety belts" reminder is also activated at road speeds above approx. 5 mph or 8 km/h if the front passenger safety belt is not fastened, if objects are placed on the front passenger seat, or if driver or front pas- senger unfasten their safety belts.

Damage to safety belts If the safety belts are damaged or stressed in an accident: have the belt sys-

tem, including any belt tensioners or child restraint systems, replaced and the belt anchors checked. Have this work done only by your BMW center or at a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel. Otherwise, it is not guaranteed that the safety devices will func- tion properly.<

Coupe: belt hand-over

The concept The belt hand-over makes it easier for you to fasten your safety belt. When you close the door and switch on radio readiness or the igni- tion, the belt hand-over extends automatically and presents the in a position that is convenient for fastening it around you. After you have fas- tened your safety belt, the belt hand-over retracts to its original position.

Even if you have not yet fastened your safety belt, the belt hand-over will retract if you:

> Wait for more than approx. one minute

> Open the corresponding door

> Start driving.

Closing the respective door reactivates the belt hand-over if the ignition or radio readiness is on.

Front passenger seat The belt hand-over will extend only if the seat is occupied and after the front passenger door is closed.

A d

ju st

m en

ts

50

Pinch protection system If the belt hand-over encounters resistance on moving in or out, it moves back slightly in the opposite direction and stops in this position. To reactivate the belt hand-over: open and close the door or switch the ignition off and on.

Although there is a pinch protection sys- tem, always check that the maneuvering

area of the belt hand-over is clear. Otherwise it cannot be ensured that the system will stop moving in certain extreme situations.<

Mirrors

Exterior mirrors The front passenger's mirror is more con- vex than the driver's mirror. The objects

seen in the mirror are closer than they appear. Do not gauge your distance from traffic behind you on the basis of what you see in the mirror; otherwise, there is an increased risk of an acci- dent.<

1 Adjustments

2 Switching to the other mirror or automatic curb monitor*

3 Folding mirrors in and out* The setting for the exterior mirrors is stored for the remote control currently in use*. The stored position is called up automatically when the vehicle is unlocked.

Manual adjustment The mirrors can also be adjusted manually: press the edge of the glass.

Folding mirrors in and out* At driving speeds up to approx. 12 mph/20 km/h, you can fold the mirrors in and out by pressing button 3. This can be beneficial in narrow streets, for example, or for moving mirrors that were folded in by hand back out into their correct positions. Mirrors that were folded in are folded out automatically at a speed of approx. 25 mph/40 km/h.

Before entering an automatic car wash, fold in the exterior mirrors manually or

with button 3 to prevent them from being dam- aged, depending on the width of the vehicle.<

Automatic heating Depending on the outside temperature, both exterior mirrors are heated automatically when the engine is running or the ignition is switched on.

Passenger side mirror tilt function automatic curb monitor*

Activating 1. Push the switch to the position for the

driver's side mirror, arrow 1.

2. Shift into reverse or engage the selector lever- or transmission position R. The glass of the mirror on the passenger side tilts slightly down. This allows the driver to see the area immediately adjacent to the vehicle, e.g. a curb, when backing into a parking space.

Deactivating Push the switch to the position for the passen- ger side mirror, arrow 2.

C o

n tr

o ls

51

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Interior rearview mirror

Turn the knob to reduce glare from the head- lamps of cars behind you when driving at night.

Interior and exterior mirrors, automatic dimming feature*

The automatic dimming feature of the interior and exterior mirrors* is controlled by two photo cells in the interior rearview mirror. One photo cell is in the mirror frame, see arrow; the other is on the back of the mirror.

In order to ensure that the system functions correctly, keep the photo cells clean, do not cover the area between the interior rearview mirror and windshield, and do not affix adhesive labels or stickers of any kind to the windshield directly in front of the mirror.

Steering wheel

Adjustments Do not adjust the steering wheel position while the car is in motion; otherwise, there

is a risk of an accident due to unexpected move- ment.<

1. Fold the lever down.

2. Move the steering wheel to the preferred height and angle to suit your seated posi- tion.

3. Swing the lever back up.

Do not use force to swing the lever back up; otherwise, the mechanism

will be damaged.<

Steering wheel heating*

Press the button.

The LED in the button lights up when the steering wheel heating is switched on.

T ra

n sp

o rt

in g

c h

ild re

n s

af el

y

52

Transporting children safely

The right place for children Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle; otherwise, they could endanger

themselves and/or other persons by opening the doors, for example.<

Children always in the rear Accident research has shown that the safest place for children is on the rear seat.

Children under the age of 13 or smaller than 5 ft/150 cm may be transported only

in the rear in suitable child restraint systems appropriate for their age, weight and size. Oth- erwise, there is an increased risk of injury in the event of an accident.<

Children 13 years of age or older must be buck- led in with a safety belt as soon as there no longer is any child restraint system that is appropriate for their age, size and weight.

Children in the front passenger seat Should it be necessary to use a child restraint system on the front passenger

seat, the front and side airbags for the front pas- senger must be deactivated. Otherwise, a child traveling on that seat will face a significant risk of injury if the airbags are triggered off, even with a child restraint system.<

For more information on automatic deactivation of the front passenger airbags refer to page 98.

Installing child restraint systems

Observe the child restraint system manu- facturer's instructions when selecting,

installing and using child restraint systems. Otherwise, the protective effect may be dimin- ished. <

Standard child restraint systems are designed to be secured with a lap belt or with the lap-belt section of a lap-and-shoulder belt. Incorrectly

or improperly installed child restraint systems can increase the risk of injury to children. Always follow the installation instructions for the system with the greatest care.

On the front passenger seat After installing a child restraint system on the front passenger seat, make sure that

the front and side airbags for the front passen- ger are deactivated; otherwise, there is an increased risk of injury if the airbags deploy.<

Seat position Before installing a child restraint system, move the front passenger seat as far back and up as possible to obtain the best possible position for the belt. Do not change the seat position after this.

Backrest width* The backrest width of the front passenger seat must be at its widest possible set-

ting. Do not change the setting after installing the child seat. Otherwise, the child seat's stabil- ity on the front passenger seat is limited.<

1. Adjust the backrest width to its widest setting, refer to page 44.

2. Install the child seat.

Child seat security

The rear safety belts and the front passenger safety belt can be prevented from being pulled out in order to fasten child restraint systems.

C o

n tr

o ls

53

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

To lock the safety belt 1. Secure the child restraint system with the

belt.

2. Pull the belt strap all the way out.

3. Allow the belt strap to retract and pull it taut against the child restraint system.

The safety belt is locked.

To unlock the safety belt 1. Open the belt buckle.

2. Remove the child restraint system.

3. Allow the safety belt strap to retract all the way.

LATCH child restraint fixing system LATCH: Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHil- dren.

To install and use the LATCH child restraint system, follow the operating and

safety instructions provided by the manufac- turer of the system; otherwise, the protective function of the seat may be compromised.<

Mounts for the lower LATCH anchors Before installing the child seat, pull the belt out of the area for the child restraint fixing system.

Ensure that both lower LATCH anchors are correctly engaged and that the child

restraint system is resting firmly against the backrest; otherwise, the protective function of the seat may be compromised.<

The anchor points for the lower LATCH anchors are located behind the labeled protec- tive caps.

Upper LATCH retaining strap

Convertible For Canadian Customers Only.

The following statement is required by Trans- port Canada.

This vehicle is not equipped with user-ready tether anchorages. As such neither a child restraint system, nor a booster cushion, requir- ing the use of a tether strap can be properly secured in the vehicle.

Coupe Use the top tether anchors to secure child restraint systems only; otherwise, the

anchors could be damaged.<

For child restraint systems with tether straps there are two additional anchors, see arrows.

T ra

n sp

o rt

in g

c h

ild re

n s

af el

y

54

Placement of the tether strap

Coupe Make sure the upper retaining strap does not run over sharp edges and is not

twisted as it passes to the top anchor. Other- wise, the strap will not properly secure the child restraint system in the event of an accident.<

1 Direction of travel

2 Head restraint

3 Hook for upper retaining strap

4 Anchor

5 Rear window shelf

6 Seat backrest

7 Upper retaining strap of child restraint system

If necessary, fold the anchors upward before use.

1. Push the head restraint upward.

2. Guide the upper retaining strap between the head restraint holders.

3. Use the hook to clip the retaining strap to the anchor.

4. Push the head restraint into its lowermost position.

5. Pull the retaining strap taut.

C o

n tr

o ls

55

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Driving

Ignition lock

Insert the remote control into the ignition lock

Insert the remote control all the way into the ignition lock.

> Radio readiness is switched on. Individual electrical consumers can operate.

Comfort Access* If the car is equipped with Comfort Access, only insert the remote control into the ignition lock under special circumstances, refer to page 33.

Removing the remote control from the ignition lock

Do not forcibly pull the remote control out of the ignition lock as this may cause

damage.<

Before removing the remote control, push it all the way in to release the locking mechanism.

> The ignition is switched off if it was on.

Automatic transmission You cannot take out the remote control unless the selector lever is in the P position: interlock.

Start/stop button

Pressing the start/stop button switches radio readiness or the ignition on or off.

Manual transmission: when you press the start/stop button and depress the clutch,

the engine starts. Automatic transmission and Sports automatic transmission with double clutch: when you press the start/stop button and depress the brake pedal, the engine starts.<

Radio readiness Individual electrical consumers can operate. The time and the outside temperature are dis- played in the instrument cluster.

Radio readiness is switched off automatically:

> When the remote control is removed from the ignition lock

> In cars with Comfort Access*, by touching the surface above the door lock, refer to Locking on page 34

Ignition on All electrical consumers can operate. The odometer and trip odometer are displayed in the instrument cluster.

When the engine is off, please switch off the ignition and any unnecessary

electrical consumers in order to preserve the battery.<

D ri

vi n

g

56

Radio readiness and ignition off All indicator and warning lamps as well as dis- plays in the instrument cluster go out.

Starting the engine Do not run the engine in enclosed areas; otherwise, the inhalation of toxic exhaust

gases can cause loss of consciousness and death. The exhaust gases contain carbon mon- oxide, an odorless and colorless, but highly toxic gas. Never leave an unattended vehicle with the engine running; otherwise, such a vehi- cle represents a potential safety hazard. Before leaving the vehicle with the engine run- ning, always shift into neutral or selector lever / transmission position P and apply the parking brake forcefully to prevent the vehicle from roll- ing.<

Avoid frequent starting in quick succes- sion as well as repeated start attempts in

which the engine does not start. Otherwise, the fuel is not burned or incompletely burned and there is a danger of overheating and damaging the catalytic converter.<

Do not wait for the engine to warm up while the vehicle remains stationary. Start driving right away, but at moderate engine speeds.

Manual transmission Remote control in the ignition lock or, with Comfort Access, inside the vehicle, refer to page 33.

1. Depress the brake.

2. Depress the clutch and shift to neutral posi- tion.

3. Press the start/stop button.

The starter operates automatically for a certain time, and stops automatically as soon as the engine has started.

Automatic transmission Remote control in the ignition lock or, with Comfort Access, inside the vehicle, refer to page 33.

1. Depress the brake.

2. Move the selector lever to position P.

3. Press the start/stop button.

The starter operates automatically for a certain time, and stops automatically as soon as the engine has started.

Sports automatic transmission with double clutch Remote control in the ignition lock or, with Comfort Access, inside the vehicle, refer to page 33.

1. Depress the brake.

2. Press the start/stop button.

The engine starts independent of the current transmission position.

Switching off the engine Always take the remote control with you when you leave the vehicle.

When parking, apply the parking brake force- fully; otherwise, the vehicle could begin to roll.<

Manual transmission 1. With the car at a standstill, press the start/

stop button.

2. Shift into first gear or reverse.

3. Forcefully apply the parking brake.

4. Removing the remote control from the ignition lock, refer to page 55.

C o

n tr

o ls

57

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Automatic transmission 1. With the car at a standstill, move the

selector lever to position P.

2. Press the start/stop button.

3. Forcefully apply the parking brake.

4. Removing the remote control from the ignition lock, refer to page 55.

Sports automatic transmission with double clutch 1. With the car at a standstill, press the start/

stop button. If the transmission is shifted into N when the engine is switched off, you will be notified visually and acoustically of this fact.

2. Forcefully apply the parking brake.

3. Remove remote control from the ignition lock, refer to page 55. The transmission is automatically shifted into transmission position P.

Parking brake The parking brake is primarily intended to pre- vent the vehicle from rolling while parked; it brakes the rear wheels.

Indicator lamp The indicator lamp is lit, and when you drive off an acoustic signal sounds in addition. The parking brake is still

applied.

Indicator lamp for Canadian models.

Applying The lever locks in position automatically.

Releasing

Pull slightly upwards, press the button and lower the lever.

In exceptional cases, if the parking brake has to be used to slow or stop the car, do

not pull the lever up too hard. In doing so, con- tinuously press the button of the parking brake lever. Otherwise, excessive force on the parking brake can lock up the rear wheels and cause the rear of the car to swerve.<

To prevent corrosion and one-sided brak- ing action, occasionally apply the parking

brake lightly when the vehicle is slowly coming to a stop if the traffic conditions are suitable. The brake lamps do not light up when the park- ing brake is applied.<

Manual transmission

When shifting into 5th or 6th gear, press the gearshift lever to the right. Otherwise,

the engine could be damaged if you inadvert- ently shift into 3rd or 4th gear.<

D ri

vi n

g

58

Reverse gear Select this only when the vehicle is stationary. When the gearshift lever is pressed to the left, a slight resistance has to be overcome.

Automatic transmission with Steptronic* In addition to fully automatic operation, you can also manually shift with the Steptronic, refer to page 59.

Vehicle parking To prevent the vehicle from rolling, always select position P and apply the

parking brake before leaving the vehicle with the engine running.<

Disengaging the remote control In order to remove the remote control from the ignition lock, you must first move the selector lever to position P and switch off the engine: interlock. Removing the remote control from the ignition lock, refer to page 55.

Selector lever positions P R N D M/S +

Displays in the instrument cluster

The selector lever position is displayed and, in manual mode, the engaged gear, e.g. M4.

Changing selector lever positions > With the ignition switched on or the engine

running, the selector lever can be moved out of position P.

> Before moving the lever away from P or N with the vehicle stationary, first depress the brake; otherwise, the selector lever will refuse to move: shiftlock.

To prevent the vehicle from creeping after you select a driving position,

depress the brake until you are ready to start.<

A lock prevents you from inadvertently engag- ing selector lever positions R and P. To cancel the lock, press the button on the front of the selector lever, see arrow.

P Park Select this only when the vehicle is stationary. The rear wheels are locked.

R Reverse Select this only when the vehicle is stationary.

N Neutral You can select this in a car wash, for example. The vehicle can roll.

D Drive, automatic position Position for normal vehicle operation. All for- ward gears are selected automatically.

Under normal operating conditions, fuel con- sumption is lowest when you are driving in posi- tion D.

Kickdown Kickdown enables you to achieve maximum performance. Press the accelerator pedal beyond the full- throttle resistance point.

C o

n tr

o ls

59

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Sport program and manual operation M/S

Move selector lever from position D toward the left into the M/S shifting slot; the Sport program is activated. This position is recommended for a performance-oriented driving style.

DS is displayed in the instrument cluster.

To deactivate the sport program or manual mode M/S, move the selector lever to the right into position D.

Shifting gears via the selector lever Move selector lever from position D toward the left into the M/S shifting slot: When you press the selector lever forwards or backwards, the manual mode is activated and Steptronic changes gear.

The engaged gear, e.g. M1 is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Upshifts and downshifts are executed only when they will result in a plausible combination of engine and vehicle speed; thus, for example, a downshift that would cause the engine to overrev will not be executed by the system.

The gear selected is briefly displayed in the instrument cluster, followed again by the gear actually in use.

Shifting gears via shift paddles* on the steering wheel The shift paddles allow you to shift gears quickly since both hands can remain on the steering wheel.

> When you use the shift paddles on the steering wheel to shift gears in automatic mode, the transmission switches to manual mode.

> If you do not accelerate or shift gears using the shift paddles for a certain amount of time, the transmission switches back to automatic mode.

If the selector lever is in the M/S gear plane, manual mode remains active.<

> To upshift, briefly pull the right shift paddle +.

> To downshift, briefly pull the left shift pad- dle .

Upshifts and downshifts are executed only when they will result in a plausible combination of engine and vehicle speed; thus, for example, a downshift that would cause the engine to overrev will not be executed by the system.

The gear selected is briefly displayed in the instrument cluster, followed again by the gear actually in use.

Overriding selector lever lock Should the selector lever refuse to move out of position P even though the ignition is switched on, the brake is depressed and the button on the selector lever is pressed, the selector lever lock can be overridden:

1. Unclip the sleeve of the selector lever.

2. Pull the sleeve up over the selector lever until the sleeve is inside out.

D ri

vi n

g

60

3. Using the screwdriver from the onboard vehicle tool kit, refer to page 233, press the red lever while moving the selector lever to the desired position.

7-gear Sports automatic transmission with double clutch*

The concept The 7-gear Sports automatic transmission with double clutch is an automated manual trans- mission with two clutches and secondary gear sets in which the clutching and shifting is han- dled by an electrohydraulic system. With the 7-gear Sports automatic transmission with double clutch, the gears are shifted without an interruption in driving power.

You operate the 7-gear Sports automatic trans- mission with double clutch using the selector lever and two shift paddles on the steering wheel.

It offers you the following functions:

> either manual or automatic mode: sequen- tial mode or drive mode

> automatic downshifting and protection against incorrect gear selection, even in sequential mode

> Launch Control, refer to page 64

> Automatic throttle blip

System limitations The 7-gear Sports automatic transmission with double clutch has an overheating protection that protects the clutch from extreme loads.

The indicator lamp lights up in yellow if the transmission becomes too warm. Avoid high engine loads and frequent

accelerations from zero. If the transmission is overheated, the indicator lamp lights up in red and the power flow to the motor is interrupted. It is only possible to continue driving once the transmission has cooled down.

Avoid frequent powerful accelerations from zero and do not hold the vehicle on inclines by pressing lightly on the accelerator while letting the clutch slip, as this may cause the transmis- sion to overheat.

Selector lever positions P R N D M/S +

Displays in the instrument cluster

The selector lever position and the engaged gear are displayed, e.g. M4.

Engaging selector lever positions > The selector lever can be moved out of

position P only with the engine running: interlock.

> Before moving the lever away from P or N with the vehicle stationary, first depress the brake; otherwise, the desired shift will not be executed: shiftlock.

C o

n tr

o ls

61

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Shifting into N, D, R

Briefly push the selector lever in the desired direction, overcoming a resistance point if nec- essary. When shifting out of P or into R, simul- taneously press the button 1.

The engaged selector lever position is also dis- played on the selector lever.

When you release the selector lever, it returns to its center position.

Shifting into P

Press the button P.

P Park Select this only when the vehicle is stationary. The rear wheels are locked.

The transmission is shifted into P if, with the engine running, you open the driver's

door, do not have your safety belt fastened, and subsequently actuate neither the brake pedal nor the accelerator.<

The transmission is shifted into P as soon as you switch off the engine, unless the

transmission is in N and the remote control is in the ignition lock, refer to page 230. As soon as you remove the remote control from the ignition lock, then the transmission is shifted into P.<

R Reverse Select this only when the vehicle is stationary.

N Neutral You can select this in a car wash, for example. The vehicle can roll.

After the engine is switched off, the trans- mission remains in N if you leave the

remote control in the ignition lock. You can use this function at a car wash, for example, refer to page 230.<

D Drive mode In Drive mode, all forward gears are shifted automatically.

Kickdown For sudden acceleration maneuvers such as passing, depress the accelerator past the resis- tance point. This provides maximum accelera- tion.

Sport program and manual operation M/S

Push selector lever toward the left from the selector lever position D, the Sport program is activated. This position is recommended for a performance-oriented driving style. The engaged gear, e.g. S1, is displayed in the instrument cluster.

When you press the selector lever forwards or backwards, the manual mode is activated and Steptronic changes gear. The engaged gear, e.g. M1 is displayed in the instrument cluster.

D ri

vi n

g

62

In the following situations, the 7-gear Sports automatic transmission with double clutch does the thinking for you:

> Upshifts and downshifts are executed only when they will result in a plausible combina- tion of engine and vehicle speed; thus, for example, a downshift that could cause the engine to overrev will not be executed by the system.

> At a stop, the transmission is automatically shifted down to the first gear.

> Shortly before the speed falls below a gear- dependent minimum speed, the transmis- sion automatically downshifts without your intervention.

Quick downshifting: Even in sequential mode, you can skip over several gears in order to achieve an optimum acceleration. To do so, depress the accelerator past the resistance point.

To return to automatic mode, push the selector lever to the right.

Gear shifting Upshift or downshift using the selector lever or the shift paddles. You do not need to lift your foot off the accelerator when doing so.

Using the selector lever > To upshift, pull the selector lever toward the

rear.

> To downshift, push it toward the front.

Using the shift paddles on the steering wheel You can also shift manually using two shift pad- dles on the steering wheel. The shift paddles allow you to shift gears quickly since both hands can remain on the steering wheel.

> When you use the shift paddles on the steering wheel to shift gears in automatic mode, the transmission switches to manual mode.

> If you do not accelerate or shift gears using the shift paddles for a certain amount of time, the transmission switches back to automatic mode if the selector lever is in position D.

> To upshift, briefly pull the right shift paddle +.

> To downshift, briefly pull the left shift pad- dle .

Driving dynamics control The driving dynamics control permits you, at the push of a button, to have your BMW react in an even more sporty fashion when driving:

> Optimal use is made of the engine's speed range.

> Gear changes occur more quickly.

> The engine reacts more spontaneously to accelerator pedal movements.

Activating the system

Press the SPORT button. The LED in the button lights up and SPORT appears in the info display.

C o

n tr

o ls

63

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Deactivating the system > Press the SPORT button again

> Switching off the engine

The LED in the button lights up and SPORT appears in the info display.

Manually unlocking parking lock In the event of a power supply interrup- tion such as a discharged or discon-

nected battery or an electrical malfunction, the parking lock must be manually unlocked; other- wise, the rear wheels are immobilized and the vehicle cannot be towed.<

Only unlock the parking lock manually for tow- ing and make sure to set the parking brake forcefully beforehand so that the vehicle cannot roll. Lock the parking lock again after the vehicle is parked.

Releasing 1. Unclip the sleeve of the selector lever.

2. Pull the sleeve up over the selector lever until the sleeve is inside out.

3. Using the allen wrench from the toolkit, refer to page 233, rotate the cover until it reaches the stop, arrow 1, and remove, arrow 2.

4. Insert allen wrench into the opening, arrow 1.

5. Rotate allen wrench until it reaches the stop, arrow 2. The parking lock is unlocked.

Do not turn allen wrench in the oppo- site direction; otherwise, you may

damage the mechanism.<

6. Remove allen wrench from the opening.

After parking the vehicle, lock the parking lock again. Otherwise, there is a danger

that the vehicle will roll.<

Locking 1. Press the button, see arrow.

The parking lock is locked again.

2. Replace cover again.

3. Clip the selector lever sleeve back into place.

4. Forcefully apply the parking brake.

Jump-starting and towing, starting on page 241.

D ri

vi n

g

64

Launch Control Launch Control enables an optimum accelera- tion when starting off on a road surface with good traction.

Do not use Launch Control too often; oth- erwise, the powerful stresses on the vehi-

cle will lead to premature component wear.<

Launch Control is available when the engine is at operating temperature, i.e. after driving con- tinuously for approx. 6.2 miles/10 km.

1. With the engine running, step on the brake with your left foot.

2. Activate Dynamic Traction Control (DTC), refer to page 90.

3. Activate Driving dynamics control, refer to page 62.

4. With the vehicle stationary, activate the manual mode and select 1st gear.

5. With your right foot, push the accelerator pedal past the resistance point. The engine speed for pulling away is adjusted. A flag symbol appears in the instrument cluster.

6. When you release the brake pedal, the vehi- cle accelerates. Keep the accelerator pedal floored.

7. The upshifting occurs automatically as long as you keep the accelerator pedal pressed past the resistance point.

Launch Control will be ready for use again after you drive a certain distance.

Launch Control is not available for use during the break-in phase, refer to page 126.

To maintain driving stability, keep DSC activated whenever possible.<

Turn signals/ headlamp flasher

1 High beams

2 Headlamp flasher

3 Turn signals

Using turn signals Press the lever beyond the resistance point.

To turn off manually, press the lever to the resistance point.

Unusually rapid flashing of the indicator lamp indicates that a turn signal indicator

has failed.<

Indicating a turn briefly Press the lever as far as the resistance point for as long as you wish to indicate a turn.

C o

n tr

o ls

65

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Triple turn signal activation Press the lever as far as the resistance point. The turn signals flash three times.

You can activate or deactivate this function.

1. "Settings"

2. "Lighting"

3. "Triple turn signal"

Triple turn signal activation is activated and is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Wiper system

1 Switching on wipers

2 Switching off wipers or brief wipe

3 Activating/deactivating intermittent wipe or rain sensor*

4 Cleaning windshield and headlamps* 5 Setting speed for intermittent wipe,

or sensitivity of the rain sensor

Switching on wipers Press the lever upward, arrow 1.

The lever automatically returns to its initial position when released.

Normal wiper speed Press once.

The system switches to operation in the inter- mittent mode when the vehicle is stationary.

Fast wiper speed Press twice or press beyond the resistance point. The system switches to normal speed when the vehicle is stationary.

Intermittent wipe or rain sensor* If the car is not equipped with a rain sensor, the intermittent-wipe time is a preset.

If the car is equipped with a rain sensor, the time between wipes is controlled automatically and depends on the intensity of the rainfall. The rain sensor is mounted on the windshield, directly in front of the interior rearview mirror.

Activating intermittent wipe or rain sensor

Press the button, arrow 3. The LED in the button lights up.

Setting speed for intermittent wipe or sensitivity of the rain sensor Turn thumbwheel 5 up or down.

Deactivating intermittent wipe or rain sensor Press the button again, arrow 3. The LED goes out.

Deactivate the rain sensor before enter- ing an automatic car wash. Failure to do

so could result in damage caused by undesired wiper activation.<

D ri

vi n

g

66

Cleaning windshield and headlamps* Pull the lever, arrow 4.

Washer fluid is sprayed onto the windshield and the wipers are operated for a short time.

When the vehicle lighting system is switched on, the headlamps are cleaned at regular and appropriate intervals.

Do not use the washers if there is any danger that the fluid will freeze on the

windshield. If you do, your vision could be obscured. Antifreeze should therefore be added to the fluid, refer to Washer fluid. Do not use the washers when the washer fluid reservoir is empty; otherwise, you will damage the washer pump.<

Windshield washer nozzles The windshield washer nozzles are heated automatically* while the engine is running or the ignition is switched on.

Washer fluid Washer fluid antifreeze is flammable. Therefore, keep it away from ignition

sources and only store it in the closed original container that is kept out of reach of children; otherwise, there is a risk of personal injury. Comply with the instructions on the con- tainer.<

Washer fluid filler neck Only refill washer fluid when the engine is cool to avoid contact with hot engine

parts. Otherwise, fluid spills constitute a fire hazard and a risk to personal safety.<

All washer nozzles are supplied with washer fluid by the same reservoir.

Fill with water and, if required, with a washer antifreeze, according to manufacturer's recom- mendations.

Mix the water and antifreeze before filling the washer fluid reservoir to make sure

the correct concentration is maintained.<

Capacity Approx. 6.3 US quarts/6 liters.

Cruise control*

The concept Cruise control is available for use at speeds of approx. 20 mph or 30 km/h. The car then stores and maintains the speed that you specify using the lever on the steering column. In order to maintain the specified speed, the system brakes the vehicle when the engine braking effect is insufficient on downhill gradients.

Do not use cruise control when driving at constant speed is prevented by adverse

conditions, e.g. winding roads, dense traffic or poor road conditions due to, e.g., snow, rain, ice or loose surfaces. Otherwise, you could lose control of the vehicle and cause an accident as a result.<

Manual transmission You can shift gears while cruise control is acti- vated. The system is deactivated when you drive at very low engine speeds for an extended period.

C o

n tr

o ls

67

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

One lever for all functions

1 Storing and maintaining speed or accelerat- ing

2 Storing and maintaining speed or deceler- ating

3 Deactivating cruise control

4 Resuming a speed stored beforehand

Maintaining current speed Tap the lever, arrow 1, or pull it briefly, arrow 2. The car's current speed is stored and main- tained. It is displayed on the speedometer and briefly in the instrument cluster.

On uphill gradients, it may prove impossible to maintain the set speed if current engine power output is insufficient. If the engine braking effect is insufficient on downhill slopes, the sys- tem will brake the vehicle slightly.

Increasing desired speed Repeatedly press the lever to the resistance point or beyond, arrow 1, until the desired speed is reached.

> Each time the lever is pressed to the resis- tance point, the desired speed is increased by approx. 1 mph or 1 km/h.

> Each time the lever is pressed beyond the resistance point, the desired speed is increased by up to 5 mph or 10 km/h.

The system stores and maintains the speed.

Accelerating using the lever Accelerating slightly:

Press the lever to the resistance point, arrow 1, until the desired speed is reached.

Accelerating significantly:

Press the lever beyond the resistance point, arrow 1, until the desired speed is reached.

The vehicle accelerates without pressure on the accelerator pedal. The system stores and maintains the speed.

Decreasing speed Repeatedly pull the lever to the resistance point or beyond, arrow 2, until the desired speed is displayed.

> Each time the lever is pulled to the resis- tance point, the desired speed is decreased by approx. 1 mph or 1 km/h.

> Each time the lever is pulled beyond the resistance point, the desired speed is reduced by up to 5 mph or 10 km/h until the minimum speed of 20 mph or 30 km/h is achieved.

The system stores and maintains the speed.

Deactivating cruise control Tap the lever upwards or downwards, arrow 3. The displays on the speedometer disappear.

In addition, the system is automatically deactivated:

> When you brake the vehicle

> When you switch gears very slowly or shift to neutral in cars with manual transmission

> When you select the automatic transmis- sion's neutral position N

> When you select the neutral position N with the Sports automatic transmission with double clutch

> When you activate DTC or deactivate DSC

> When DSC or ABS is intervening

Cruise control is not deactivated by depressing the accelerator pedal. Once the accelerator pedal is released, the stored speed is achieved again and maintained.

D ri

vi n

g

68

Warning lamp The warning lamp lights up when cruise control is deactivated due to control intervention by the DSC,

for example. A message appears on the Control Display.

Resuming a speed stored beforehand Press the button, arrow 4. The last stored speed is resumed and maintained.

In the following instances, the stored speed is deleted and can no longer be resumed:

> When driving stability control systems are intervening

> In cars with manual transmission: when you shift gears very slowly or shift to neutral

> In cars with automatic transmission: when you engage selector lever position N

> In cars with Sports automatic transmission with double clutch: when you engage selec- tor lever position N

> When the ignition is switched off

Displays in the instrument cluster

1 Stored speed

2 Selected speed is displayed briefly

If --- mph or --- km/h temporarily appears in the instrument cluster display, it is pos-

sible that the system prerequisites for operation are currently not met. Calling up Check Control messages, refer to page 85.<

Malfunction The warning lamp comes on when the system has failed. A message appears on the Control Display.

More information can be found beginning on page 84.

Active cruise control*

The concept With active cruise control, you can select a desired speed which is not only automatically maintained when driving on open roadways, but also varied to maintain a selected distance set- ting as slower traffic is encountered.

Active cruise control is a technological advance over the familiar cruise control and is a welcome relief from the constant adjustment of speed that can accompany driving in traffic on high- ways or other high-speed thoroughfares. Espe- cially on longer trips, the system can reduce fatigue and tension, while increasing your enjoyment of driving. Please use it safely and responsibly.

Within the limits of its capability, the system automatically adapts the car's speed to that of a slower vehicle in front of you. You can specify the distance to be maintained from the vehicle in front in four stages. For safety reasons, the distance is speed-dependent. Based on your selected distance setting, the system automat- ically decreases the throttle setting and lightly applies the brakes if necessary. The vehicle brake lamps will automatically illuminate to sig- nal a following driver to take action. In addition, it may be necessary for the vehicle or the driver to downshift, depending on the kind of trans- mission your vehicle is equipped with, to main- tain the distance setting selected. If the vehicle ahead speeds up or when the lane ahead becomes clear, your vehicle will accelerate to the speed you have selected by increasing the throttle setting and shifting gears automatically or by the driver as needed. Your selected speed will be held when driving downhill, too.

C o

n tr

o ls

69

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Since this active cruise control system is a new technology and operates differently from con- ventional cruise control systems which you may be accustomed to, you are strongly urged to read all of the pages relating to this system before use. Pay special attention to the System limitations section beginning on page 73.

Braking sensation > If you step on the brake pedal while the sys-

tem is braking, pedal sensation will be slightly different from the usual.

> Possible noises during automatic braking are normal.

Manual transmission You can shift gears while cruise control is acti- vated. The system is deactivated when you drive at very low engine speeds for an extended period.

Range of applications The minimum desired speed is 20 mph or 30 km/h, the maximum desired speed is 110 mph or 180 km/h.

As with conventional cruise control sys- tems, active cruise control in no way

diminishes or substitutes for the drivers own personal responsibility, alertness and aware- ness in adjusting speed, braking or otherwise controlling the vehicle. The driver should decide when to use the system on the basis of road, traffic, visibility, and weather conditions. Active cruise control is intended for use on highway-type roadways where traffic is moving relatively smoothly. Do not use this system in city driving; heavy traffic such as during rush hour; on curvy, winding roads, slippery roads or roads with sharp curves such as highway off- ramps; during inclement weather such as snow, strong rain or fog; or when entering inter- changes, service/parking areas or toll booths. It is also important to regulate your vehicle's speed and distance setting within applicable legal limits. Always be ready to take action or apply the brakes if necessary, especially when the system is actively following a vehicle in front

of you. Otherwise, driving situations could result that pose the risk of accidents.<

One lever for all functions

1 Store and increase desired speed

2 Store and decrease desired speed

3 Deactivate system, refer to page 70

4 Resume stored desired speed and dis- tance, refer to page 71

5 Select distance to vehicle driving ahead, refer to page 70

Storing current speed Briefly push lever, arrow 1, or pull lever, arrow 2, at a driving speed of more than approx. 20 mph or 30 km/h.

The car's current speed is stored. It is displayed on the speedometer and briefly in the instru- ment cluster.

D ri

vi n

g

70

Increasing desired speed Press or tap the lever to the resistance point or beyond, arrow 1, until the desired speed is displayed.

> Each time the lever is tapped to the resis- tance point, the desired speed is increased by approx. 1 mph or 1 km/h.

> Each time the lever is tapped beyond the resistance point, the desired speed is increased by up to 5 mph or 10 km/h until the maximum speed of 110 mph or 180 km/ h is achieved.

The speed then displayed is stored and achieved on a clear road.

Decreasing desired speed Pull the lever, arrow 2, until the desired speed is displayed.

The other functions work analogously to those described under Increasing desired speed.

Selecting distance

> Press downward: Increase distance.

> Press upward: Decrease distance.

The selected distance is displayed in the instrument cluster.

Use good judgment to select the appro- priate following distance given road con-

ditions, traffic, applicable laws and driving rec- ommendations for safe following distance. Otherwise, an accident risk could result.<

Deactivating cruise control

Press the lever upward or downward, arrow 3. The displays on the speedometer disappear.

In addition, the system is automatically deacti- vated:

> When you brake the vehicle

> When the speed is reduced to below 20 mph or 30 km/h due to a traffic situation

> When you switch gears very slowly or shift to neutral in cars with manual transmission

Distance 1

Distance 2

Distance 3

Distance 4 This is always the preset dis- tance when you use the system for the first time after starting the engine.

C o

n tr

o ls

71

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

> When you select the automatic transmis- sion's neutral position N

> When you select the neutral position N with the Sports automatic transmission with double clutch

> When you activate the Dynamic Traction Control DTC

> When you deactivate the Dynamic Stability Control DSC

> When DSC or ABS is intervening

> When the system does not recognize any objects for a longer period of time, e.g. on infrequently traveled roads without a shoul- der or guard rails, or if the radar sensor is covered with dirt, refer to page 72

> When you apply the parking brake

When the system is deactivated, you must brake the vehicle yourself and/or

maneuver as necessary; otherwise, there is a risk of accidents.<

Warning lamp The warning lamp comes on when active cruise control has been auto- matically deactivated, for example

due to a driving speed below 20 mph or 30 km/ h or a DSC intervention. A message appears on the Control Display.

Resuming stored desired speed and distance Briefly press the button, arrow 4. The stored speed and distance are regained and maintained.

In the following instances, the stored speed is deleted and can no longer be resumed:

> When driving stability control systems are intervening

> In cars with manual transmission: when you shift gears very slowly or shift to neutral

> In cars with automatic transmission: when you engage selector lever position N

> In cars with Sports automatic transmission with double clutch: when you engage selec- tor lever position N

> When the ignition is switched off

Displays in the instrument cluster

1 Stored desired speed

2 Shows yellow: vehicle detected ahead

Flashes in red: system cannot maintain dis- tance; driver must brake the vehicle

Flashes in yellow: driving stability control systems are intervening; cruise control is deactivated

3 Selected distance to vehicle ahead The indicator lights up as soon as the sys- tem is activated.

4 Selected desired speed is temporarily dis- played

If --- mph or --- km/h temporarily appears in the instrument cluster display, it is pos-

sible that the system prerequisites for operation are currently not met. Calling up Check Control messages, refer to page 85.<

D ri

vi n

g

72

Warning lamps The indicator 2 flashes in red; a signal sounds. The system indicates that you must brake and/or maneuver the vehicle yourself. Active cruise con-

trol cannot automatically restore the distance to the vehicle ahead. This indicator does not release you from your responsibility to adapt your desired speed and driving style to prevailing driving conditions.

The indicator 2 flashes in yellow. The prerequisites for operating active cruise control are not met, e.g. as a result of ABS or DSC interventions. Active cruise control

is deactivated. You can reactivate the system, if desired, by tapping or pulling the lever when road and traffic conditions permit. It is not pos- sible to resume a stored speed.

Radar sensor

The sensor's ability to detect vehicles ahead may be restricted as a result of heavy rain, dirt, snow or ice. If necessary, clean the radar sensor located in the front bumper, see arrow. Be sure to use particular care when removing any layers of snow or ice from the sensor.

The system cannot be activated if the sensor is incorrectly aligned.

For US owners only The transmitter and receiver units comply with part 15 of the FCC/Federal Communications Commission regulations. Operation is gov- erned by the following:

FCC ID: NF3 ACC2SCU 003YK04001 0000

Compliance statement: This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:

> This device must not cause harmful inter- ference, and

> this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

Any unauthorized modifications or changes to these devices could void the

users authority to operate this equipment.<

Malfunction The warning lamp comes on when the system has failed. A message appears on the Control Display. More

information can be found beginning on page 84.

C o

n tr

o ls

73

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

System limitations

Always remember that the range and abil- ity of the system does have physical limi-

tations. It will not apply the brakes or decelerate your vehicle when there is a slow-moving vehi- cle, stopped vehicle or stationary object ahead of you, as for example, at a traffic light or a parked vehicle. Also, the system does not react to oncoming traffic, pedestrians or other types of potential traffic such as a rider on horseback. It is also possible that the system may not detect smaller moving objects such as motor- cycles or bicycles. Be especially alert when encountering any of these situations as the sys- tem will neither automatically brake, nor provide a warning to you. Also, be aware that every decrease in the distance setting allows your vehicle to come closer to a vehicle in front of you and requires a heightened amount of alert- ness.<

Active cruise control is not and must not be used as a collision avoidance/warning

system.<

If while your vehicle is actively following a vehi- cle in front of you and the vehicle ahead speeds up or the lane ahead becomes clear, then your vehicle will accelerate to the speed you have selected. Be aware that changing to a clear, unobstructed lane will also result in your vehicle accelerating.

Be certain to deactivate the system when you pull into an exit lane for a highway off-

ramp.<

Also, vehicles traveling in a staggered manner on a highway may cause a delay in the system's reaction to a vehicle in front of you or may cause the system to react to a vehicle actually in the

lane next to you. Always be ready to take action or apply the brakes if necessary.

While active cruise control is capable of braking your vehicle automatically when

you approach a slower vehicle ahead, it is important to be aware that the ability of the sys- tem to apply the brakes is also limited, e.g. when you reduce your desired speed sharply. The system cannot stop your vehicle. It uses only a portion of braking system capacity and does not utilize the full capacity of the vehicle braking system. Therefore, the system cannot decrease your speed for large differences in speed between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead. Examples: when you approach a vehicle traveling at a much lower speed than your own speed such as approaching a toll booth or when a much slower vehicle cuts in front of you at close range.<

Active cruise control can only decelerate the vehicle to approx. 20 mph or 30 km/h.

D ri

vi n

g

74

Swerving vehicles

When a vehicle moves from an adjacent lane into your lane, active cruise control will not rec- ognize this vehicle until it is fully in your lane ahead of your vehicle.

When a vehicle ahead suddenly swerves into your lane, the system may not be able

to maintain the selected distance automatically. This also applies to great differences in speed between you and vehicles ahead, e.g. when quickly approaching a truck. There is a risk of collision. Once the system has established that a vehicle is indeed in front of you, it will indicate that you must brake and/or maneuver the vehi- cle yourself. Take action yourself; otherwise, there is a risk of an accident.<

Behavior in curves

Because of the limited range of the system, it is possible that in curves or on the peaks and val- leys of hilly roads, a vehicle ahead may be rec- ognized late, or not at all. Therefore, it is up to the driver to select a speed that is prudent in view of the curves and terrain of the roadway.

In approaching a curve, it is possible that active cruise control would react briefly to a vehicle in the adjacent lane. In addition, the system can sense if your vehicle is in a curve and may not accelerate. If your vehicle decelerates in either case, you can choose to overcome the deceler- ation by briefly pressing the accelerator pedal.

Your responsibility Your actions have priority at all times. When you press the accelerator pedal while driving with active cruise control, the automatic braking function will be temporarily interrupted. Once you release the accelerator pedal, the desired speed or the selected distance to the vehicle ahead is achieved again.

Do not leave your foot on the accelerator pedal and make sure that no objects such

as floor mats are lying on the accelerator pedal. Otherwise, the system may not be able to brake the vehicle.<

C o

n tr

o ls

75

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Controls overview

Odometer, outside temperature display, clock

1 Knob in the instrument cluster

2 Outside temperature display and clock

3 Odometer and trip odometer

Knob in the instrument cluster > To reset the trip odometer while the ignition

is switched on

> To display the time, outside temperature and odometer briefly while the ignition is switched off

Units of measure To select the respective units of measure, miles or km for the odometer as well as 7 or 6 for the outside temperature, refer to page 80.

The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Time, outside temperature display Setting the time, refer to page 83.

Outside temperature warning When the displayed temperature sinks to approx. +377/+36, a signal sounds and a warning lamp lights up. There is an increased risk of black ice.

Black ice can also form at temperatures above +377/+36. You should there-

fore drive carefully on bridges and shaded roads, for example; otherwise, there is an increased risk of an accident.<

Odometer and trip odometer Resetting the trip odometer: With the ignition switched on, press button 1 in the instrument cluster.

When the vehicle is parked If you still want to view the time, outside tem- perature and odometer reading briefly after the remote control has been taken out of the igni- tion lock: Press button 1 in the instrument cluster.

Tachometer

Never force the engine speed up into the red warning field, see arrow. In this range, the fuel supply is interrupted to protect the engine.

C o

n tr

o ls

o ve

rv ie

w

76

Coolant temperature A warning lamp will come on if the coolant, and therefore the engine, becomes too hot. In addition, a message will appear on the Control Display.

Check coolant level, refer to page 226.

Engine oil temperature*

When the engine is at normal operating temper- ature, the engine oil temperature is between approx. 2107/1006 and approx. 3007/ 1506.

If the engine oil temperature is too high, a mes- sage appears on the Control Display.

Fuel gauge

Fuel tank capacity: approx. 16.1 gallons/ 61 liters.

You can find information on refueling on page 207.

If the tilt of the vehicle varies for a longer period, when you are driving in mountainous areas, for example, the indicator may fluctuate slightly.

Reserve Once the fuel level has fallen to the reserve zone, a message briefly appears on the Control Display and the cruising range for the remaining amount of fuel is displayed on the computer. Under a cruising range of approx. 30 miles/ 50 km, the message remains in the Control Display.

Refuel as soon as possible once your cruising range falls below 30 miles/

50 km; otherwise, engine functions are not ensured and damage can occur.<

Computer

Displays in the instrument cluster

Calling up information

Press the button in the turn indicator lever.

The following items of information are dis- played in the order listed:

> Cruising range

> Average speed

> Average fuel consumption

> Current fuel consumption* > No information

To set the corresponding units of measure, refer to Units of measure on page 80.

C o

n tr

o ls

77

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Cruising range Displays the estimated cruising range available with the remaining fuel. The range is calculated on the basis of the way the car has been driven over the last 18 miles/30 km and the amount of fuel currently in the tank.

Refuel as soon as possible once your cruising range falls below 30 miles/

50 km; otherwise, engine functions are not ensured and damage can occur.<

Average speed Periods with the vehicle parked and the engine switched off are not included in the calculations of average speed.

With the trip computer, refer to page 78, you can have the average speed for another trip dis- played.

To reset average speed: press the button in the turn indicator lever for approx. 2 seconds.

Average fuel consumption The average fuel consumption is calculated for the time during which the engine is running.

You can have the average consumption for another trip displayed, refer to Displays on the Control Display below.

To reset average fuel consumption: press the button in the turn indicator lever for approx. 2 seconds.

Current fuel consumption Displays the current fuel consumption. This allows you to see whether your current driving style is conducive to fuel economy with mini- mum exhaust emissions.

Displays on the Control Display The computer can also be opened via iDrive.

1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Onboard info" or "Trip computer"

Displays on the "Onboard info":

> Cruising range

> Distance from destination

> Estimated time of arrival if:

> A distance was manually entered in the computer, refer to the information below.

> A destination was entered in the naviga- tion system*, refer to page 135.

C o

n tr

o ls

o ve

rv ie

w

78

Displays on the "Trip computer":

> Departure time

> Trip duration

> Trip distance

Both displays show:

> The average speed and

> the average fuel consumption.

Resetting the fuel consumption and speed You can reset the values for average speed and average consumption:

1. Select the respective menu item and press the controller.

2. Press the controller again to confirm your selection.

Resetting the trip computer You can reset all values:

1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Trip computer"

3. "Reset"

C o

n tr

o ls

79

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Settings and information

Operating principle

1 Button for:

> Selecting display

> Setting values

2 Button for:

> Confirming selected display or set val- ues

> Calling up computer information 76

3 When the lights are on: instrument lighting brightness 105

4 Calling up Check Control 84

5 Checking engine oil level 223

6 Setting the time 83

7 Setting the date 84

8 Viewing service requirement display 80

Exiting displays The outside temperature reading and the time reappear when you press button 2 or if you make no entries within approx. 15 seconds. If required, complete the current setting first.

C o

n tr

o ls

o ve

rv ie

w

80

Units of measure

Setting the units of measure You can change the units for fuel consumption, route/distance, temperature and pressure.

1. "Settings"

2. "Language/Units"

3. Select the desired menu item.

4. Select the desired unit.

The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Service requirements

The remaining driving distance and the date of the next scheduled service are displayed briefly immediately after you start the engine or switch on the ignition.

The extent of service work required can be read out from the remote control by

your BMW Service Advisor.<

For certain maintenance operations, you can view the respective distance remaining or due date individually in the instrument cluster.

1. Switch on the ignition, refer to page 55.

2. Push button 1 in the turn indicator lever up or down repeatedly until the appropriate symbol appears in the display, accompa- nied by the words "SERVICE-INFO".

3. Press button 2.

4. Use button 1 to scroll through the individual service items.

C o

n tr

o ls

81

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Possible displays

1 Button for selecting functions

2 Service requirements

3 Engine oil

4 Roadworthiness test* 5 Front brake pads

6 Rear brake pads

7 Brake fluid

The sequence of displayed service items may vary. The data for the next service appointment is shown first.

More information

Detailed information on service requirements You can call up additional information on the maintenance regimen on the Control Display.

1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Vehicle status"

3. "Service required"

Required maintenance procedures and legally mandated inspections are displayed.

You can request more detailed information on every entry:

Select the entry and press the controller.

To exit from the menu: Move the controller to the left.

Symbols No service is currently required.

The deadline for service or a legally mandated inspection is approaching.

Please schedule a service appointment.

The service deadline has already passed.

C o

n tr

o ls

o ve

rv ie

w

82

Entering deadlines for legally required inspections* Make sure the date on the Control Display is set correctly, refer to page 84; otherwise, the effec- tiveness of CBS Condition Based Service is not ensured.

1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Vehicle status"

3. "Service required"

4. " Vehicle inspection"

5. Open the menu for entering the deadline.

6. "Date:"

7. Create the settings.

8. Press the controller to apply the setting. The year is highlighted.

9. Turn the controller to make the adjustment.

10. Press the controller to apply the setting. The date entry is stored.

To exit from the menu: Move the controller to the left.

More information on the BMW Maintenance System can be found on page 227.

Automatic Service Request* Data regarding the maintenance status or legally mandated inspections of the vehicle are automatically transmitted to your BMW center prior to a service due date.

You can check when your BMW center was notified.

1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Vehicle status"

3. "Options"

4. "Last Service Request"

C o

n tr

o ls

83

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Clock The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use, refer also to Personal Profile on page 26.

Setting the time

In the instrument cluster To set the 12h/24h mode, refer to Setting the time format below.

1. Push button 1 in the turn indicator lever up or down repeatedly until the appropriate symbol appears in the display, accompa- nied by the time and the word "SET".

2. Press button 2.

3. Use button 1 to set the hours.

4. Press button 2 to confirm the entry.

5. Use button 1 to set the minutes.

6. Press button 2 to confirm the entry.

7. Press button 2. The system accepts the new time.

Via iDrive 1. Press the MENU button.

The main menu is displayed.

2. "Settings"

Setting the time 1. "Settings"

2. "Time/Date"

3. "Time:"

4. Turn the controller until the desired hours are displayed, and then press the controller.

5. Turn the controller until the desired minutes are displayed, and then press the controller.

The time is stored.

Setting the time format 1. "Settings"

2. "Time/Date"

3. "Format:"

4. Select the desired format and press the controller.

The time format is stored.

C o

n tr

o ls

o ve

rv ie

w

84

Date The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use, refer also to Personal Profile on page 26.

Setting the date

In the instrument cluster To set the dd/mm or mm/dd date format, refer to Setting the date format below.

1. Push button 1 in the turn indicator lever up or down repeatedly until the appropriate symbol appears in the display, accompa- nied by the date and the word "SET".

2. Press button 2.

3. Use button 1 to set the day of the month.

4. Press button 2 to confirm the entry.

5. Set the month and the year in the same way.

6. Press button 2. The system stores the new date.

Via iDrive 1. "Settings"

2. "Time/Date"

3. "Date:"

4. Turn the controller until the desired day is displayed, and press the controller.

5. Create the necessary settings for the month and year.

The date is stored.

Setting the date format 1. "Settings"

2. "Time/Date"

3. "Format:"

4. Select the desired format.

The date format is stored.

Check Control

The concept The Check Control monitors vehicle functions and alerts you to any malfunctions in the sys- tems monitored. This type of Check Control message includes indicator and warning lamps in the instrument cluster and, in some cases, an acoustic signal and text messages at the top of the Control Display.

Indicator and warning lamps

Indicator and warning lamps can light up in a variety of combinations and colors.

Several of the lamps are checked for proper functioning and light up temporarily when the engine is started or the ignition is switched on.

C o

n tr

o ls

85

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

indicates that Check Control messages have been stored. These Check Control messages can be viewed again later, refer to page 85.

Text messages Text messages at the upper edge of the Control Display explain the meaning of the displayed indicator and warning lamps.

Supplementary text messages You can call up more information on the Control Display, e.g. on the cause of a malfunction and on how to respond, via Check Control.

The text of urgent messages is displayed auto- matically.

To exit the display: Select "OK" and press the controller.

Hiding Check Control messages

Press the button on the turn indicator lever.

> Some Check Control messages are dis- played continuously and remain visible until the malfunction has been rectified. If several malfunctions occur at once, the messages are displayed consecutively. These messages can be hidden for approx. 8 seconds. After this, they are displayed again automatically.

They are marked with the symbol shown here.

> Other Check Control messages are hidden automatically after approx. 20 seconds. They are stored and can be displayed again later.

They are marked with the symbol shown here.

Displaying stored Check Control messages

1. Push button 1 in the turn indicator lever up or down repeatedly until the appropriate symbol appears in the display, accompa- nied by the words "CHECK CONTROL".

2. Press button 2. "CHECK OK" appears if there are no Check Control messages. If a Check Control message has been stored, the corresponding lamp comes on. It is accompanied by a text message on the Control Display.

3. Push button 1 to check for other messages.

4. Press button 2. The display again shows the outside tem- perature and the time.

C o

n tr

o ls

o ve

rv ie

w

86

Via iDrive 1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Vehicle status"

3. "Check Control"

4. Select the text message.

Speed limit You can enter a speed, and a Check Control message will indicate when you reach this speed. This enables you, for example, to receive warnings if you exceed a speed limit in an urban area. You are only warned of reaching this speed a second time if your vehicle speed falls below it again by at least 3 mph or 5 km/h.

Displaying, setting or changing the limit 1. "Settings"

2. "Speed"

3. "Warning at:"

4. Turn the controller until the desired speed is displayed.

5. Press the controller.

The speed limit is stored.

Applying your current speed as the limit 1. "Settings"

2. "Speed"

3. "Select current speed"

4. Press the controller.

The system adopts your current speed as the limit.

Activating/deactivating the limit 1. "Settings"

2. "Speed"

3. "Warning"

4. Press the controller.

The limit warning is switched on.

C o

n tr

o ls

87

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Settings on the Control Display

Language on the Control Display

Setting the language 1. "Settings"

2. "Language/Units"

3. "Language:"

4. Select the desired language.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Setting the voice dialog Switch between a standard dialog and a short dialog.

1. "Settings"

2. "Language/Units"

3. "Speech mode:"

4. Select the desired dialog.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Brightness of the Control Display The brightness is automatically adapted to the ambient lighting conditions. However, you can change the basic setting.

1. "Settings"

2. "Control display"

3. "Brightness"

4. Turn the controller until the desired setting is selected.

5. Press the controller.

The setting is stored for the remote control currently in use. In bright conditions, for exam- ple, the brightness control may not be clearly visible.

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r d

ri vi

n g

c o

m fo

rt a

n d

s af

et y

88

Technology for driving comfort and safety

Park Distance Control PDC*

The concept The PDC assists you with maneuvering in tight parking spaces. Acoustic signals and a visual indicatorwarn you of the presence of an object in front of* or behind your vehicle. To measure the distance, there are four ultrasonic sensors in either bumper.

These sensors have a range of approx. 6.5 ft/ 2 m. However, an acoustic warning does not sound until the sensors at the front* and at the two rear corners are approx. 24 in/60 cm away from the object and the middle rear sensors are approx. 5 ft/1,50 m away from it.

PDC is a parking aid that can indicate objects when they are approached

slowly, as is usually the case when parking. Avoid approaching an object at high speed; oth- erwise, physical circumstances may lead to the system warning being issued too late.<

Switching on automatically With the engine running or the ignition switched on, the system is activated after approx. one second when you shift into reverse or move the automatic transmission selector lever to position R. Wait this short period before driving.

Switching off automatically After approx. 55 yd/50 m of driving or above approx. 20 mph/approx. 30 km/h, the system switches off and the LED goes out.

Switching on manually*

Press the button; the LED lights up.

Switching off manually* Press the button again; the LED goes out.

Signal tones When nearing an object, its position is indicated correspondingly by an interval tone. For exam- ple, if an object is detected behind the vehicle, the signal tone sounds from the rear. As the dis- tance between vehicle and object decreases, the intervals between the tones become shorter. If the distance to the nearest object falls to below roughly 1 ft/30 cm, then a contin- uous tone sounds.

An interval tone is interrupted after approx. 3 seconds

> If you remain in front of an object that has been detected by only one of the corner sensors

> If you are driving parallel to a wall.

C o

n tr

o ls

89

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Malfunction The indicator lamp in the instrument cluster comes on. PDC is malfunc- tioning. A message appears on the

Control Display. Have the system checked.

To avoid this problem, keep the sensors clean and free of ice or snow in order to ensure that they will continue to operate effectively. When using a high-pressure cleaner, do not spray the sensors for extended periods of time and only from a distance of at least 1 ft/30 cm.

Manual operation* The LED above the button also flashes.

PDC with visual warning The approach of the vehicle to an object is shown on the Control Display. Objects that are farther away are displayed on the Control Dis- play before a signal tone sounds. The display appears on the Control Display as soon as PDC is activated.

System limitations Even with PDC, final responsibility for estimating the distance between the

vehicle and any obstructions always remains with the driver. Even when sensors are pro- vided, there is a blind spot in which objects can no longer be detected. The system is also sub- ject to the physical limits that apply to all forms of ultrasonic measurement, such as those encountered with trailer towbars and hitches, thin or wedge-shaped objects, etc. Low objects that have already been displayed, e.g. curbs, can disappear again from the detection area of the sensors before or after a continuous tone sounds. Higher, protruding objects, e.g. ledges, cannot be detected. Therefore, always drive cautiously; otherwise, there is a risk of personal injury or property damage. Loud sound sources outside or inside the car can drown out the PDC signal. Therefore, always drive cautiously; otherwise, there is a risk of personal injury or property damage.<

Driving stability control systems Your BMW has a number of systems that help to maintain the vehicle's stability even in adverse driving conditions.

Antilock Brake System ABS ABS prevents locking of the wheels during braking. Safe steering response is maintained even during full braking. Active safety is thus increased.

The ABS is operational every time you start the engine. Braking safely, refer to page 128.

Electronic brake-force distribution EBV The system controls the brake pressure in the rear wheels to ensure stable braking behavior.

Dynamic Brake Control DBC When you apply the brakes rapidly, this system automatically produces the maximum braking force boost and thus helps to achieve the short- est possible braking distance during full brak- ing. This system exploits all of the benefits pro- vided by ABS.

Do not reduce the pressure on the brake for the duration of the full braking application.

Dynamic Stability Control DSC DSC prevents the driving wheels from losing traction when you pull away from rest or accel- erate. The system also recognizes unstable driving conditions, for example if the rear of the car is about to swerve or if momentum is acting at an angle past the front wheels. In these cases, DSC helps the vehicle maintain a safe course within physical limits by reducing engine output and through braking actions at the indi- vidual wheels.

The laws of physics cannot be repealed, even with DSC. An appropriate driving

style always remains the responsibility of the driver. Therefore, do not reduce the additional safety margin again by taking risks, as this could result in an accident.<

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r d

ri vi

n g

c o

m fo

rt a

n d

s af

et y

90

Deactivating DSC

Press the button for at least 3 seconds; the indi- cator lamps for DSC in the instrument cluster light up. Dynamic Traction Control DTC and DSC have been simultaneously deactivated. Stabilizing and drive-output promoting actions are no longer executed.

In the same way as with a differential interlock*, even if DSC is deactivated, brake actions are still performed to enhance drive output if the drive wheels experience a significant loss of traction.

To increase vehicle stability, activate DSC again as soon as possible.

Activating DSC Press the button again; the indicator lamps in the instrument cluster go out.

For better control If the indicator lamp flashes: DSC is regulating the drive and brak- ing forces.

If the indicator lamps are on: DSC is deactivated.

Dynamic Traction Control DTC DTC is a version of DSC in which the drive out- put is optimized for particular road conditions, e.g. unplowed snow-covered roads. The sys- tem assures the maximal drive output, but with reduced driving stability. It is therefore neces- sary to drive with appropriate caution.

You may find it useful to briefly activate DTC under the following special circumstances:

> When driving uphill on snow-covered roads, in slush or on unplowed, snow-covered roads

> When rocking a stuck vehicle free or start- ing off in deep snow or on loose ground

> When driving with snow chains

Activating DTC

Press the button; the indicator lamps for DTC in the instrument cluster come on.

For better control If the indicator lamp flashes: DTC is regulating the drive and braking forces.

If the indicator lamps are on: DTC has been activated.

Deactivating DTC Press the button again; the DTC indicator lamps in the instrument cluster go out.

xDrive* xDrive is your BMW's four-wheel-drive system. The combined efforts of xDrive and DSC help to further optimize traction and driving dynamics. The xDrive four-wheel-drive system distributes driving power variably to the front and rear axles depending on the driving situation and road conditions.

C o

n tr

o ls

91

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Hill Descent Control HDC* HDC is a downhill driving assistant that controls your speed on steep downhill gradients and makes it even easier to control your BMW's handling under these conditions. The vehicle then moves slightly faster than double walking speed without the driver needing to intervene.

HDC can be activated as long as you are driving under approx. 20 mph or 35 km/h. When driving downhill at a speed of under approx. 20 mph or 35 km/h, the vehicle's speed is automatically reduced to slightly more than double walking speed and maintained.

Increasing or decreasing speed By accelerating or braking you can change this speed within a range from approx. 3 to 15 mph, approx. 5 to 25 km/h. You can specify a target speed within the same range using the cruise control* lever on the steering column.

1 To increase speed

2 To decrease speed

Activating HDC

Press the button; the LED lights up. When the vehicle is being braked automatically, the LED flashes.

Deactivating HDC Press the button again; the LED goes out.

HDC is automatically deactivated at speeds greater than approx. 35 mph/60 km/h.

Using HDC In cars with manual transmission: Use HDC in lower gears and in reverse gear.

With automatic transmission: You can use HDC in any drive position.

Displays in the instrument cluster*

1 Display for target speed

2 HDC display

Malfunction The HDC display disappears during HDC oper- ation, or does not appear: HDC is temporarily unavailable due to exces- sive brake temperature, or DSC has failed.

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r d

ri vi

n g

c o

m fo

rt a

n d

s af

et y

92

Drive-off assistant The drive-off assistant enables you to drive off smoothly on uphill gradients. It is not necessary to use the parking brake for this.

1. Hold the car in place by depressing the brake.

2. Release the brake and drive off without delay.

The drive-off assistant holds the car in place for approx. 2 seconds after the

brake is released. Drive off without delay after releasing the brake. Otherwise, the drive-off assistant will no longer hold the car in place after approx. 2 seconds and the car will start to roll backwards.<

Flat Tire Monitor FTM*

The concept The system does not measure the actual infla- tion pressure in the tires.

The system detects a tire pressure loss due to speed comparisons among the individual wheels as you drive.

In the event of pressure loss, the rolling circum- ference changes and, thus, the rotating speed of the affected wheel. The system detects this and reports it as a flat tire.

Functional requirement The system has to have been initialized at the correct inflation pressure; otherwise, a reliable reporting of a flat tire is not assured.

Each time a tire inflation pressure has been cor- rected or a wheel or tire has been changed, reinitialize the system.

System limitations It is impossible to provide advance warn- ing of sudden, severe tire damage caused

by outside influences.<

The system will not detect a natural, uniform pressure loss in all four tires. Therefore you should check the inflation pressure regularly.

In the following situations, the system could be delayed or malfunction:

> System has not been initialized

> Driving on snowy or slippery road surface

> Performance-oriented style of driving: slip in the drive wheels, high lateral acceleration

> Driving with snow chains*

Status display The current status of the Flat Tire Monitor can be displayed on the Control Display, e.g. whether or not the FTM is active.

1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Vehicle status"

3. "Flat Tire Monitor"

The status is displayed.

C o

n tr

o ls

93

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Initialization In the initialization, the set inflation pressures are adopted as reference values for the detec- tion of a flat tire. The initialization is begun by confirmation of the inflation pressures.

Do not initialize the system while snow chains are attached.

1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Vehicle status"

3. "Reset"

4. Start the engine do not drive away.

5. Start the initialization using "Reset".

6. Start driving.

The initialization is completed during driv- ing, which can be interrupted at any time.

When driving resumes, the initialization is con- tinued automatically.<

Indication of a flat tire The warning lamps come on in yellow and red. A message appears on the Control Display. In addition, an acoustic signal sounds. There is a flat

tire or substantial loss of tire pressure.

What to do in case of a flat tire

Run-flat tires With a damaged tire, is possible to continue driving at speeds of up to 50 mph/80 km/h.

Do not continue driving if the vehicle is not equipped with run-flat tires, refer to

page 220; continued driving could result in a severe accident.<

When continuing to drive with a damaged tire:

1. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneu- vers.

2. Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

3. At the next opportunity, check the air pres- sure in all four tires.

If all four tires are inflated to the cor- rect pressures, the Flat Tire Monitor

might not have been initialized. The system must then be initialized.<

Possible travel distance with complete tire pressure loss:

> With a light load: 1 to 2 persons without luggage: Approx. 155 miles/250 km

> With a medium load: 2 persons, cargo area full, or 4 persons without luggage: Approx. 94 miles/150 km

> With a full load: 4 persons, cargo area full: Approx. 30 miles/50 km

Drive cautiously and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

When there is a tire pressure loss, the handling characteristics change, e.g. there will be reduced directional stability during braking, braking distances will be longer, and self-steer- ing response will change.<

Vibrations or loud noises during driving may indicate the final failure of the tire.

Reduce your speed and bring the vehicle to a stop; otherwise, tire components may become detached, which could result in an accident. Do not continue driving; instead, contact your BMW center.<

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r d

ri vi

n g

c o

m fo

rt a

n d

s af

et y

94

Tire Pressure Monitor TPM*

The concept Check the inflation pressure in the four installed tires. The system notifies you if there is a signif- icant loss of pressure in one or more tires.

Functional requirement The system has to have been reset at the cor- rect inflation pressure; otherwise, a reliable reporting of a flat tire is not assured.

Always use wheels with TPM electronics to assure a trouble-free function of the system.

Each time a tire inflation pressure has been corrected or a wheel or tire has been

changed, reset the system.<

System limitations It is impossible to provide advance warn- ing of sudden, severe tire damage caused

by outside influences.<

The system does not function correctly if it has not been reset. For example, a flat tire may be indicated even though the tire inflation pres- sures are correct.

The system is inactive and cannot indicate a flat tire:

> when a wheel without TPM electronics is installed.

> when other systems or devices that use the same radio frequency interfere with TPM.

Status display The current status of the TPM Tire Pressure Monitor can be displayed on the Control Dis- play, e.g. whether or not the TPM is active.

1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Vehicle status"

3. "Tire Pressure Monitor - TPM"

The status is displayed.

Status indicator on the Control Display The color of the tires represents the status of the tires and the system.

A change in the inflation pressure during driving is taken into account.

A correction is only needed if TPM indicates it.

Green The inflation pressure corresponds to the desired state.

"TPM active" appears on the Control Display.

One wheel yellow There is a flat tire or substantial loss of tire pres- sure in the indicated tire.

All wheels yellow > There is a flat tire or substantial loss of tire

pressure in several tires.

> The system was not reset after a wheel change and will thus issue warnings at the last initialized inflation pressures.

C o

n tr

o ls

95

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Gray The system cannot detect a puncture.

The reasons for this are as follows:

> TPM is being reset.

> Interference from systems or devices that use the same radio frequency.

> Malfunction.

Resetting the system Each time a tire inflation pressure has been corrected or a wheel or tire has been changed, reset the system.

1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Vehicle status"

3. "Reset TPM"

4. Start the engine do not drive away.

5. Start the initialization using "Reset TPM".

6. Start driving.

The tires are shown in gray and "Resetting TPM..." is displayed.

After driving a few minutes, the set inflation pressures in the tires are accepted as the target values to be monitored. The resetting is com- pleted automatically as you drive. On the Con- trol Display, the tires are shown in green and "Status: TPM active" is displayed again.

You can stop driving at any time. The resetting continues automatically when you resume driv- ing.

If a flat tire is detected during the reset- ting process, all tires are displayed in

yellow in the Control Display. The message "Low tire!" is shown.<

Message for low tire inflation pressure The warning lamps come on in yellow and red. A message appears on the Control Display. In addition, a signal sounds.

> There is a flat tire or substantial loss of tire pressure.

> The system was not reset after a wheel change and will thus issue warnings at the last initialized inflation pressures.

Cautiously reduce speed to below 50 mph/ 80 km/h. Avoid sudden braking and steering maneuvers. Do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/ 80 km/h.

Do not continue driving if the vehicle is not equipped with run-flat tires, refer to

page 220; continued driving could result in a severe accident.<

Continuing to drive with a flat tire Possible travel distance with complete tire pressure loss:

> With a light load: 1 to 2 persons without luggage: Approx. 155 miles/250 km

> With a medium load: 2 persons, cargo area full, or 4 persons without luggage: Approx. 95 miles/150 km

> With a full load: 4 persons, cargo area full: Approx. 30 miles/50 km

Drive cautiously and do not exceed a speed of 50 mph/80 km/h.

When there is a tire pressure loss, the handling characteristics change, e.g. there will be reduced directional stability during braking, braking distances will be longer, and self-steer- ing response will change.<

Vibrations or loud noises during driving may indicate the final failure of the tire.

Reduce your speed and bring the vehicle to a stop; otherwise, tire components may become detached, which could result in an accident. Do not continue driving; instead, contact your BMW center.<

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r d

ri vi

n g

c o

m fo

rt a

n d

s af

et y

96

Message for unsuccessful system reset

Yellow warning lamp comes on. A message appears on the Control Display.

The system is not reset, e.g. after a wheel change.

Check the tire inflation pressure and reset the system, refer to page 95.

Malfunction The small warning lamp flashes in yellow and then lights up continu- ously; the large warning lamp comes on in yellow. The tires appear in gray

in the Control Display. No punctures can be detected.

Display in the following situations:

> Malfunction Have the system checked.

> A wheel without TPM electronics has been installed: Have it checked by your BMW center.

> Interference from systems or devices that use the same radio frequency: The system automatically becomes active again when the vehicle moves out of the interference zone.

Declaration according to NHTSA/ FMVSS 138 Tire Pressure Monitoring Systems Each tire should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recom- mended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire infla- tion pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires. As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring sys- tem, TPMS, that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires are signif- icantly underinflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should

stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicles han- dling and stopping ability. Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire mainte- nance, and it is the drivers responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if underin- flation has not reached the level at which the TPMS low tire pressure telltale illuminates.

The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the sys- tem detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously lit. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle startups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function properly.

Active steering*

The concept Active steering varies the turning angle of the front wheels in relation to steering wheel move- ments. It also varies the steering force required to turn the wheels depending on the speed at which you are driving.

When you are driving in the low road speed range, e.g. in a town or when parking, the steer- ing angle is increased, i.e. steering becomes very direct and less effort is required to turn the wheels. In the higher speed range, on the other hand, the steering angle is reduced as the speed increases. This improves the handling of your BMW over the entire speed range.

C o

n tr

o ls

97

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

In critical situations, the system can make tar- geted corrections to the steering angle pro- vided by the driver and thus stabilize the vehicle before the driver intervenes. This stabilizing intervention is simultaneously deactivated when DSC is switched off, refer to page 90.

Malfunction The warning lamps light up and a message is displayed on the Control Display. Active steering is malfunc- tioning or is temporarily deactivated.

At low speeds, greater steering wheel move- ments are required, whereas at higher speeds the vehicle reacts more sensitively to steering wheel movements. The stability-enhancing feature may also be deactivated. Drive cau- tiously and think well ahead.

Deactivation Active steering is deactivated to perform an ini- tialization. A message indicates that the feature is deactivated. Initialization may take several minutes.

If the message does not disappear during the current trip, have the system checked.

Defect If there is a defect, a corresponding text mes- sage appears. Have the system checked.

Servotronic*

The concept The Servotronic varies the steering force required to turn the wheels relative to the vehi- cle speed. At low speeds, the steering force is strongly assisted, i.e. less force is needed for steering. As the vehicle speed increases, the steering assisting power is reduced.

Malfunction Malfunctions are displayed via Check Control, refer to page 84.

Brake Force Display

On the left: normal braking.

On the right: sharp braking.

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r d

ri vi

n g

c o

m fo

rt a

n d

s af

et y

98

Airbags

The following airbags are located under the marked covers:

1 Front airbags

2 Coupe: head airbags

3 Side airbags in the seat backrests

4 Convertible: knee airbags

Protective action Observe the adjustment instructions on page 42 to ensure the best possible per-

sonal protection.<

The front airbags help protect the driver and front passenger by responding to frontal impacts in which safety belts alone cannot pro- vide adequate restraint. When needed, the head and side airbags help provide protection in the event of side impact. The relevant side air- bag supports the side upper body area. The head air bag supports the head.

The airbags have been designed to not be trig- gered in every collision situation, e.g. not in minor accidents or rear-end collisions.

Do not apply adhesive materials to the cover panels of the airbags, cover them or

modify them in any other way. Keep the dashboard and windows on the front passenger side clear, i.e. do not cover with adhesive labels or coverings, and do not attach holders such as for navigation instruments or mobile phones. Do not attach seat covers, cushions or other objects not specifically approved for seats with integral side airbags to the front seats. Do not hang items of clothing such as coats or jackets

over the backrests. Do not attempt to remove the airbag retention system from the vehicle. Do not modify the individual components of the system or its wiring in any way. This includes the upholstered covers on the steering wheel, instrument panel, seats and roof posts, as well as the sides of the roof lining. Do not attempt to remove or dismantle the steering wheel. Do not touch the individual components imme- diately after the system has been triggered, because there is a danger of burns. In the event of malfunctions, deactivation or triggering of the airbag restraint system, have the testing, repair, removal and disposal of air- bag generators executed only by a BMW center or a workshop that works according to repair procedures of BMW with correspondingly trained personnel and that has the required explosives licenses. Unprofessional attempts to work on the system could lead to failure in an emergency or to undesired airbag activation, either of which could result in personal injury.<

Warning notices and information about the air- bags can also be found on the sun visors.

Automatic deactivation of the front passenger airbags An analysis of the impression in the front pas- senger seat cushion determines whether and how the seat is occupied. The front and side air- bags for the front passenger are activated or deactivated by the system accordingly.

The indicator lamp above the interior rearview mirror shows the current status

of the front passenger airbags, deactivated or

C o

n tr

o ls

99

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

activated, refer to Status of front passenger air- bags below.<

Before transporting a child on the front passenger seat, read the safety precau-

tions and handling instructions under Trans- porting children safely, refer to page 52. The front and side airbags can also be deacti- vated by adolescents and adults sitting in cer- tain positions; the indicator lamp for the front passenger airbags comes on. In such cases, the passenger should change his or her sitting position so that the front passenger airbags are activated and the indicator lamp goes out. If the desired airbag status cannot be achieved by changing the sitting position, transport the rele- vant passenger on a rear seat. Do not attach seat covers, seat cushion padding, ball mats or other items to the front passenger seat unless they are specifically recommended by BMW. Do not place any items under the seat which could press against the seat from below. Other- wise, a correct analysis of the seat cushion is not ensured.<

Status of front passenger airbags

The indicator lamp for the front passenger air- bags shows the functional status of the front passenger front and side airbags in accordance with whether and how the front passenger seat is occupied. The indicator lamp shows whether the front passenger airbags are activated or deactivated.

> The indicator lamp lights up when a child in a specially designated child restraint sys- tem is detected, as intended, on the seat. The front and side airbags for the front pas- senger are not activated.

Most child seats are detected by the system, especially child seats

required by the NHTSA at the time of vehi- cle production. After mounting a child seat, ensure that the indicator lamp for the front passenger airbag is lit. It indicates that the child seat has been detected and that the front passenger airbags are deactivated.<

> The indicator lamp does not come on as long as a person of sufficient size and in a correct sitting position is detected on the seat. The front and side airbags for the front pas- senger are activated.

> The indicator lamp does not come on if the seat is empty. The front and side airbags for the front pas- senger are not activated.

Operational readiness of airbag system

As of radio readiness, refer to page 55, the warning lamp comes on briefly to indicate that the entire airbag system and the belt tensioners are operational.

Airbag system malfunction > Warning lamp does not light up at radio

readiness or beyond.

> Warning lamp remains permanently on.

In the event of a fault in the airbag system, have it checked without delay; otherwise,

there is the risk that the system will not function as intended even if a sufficiently severe acci- dent occurs.<

T ec

h n

o lo

g y

fo r d

ri vi

n g

c o

m fo

rt a

n d

s af

et y

100

Convertible: rollover protection system The rollover protection system is activated automatically in the event of an accident, a crit- ical driving situation, an extreme tilt in the car's longitudinal axis or upon loss of ground contact. The protection bars behind the rear head restraints deploy within fractions of a second.

As a supplementary system to the reinforced windshield frame, the rollover protection sys- tem ensures that the necessary headroom is maintained for all vehicle occupants.

Always keep the area of movement of the rollover protection system clear.

In minor accidents, you are protected by the fastened safety belt and, depending on acci- dent severity, by the safety belt tensioner and multi-phase airbag retention system.<

Resetting If the rollover protection system was not impacted after being automatically activated, it can be reset by lowering the protection bars to their original positions. This does not require tools.

1. Push the locking lever to one side and hold it there.

2. Push the protection bar halfway down from above.

3. Release the locking lever.

4. Push the protection bar down until it snaps into place.

5. Repeat the procedure for the other protec- tion bar.

Have the rollover protection system checked after an unexpected activation.

Never move the retractable hardtop when the rollover protection system is in the

activated position. Do not make any modifications to the individual components of the rollover protection system or its cabling. Work on the rollover protection system should only be performed by a BMW center. Incorrectly performed work on the system may lead to system failure or incorrect operation. To check the system and ensure flawless long- term operation, always observe the service intervals, refer to page 80.<

C o

n tr

o ls

101

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Lamps

Parking lamps/low beams

0 Lamps off, daytime running lights

1 Parking lamps and daytime running lights

2 Low-beam headlamps and welcome lamps

3 Automatic headlamp control*, daytime run- ning lights, welcome lamps, high-beam assistant* and adaptive light control*

When you open the driver's door with the igni- tion switched off, the exterior lighting is auto- matically switched off if the light switch is in position 0, 2 or 3.

Switch on the parking lamps if necessary, switch position 1.

Parking lamps In switch position 1, the front, rear and side vehicle lighting is switched on. You can use the parking lamps for parking.

The parking lamps will discharge the bat- tery. Therefore, do not leave them on for

unduly long periods of time; otherwise, the bat- tery might not have enough power to start the engine. It is preferable to switch on the left- hand or right-hand roadside parking lamps, refer to page 103.<

Low beams The low beams light up when the light switch is in position 2 and the ignition is on.

Automatic headlamp control* When the switch is in position 3, the low beams are switched on and off automatically depend- ing on ambient light conditions, e.g. in a tunnel, in twilight, or if there is precipitation. The adap- tive light control* is active. The LED next to the symbol is illuminated when the low beams are on. You can also activate the daytime running lights, refer to page 102. In the situations described above, the lamps then automatically switch from daytime running lights to low beams.

The headlamps may also come on when the sun is sitting low on a blue sky.

The low beams remain switched on regardless of the ambient lighting condi-

tions when you switch on the fog lamps.<

The automatic headlamp control cannot serve as a substitute for your personal

judgment in determining when the lamps should be switched on in response to ambient lighting conditions. For example, the system cannot detect fog or hazy weather. To avoid safety risks, you should always switch on the low-beam headlamps manually under these conditions.<

Welcome lamps If you leave the light switch in position 2 or 3 when you park the car, the parking lamps and the interior lamps light up briefly when you unlock the vehicle.

Activating/deactivating welcome lamps 1. "Settings"

2. "Lighting"

L am

p s

102

3. "Welcome light"

Welcome lamps are activated and are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Pathway lighting If you activate the headlamp flasher after switching off the ignition with the lamps switched off, the low beams come on and remain on for a certain time.

Setting the duration or deactivating 1. "Settings"

2. "Lighting"

3. "Pathway light.:"

4. Set a time of duration, or 0 s to deactivate the function.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Daytime running lights The daytime running lights light up in switch position 0, 1 and 3. They are less powerful than the low beams.

Activating/deactivating daytime running lights 1. "Settings"

2. "Lighting"

3. "Daytime running lamps"

Daytime running lights are activated and are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Adaptive light control*

The concept Adaptive light control is a variable headlamp control system that enables better illumination of the road surface. Depending on the steering angle and other parameters, the light from the headlamp follows the course of the road.

In tight curves at speeds up to 40 mph/70 km/h, e.g. on mountainous roads or when turning, an additional, corner-illuminating lamp is switched on that lights up the inside area of the curve.

Activating Adaptive Light Control With the ignition switched on, turn the light switch to position 3, refer to page 101. The corner-illuminating lamp is switched on automatically, depending on the steering wheel angle or turn signal indicator.

Standstill function*: to avoid blinding oncoming traffic, the adaptive light control directs light towards the front passenger side when the vehicle is at a standstill.

When you are reversing, only the corner-illumi- nating lamps are switched on and active on both sides.

C o

n tr

o ls

103

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Malfunction The LED next to the symbol for automatic head- lamp control flashes. Adaptive light control is malfunctioning or has failed. Have the system checked as soon as possible.

High beams/roadside parking lamps

1 High beams

2 Headlamp flasher

3 Roadside parking lamps*

Roadside parking lamps, left or right* There is an additional option of switching on the lamps on the side of the car facing the road when parked.

Switching on After parking the vehicle, press the lever up or down beyond the pressure point for a longer period, arrow 3.

The roadside parking lamps drain the bat- tery. Therefore, do not leave them on for

unduly long periods of time; otherwise, the bat- tery might not have enough power to start the engine.<

Switching off Press the lever in the opposite direction to the pressure point, arrow 3.

High-beam assistant*

The concept This system automatically switches the high beams on and off. The procedure is controlled by a sensor on the front of the interior rearview mirror. The assistant ensures that the high beams are switched on whenever the traffic sit- uation allows. It handles this task for you and gives you the benefit of the best possible view. You can intervene at any time and switch the high beams on and off as usual.

Activating the system 1. Turn the light switch to position 3, refer to

page 101.

2. With the low beams switched on, briefly push the turn indicator lever in the direction of the high beam.

The indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the high beams are activated. The system automati-

cally switches from high beams to low beams and vice versa in response to oncoming traffic, traffic ahead of you, and adequate ambient lighting, e.g. on city streets.

L am

p s

104

Switching the high beams on and off manually Whenever you wish, or when the situation requires, you can intervene:

> If the high-beam assistant switches on the high beams, but you would like to drive with the low beams, simply switch off the high beams using the turn indicator lever. This deactivates the high-beam assistant. To reactivate the system, briefly push the turn indicator lever toward the high beams again.

> If the high-beam assistant switches on the low beams, but you would like to drive with the high beams, switch on the high beams as usual. This deactivates the system and the high beams need to be switched off manually, if necessary. To reactivate the system, briefly push the turn indicator lever toward the high beams again.

> Use the headlamp flasher as usual with the low beams switched on.

System limitations The high-beam assistant cannot serve as a substitute for the driver's personal judg-

ment of when to use the high beams. Therefore, manually switch off the high beams in situations where this is required to avoid a safety risk.<

The system is not fully functional in situations such as the following, and driver intervention may be necessary:

> In very unfavorable weather conditions, such as fog or heavy precipitation

> In detecting poorly-lit road users, such as pedestrians, cyclists, horseback riders and wagons; when driving close to train or ship traffic; and at animal crossings

> In tight curves, on hilltops or in depressions, in cross traffic or half-obscured oncoming traffic on highways

> In poorly lit towns and cities and in the pres- ence of highly reflective signs

> At low speeds

> When the windshield in front of the interior rearview mirror is fogged over, dirty or cov- ered with stickers, etc.

> If the sensor is dirty. Clean the sensor on the front of the interior rearview mirror using a cloth moistened with a small amount of glass cleaner.

Activating via iDrive 1. "Settings"

2. "Lighting"

3. "High beam assistant"

The high-beam assistant is activated and is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Fog lamps*

The parking lamps or low beams must be switched on for the fog lamps to operate. The green indicator lamp in

the instrument cluster lights up whenever the fog lamps are on.

The fog lamps are switched off while you acti- vate the headlamp flasher or switch on the high beams.

C o

n tr

o ls

105

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

If the automatic headlamp control is acti- vated, the low beams will come on auto-

matically when you switch on the fog lamps.<

Instrument lighting You can adjust the brightness of the instrument lighting only when the parking lamps or the low beams are switched on.

1. Push button 1 up or down repeatedly until the appropriate symbol appears in the dis- play, accompanied by the brightness set- ting and scale the word "SET".

2. Press button 2.

3. Push button 1 up or down to select the desired brightness level.

4. Press button 2. The display again shows the outside tem- perature and the time.

Interior lamps The interior lamps, the footwell lamps*, entry lamps*, cargo area lamp and courtesy lamps* are controlled automatically.

The LEDs for the courtesy lampsare set in the door handles and illuminate the ground in front of the doors.

To avoid draining the battery, all lamps inside the car are switched off about

8 minutes after the ignition is switched off, refer to Start/stop button on page 55.<

Switching interior lamps on/off manually

Interior lamps, front and rear*: To switch on and off, press the button.

To switch off the interior lamps, footwell lamps*, entry lamps* and courtesy lamps* per- manently, press the button for the front interior lamps for about 3 seconds.

Reading lamps

There are reading lamps at the front and rear*, next to the interior lamps. To switch on and off, press the button.

C lim

at e

106

Climate

1 Airflow directed toward the windshield and side windows

2 Air to the upper body area Draft-free ventilation 109

3 Air to the footwell

4 Air distribution, manual

5 Temperature, left side

6 Maximum cooling

7 AUTO program

8 Air volume, manual adjustment; AUTO intensity

9 Automatic recirculated-air control AUC/Recirculated-air mode

10 Temperature, right side

11 ALL program

12 Defrosting windows and removing condensation

13 Switching cooling function on/off manually

14 Rear window defroster

15 Seat heating*, right side 47

16 Interior temperature sensor, please keep clear

17 Seat heating*, left side 47

C o

n tr

o ls

107

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Automatic climate control

Comfortable interior climate AUTO program 7 offers the ideal air distribution and air volume for almost all conditions, refer to AUTO program below. All you need to do is select an interior temperature which is comfort- able for you.

The following sections inform you in detail about how to adjust the settings.

Most settings are stored for the remote control currently in use, refer also to Personal Profile settings on page 26.

Adjusting air distribution manually The air distribution can be switched on and off manually. The air is directed to the windshield, to the upper body area and to the

footwell.

The automatic air distribution can be switched back on by pressing the AUTO button. The cooling function is switched on automatically and the manual air distribution setting is cleared.

Temperature Turn to set the desired tempera- ture.

The automatic climate control achieves this temperature as

quickly as possible regardless of the season, using maximum cooling or heating power if nec- essary, and then maintains it.

Avoid rapid switching between different tem- perature settings. The automatic climate con- trol will not have sufficient time to adjust the set temperature.

Maximum heating power can be obtained with the highest setting, regardless of the outside temperature.

The system cools steadily in the lowest setting, regardless of the outside temperature.

Maximum cooling Press the button. The system is set to the lowest temperature, maximum air volume and recirculated-air mode.

Air flows out of the vent outlets for the upper body region. Open them for this purpose.

Air is cooled as quickly as possible:

> Above an outside temperature of approx. 327/06

> When the engine is running

AUTO program Press the button. Air volume, air distribution and temperature are controlled auto-

matically.

Depending on the selected temperature, AUTO intensity and outside influences, the air is directed toward the windshield, the side win- dows, the upper body and the footwell.

Pressing the AUTO button automatically switches on the cooling function.

At the same time, a condensation sensor con- trols the program so as to prevent window con- densation as much as possible.

The program is switched off when the air distri- bution is set manually or the button is pressed again.

Intensity of the AUTO program With the AUTO program switched on, auto- matic control of the air volume and air distribu- tion can be adjusted:

Press the left side of the button to reduce the intensity. Press the right side of the button to

increase it.

The selected intensity is shown on the display of the automatic climate control.

C lim

at e

108

Convertible program The Convertible program is active when the hardtop is open and the AUTO program is switched on. In the Convertible program, the automatic climate control is optimized for driv- ing with the hardtop open. In addition, the air volume is increased as vehicle speed increases.

The effectiveness of the Convertible pro- gram can be enhanced considerably by

installing the wind deflector.<

Adjusting air volume manually To be able to manually adjust the air volume, switch off the AUTO program first.

Press the left side of the button to reduce the air volume. Press the right side of the button to

increase it.

The air volume may be reduced or the blower may be switched off entirely to save on battery power. The display remains the same.

Automatic recirculated-air control AUC/Recirculated-air mode You can respond to unpleasant odors or pollut- ants in the immediate environment by tempo- rarily suspending the supply of outside air. The system then recirculates the air currently within the vehicle.

Press the button repeatedly to select an operating mode:

> LED off: outside air flows in continuously.

> Left-hand LED on, AUC mode: a sensor detects pollutants in the outside air and controls the shut-off automatically.

> Right-hand LED on, recirculated-air mode: the supply of outside air is permanently shut off. If the windows fog over, switch off recirculated-air mode and increase the air volume, if necessary. Make sure that air can flow onto the windshield.

The recirculated-air mode should not be used over an extended period of time;

otherwise, the air quality inside the car will dete- riorate continuously.<

Via the button on the steering wheel You can switch quickly between the recircu- lated-air mode and the previous mode using a buttonon the steering wheel, refer to page 11.

ALL program Press the button.

The current temperature setting on the driver's side is transferred to the front passenger side.

If the temperature setting on the driver's side is changed, the temperature on the front passen- ger side is changed as well.

The program is switched off when the setting is adjusted on the front passenger side or the but- ton is pressed again.

Defrosting windows and removing condensation

Press the button.

Quickly removes ice and conden- sation from the windshield and

front side windows. For this purpose, also switch on the cooling function.

Switching cooling function on/off The passenger compartment can only be cooled while the engine is running.

Press the button.

The air is cooled and dehumidified and depending on the tempera-

ture setting warmed again.

Depending on the weather, the windshield may fog up briefly when the engine is started.

Pressing the AUTO button automatically switches on the cooling function.

Rear window defroster Press the button.

The defroster is switched off auto- matically after a certain time.

Depending on your vehicle's equipment, the upper wires serve as an antenna and are not part of the rear window defroster.

C o

n tr

o ls

109

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Switching the system on/off

Switching off With the blower at its lowest setting, press the left side of the button to switch off the automatic

climate control.

All displays are cleared except for the rear win- dow defroster if it is switched on.

The outside air supply is blocked when the automatic climate control is switched

off. If the air quality deteriorates or the window fogs over, switch the system back on and increase the air volume.<

Switching on Press any button except the ALL or the rear window defroster button to reactivate the automatic climate control.

Ventilation

1 Use the thumbwheels to smoothly open and close the air vents

2 Use the lever to change the direction of the airflow

3 Thumbwheel for more or less cool air from the vents for the upper body area

Ventilation for cooling Adjust the vent outlets to direct the flow of cool air in your direction, for instance if it has become too hot in the car.

Draft-free ventilation Set the vent outlets so that the air flows past you and not straight at you.

Ventilation in the rear

1 Use the thumbwheel to adjust the temperature:

> Turn toward blue: colder

> Turn toward red: warmer

2 Use the thumbwheel to smoothly open and close the air vents

3 Use the lever to change the direction of the airflow

Microfilter/activated-charcoal filter The microfilter traps dust and pollen in the incoming air. The activated-charcoal filter pro- vides additional protection by filtering gaseous pollutants from the outside air. Your BMW cen- ter replaces this combined filter during routine maintenance.

C lim

at e

110

Parked car ventilation

The concept The parked car ventilation provides ventilation to the passenger compartment and lowers its temperature, if necessary. It is ready for use at any outside temperature, as of radio readiness.

The parked car ventilation remains switched on for approx. 30 minutes. Two different switch-on times can be preselected. The system can also be switched on and off directly. Due to its high power consumption, it should not be switched on twice in a row without driv- ing in between to allow the battery to recharge.

The air emerges from the air vents for the upper body area in the instrument panel. The air vents must therefore be open.

The parked car ventilation system is operated via iDrive.

Switching on/off directly 1. "Settings"

2. "Climate"

3. "Activate parked-car vent."

The parked car ventilation is switched on. The symbol on the automatic climate Control

Display flashes.

Preselecting switch-on times 1. "Settings"

2. "Climate"

3. "Activate Timer 1" or "Activate Timer 2"

4. "Timer 1:" or "Timer 2:"

5. Turn the controller: set the hours.

6. Press the controller: the setting is accepted.

7. Turn the controller: set the minutes.

8. Press the controller: the setting is accepted.

The switch-on time is activated. The symbol on the automatic climate Control

Display lights up.

The symbol on the automatic climate Control Display flashes when the system has switched on.

The respective system is switched on within the next 24 hours only. After these

have elapsed, it must be reactivated.<

C o

n tr

o ls

111

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Practical interior accessories

Integrated universal remote control*

The concept The integrated universal remote control can replace as many as three hand-held transmit- ters for various remote-controlled devices, such as garage doors and gates or lighting sys- tems. The integrated universal remote control registers and stores signals from the original hand-held transmitters.

The signal of an original hand-held transmitter can be programmed on one of the three mem- ory buttons 1. After this, the programmed memory button 1 will operate the system in question. The LED 2 flashes to confirm trans- mission of the signal.

Should you sell your vehicle one day, be sure to delete the stored programs beforehand for your safety, refer to page 112.

To prevent possible damage or injury, before programming or using the inte-

grated universal remote control, always inspect the immediate area to make certain that no peo- ple, animals or objects are within the pivoting or travel range of the device being operated. Com- ply also with the safety instructions supplied with the original hand-held transmitter.<

Checking compatibility If this symbol appears on the package or in the instructions supplied with the original hand-held transmitter, you can

assume that the radio remote control device will be compatible with the integrated universal remote control.

For additional information, please contact your BMW center or call: 1-800-355-3515. You can also obtain information on the Internet at: www.bmwusa.com or www.homelink.com. HomeLink is a registered trademark of Johnson Controls, Inc.<

Programming

1 Memory buttons

2 LED

Fixed-code hand-held transmitters 1. Switch on the ignition, refer to page 55.

2. When starting operation for the first time: press the left and right memory buttons 1 for approx. 20 seconds until the LED 2 flashes rapidly. The three memory buttons are cleared.

3. Hold the original hand-held transmitter at a distance of approx. 4 to 12 in/10 to 30 cm from the memory buttons 1.

The required distance between the hand-held transmitter and the mem-

ory buttons 1 depends on the system of the respective original hand-held transmitter used.<

4. Simultaneously press the transmit key on the original hand-held transmitter and the desired memory button 1 on the integrated universal remote control. The LED 2 flashes slowly at first. As soon as the LED 2 flashes rapidly, release both buttons. If the LED 2 does not flash rapidly after approx. 15 sec- onds, alter the distance and repeat this step.

5. To program other original hand-held trans- mitters, repeat steps 3 and 4.

The corresponding memory button 1 is now programmed with the signal of the original hand-held transmitter.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

112

You can operate the device while the ignition is switched on.

If the device fails to function even after repeated programming, check whether

the original hand-held transmitter uses an alter- nating-code system. To do so, either read the instructions for the original hand-held transmit- ter or hold down the programmed memory button 1 of the integrated universal remote control. If the LED 2 on the integrated universal remote control flashes rapidly and then remains lit for about two seconds, the original hand-held transmitter uses an alternating-code system. If it uses an alternating-code system, program the memory buttons 1 as described under Alternating-code hand-held transmitters.<

Alternating-code hand-held transmitters To program the integrated universal remote control, consult the operating instructions for the device to be set. You will find information there on the possibilities for synchronization. When programming hand-held transmitters that employ an alternating code, please observe the following supplementary instructions:

Programming will be easier with the aid of a second person.<

1. Park your vehicle within the range of the remote-controlled device.

2. Program the integrated universal remote control as described above in the section Fixed-code hand-held transmitters.

3. Locate the button on the receiver of the device to be set, e.g. on the drive unit.

4. Press the button on the receiver of the device to be set. After step 4, you have approx. 30 seconds for step 5.

5. Press the programmed memory button 1 of the integrated universal remote control three times.

The corresponding memory button 1 is now programmed with the signal of the original hand-held transmitter.

If you have any questions, please contact your BMW center.<

Deleting all stored programs Press the left and right memory buttons 1 for approx. 20 seconds until the LED 2 flashes rap- idly: all stored programs are deleted.

Reassigning individual programs 1. Hold the original hand-held transmitter at a

distance of approx. 4 to 12 in/10 to 30 cm from the memory buttons 1.

The required distance between the hand-held transmitter and the mem-

ory buttons 1 depends on the system of the respective original hand-held transmitter used.<

2. Press the desired memory button 1 of the integrated universal remote control.

3. If the LED 2 flashes slowly after approx. 20 seconds, press the transmit key of the original hand-held transmitter. Release both buttons as soon as the LED 2 flashes rapidly. If the LED 2 does not flash rapidly after approx. 15 seconds, alter the distance and repeat this step.

C o

n tr

o ls

113

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Digital compass*

1 Adjustment button

2 Display

The display shows you the main or secondary compass direction in which you are driving.

Operating principle You can call up various functions by pressing the adjustment button with a pointed object

such as a ballpoint pen or similar item. The fol- lowing adjustment options are displayed one after the other, depending on how long you keep the adjustment button pressed:

> Press briefly: switch display on/off

> 3 to 6 seconds: set compass zone

> 6 to 9 seconds: calibrate compass

> 9 to 12 seconds: set left-hand/right-hand steering

> 12 to 15 seconds: set the language

Setting compass zones Set the compass zone corresponding to your vehicle's geographic location so that the com- pass can function correctly; refer to the world map with compass zones.

To set the compass zone, press the adjustment button for approx. 3-4 seconds. The number of the compass zone set is shown in the display.

To change the zone setting, briefly press the adjustment button repeatedly until the display shows the number of the compass zone corre- sponding to your current location.

The compass is operational again after approx. 10 seconds.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

114

Calibrating the digital compass The digital compass must be calibrated in the following situations:

> An incorrect compass direction is shown.

> The compass direction shown does not change although the direction of travel does.

> Not all compass directions are shown.

Procedure 1. Make sure that no large metal objects or

overhead power lines are in the vicinity of your vehicle and that you have enough space to drive in a circle.

2. Set the currently valid compass zone.

3. Convertible: ensure that the retractable hardtop is fully closed.

4. Press the adjustment button for approx. 6-7 seconds to call up C. Then drive in at least one full circle at a speed of no more than 4 mph or 7 km/h. If calibration is successful, the display changes from C to a compass direction.

5. Convertible: open the retractable hardtop fully and repeat step 4.

Setting right-hand/left-hand steering Your digital compass is factory-set to right- hand or left-hand steering, in accordance with your vehicle.

Set the language You can set the language of the display:

Press the adjustment button for approx. 12-13 seconds. Briefly press the adjustment button again to switch between English, "E", and German, "O".

The setting is automatically saved after approx. 10 seconds.

Coupe: Roller sun blind*

Tap the button in the center console to raise or lower the roller sun blind.

Glove compartment

Opening

Pull the handle. The light in the glove compartment comes on.

To prevent injury in the event of an acci- dent while the vehicle is being driven,

close the glove compartment immediately after use.<

Closing Fold the cover up.

Locking To lock the glove compartment, use the inte- grated key of the remote control, refer to page 26.

Convertible: when you lock the vehicle from the outside, the glove compartment is locked as well.

C o

n tr

o ls

115

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

USB interface for data transmission

Port for importing and exporting data on USB devices, e.g. music collections, refer to page 176.

Observe the following when connecting:

> Do not use force when plugging the con- nector into the USB audio interface.

> Do not connect devices such as fans or lamps to the USB audio interface.

> Do not connect USB hard drives.

> Do not use the USB interface to recharge external devices.

Center armrest

Storage compartment The center armrest between the front seats contains either a compartment or the cover for the snap-in adapter*, depending on the equip- ment version.

Opening Press the button, see arrow.

Settings*

Slide the center armrest on the driver's side into the desired position.

Connection for external audio device You can connect an external audio device such as a CD or MP3 player and play audio tracks over the car's loudspeaker system:

> AUX-IN port, refer to page 177

> USB audio interface*/additional connection of the music player in the mobile phone*, refer to page 178

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

116

Storage compartments inside the vehicle Depending on your vehicle's equipment, you will find compartments beside the steering col- umn*, in the front doors and in the center con- sole*. There are nets* on the front-seat backrests.

Storage compartments in the rear console Depending on your vehicle's equipment ver- sion, the following storage compartments can be found in the rear console:

> Storage tray

> Storage compartment with cover

> Cupholders

Coupe: clothes hooks

Press the upper edge to flip open.

Items of clothing hung from the hooks must not obstruct the driver's view. Do

not hang heavy objects from the hooks; other- wise, they could endanger the car's occupants, e.g. in case of heavy braking or sudden swerving.<

Cupholders Use lightweight and shatterproof contain- ers and do not transport hot beverages;

otherwise, there is an increased risk of injury in the event of the accident. Do not force contain- ers that are too large into the cupholders; other- wise, damage could result.<

Front

Opening Briefly press the center of the cover.

Closing Briefly press the cover in the center and push in the cupholder.

Coupe: rear There are two additional cupholders in the rear center armrest.

Press the front of the armrest.

C o

n tr

o ls

117

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Convertible: rear There are two additional cupholders in the rear console.

Press the button to open.

Before folding down the rear seat back- rest or using the transport bag, remove all

containers from the cupholder and close it. Do not place objects into the cupholder and use force to close it. Do not use the cupholder as a grab handle.<

Ashtray*

Opening

Push the ridge on the cover.

Emptying

Lift out the insert.

Lighter

With the engine running or the ignition switched on, press in the cigarette lighter.

The lighter can be pulled out as soon as it pops back out.

Hold or touch the hot cigarette lighter by the knob only. Holding or touching it in

other areas could result in burns. When leaving the car, always remove the remote control so that children cannot operate the cigarette lighter and burn themselves.<

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

118

Connecting electrical appliances In your BMW, when the engine is running or the ignition is switched on, you can use electrical devices such as a hand lamp, car vacuum cleaner, etc., up to approx. 200 watts at 12 volts, as long as one of the following sockets is available. Avoid damaging the sockets by attempting to insert plugs of unsuitable shape or size.

Cigarette lighter socket* To access the socket: take the cigarette lighter out of the socket.

Socket* in the front passenger footwell A socket is located under the glove compart- ment on the left.

Socket in the center armrest External audio device, refer to page 115.

Coupe: socket in the cargo area*

Open the cap.

Coupe: Through-loading system*

Opening

1. To release the rear seat backrest, pull the corresponding lever in the cargo area.

2. The unlocked rear seat backrest moves for- ward slightly. Fold the backrest forward by the head restraint.

Closing Return the rear seat backrest to its upright posi- tion and engage it.

When returning the backrest to its seating position, make sure that the seat's lock-

ing mechanism engages properly. Otherwise, cargo could be thrown around in the event of sharp braking or swerving and endanger the occupants.<

The lashing eyes in the cargo area provide you with a way to attach cargo area nets* or draw straps for securing suitcases and luggage, refer to page 130.

C o

n tr

o ls

119

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Convertible: Cargo loading

Enlarging the cargo area

When the hardtop is closed you can enlarge the cargo area: To do so, push the cargo area partition upward.

Before opening the hardtop, push the cargo area partition down until it engages on both sides.

Before moving the hardtop, ensure that there are no objects on or next to the

cargo area partition; otherwise, parts of the hardtop may be damaged. Do not exceed the maximum loading height; refer to the sticker in the cargo area showing a line indicating the maximum height. Do not use force to push down the cargo area partition.<

The retractable hardtop can only be opened if the cargo area partition is in its

lowermost position and engaged on both sides.<

Folding down the rear seat backrest

Opening

You can fold down the rear seat backrest to transport light objects in the rear without dam-

aging the seats. Depending on the vehicle equipment, the mounting points for the cargo area net* are found on the back of the seat backrest. To unlock the rear seat backrest: press the button on the driver's or the opposite side.

Closing Return the rear seat backrest to the upright seating position and engage it.

When returning the backrest to its seating position, make sure that the seat's lock-

ing mechanism engages properly. Otherwise, cargo could be thrown around in the event of sharp braking or swerving and endanger the occupants.<

Bag holder*

When the rear seat backrest is folded down, you will find two bag holders on the cargo area wall:

1. Fold open the holder by pressing the but- ton.

2. Press the handles of the bag onto the holder from above.

Only hang light shopping bags or other suitable objects from the holders; other-

wise, braking maneuvers and swerving, for example, may lead to a safety hazard due to objects flying about the passenger compart- ment. Only transport heavy luggage in the cargo area if it has been appropriately secured.<

For more information on loading the vehicle, refer to page 129.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

120

Storage compartment behind the rear seat backrest

A storage compartment is located behind the rear seat backrest. To access the storage com- partment: remove the insert or fold down the rear seat backrest.

When the rear seat backrest is folded down or the insert has been removed,

only transport small light objects in the storage compartment; otherwise, braking maneuvers and swerving, for example, may lead to a safety hazard due to objects flying about the passen- ger compartment. Only transport heavy lug- gage in the cargo area if it has been appropri- ately secured.<

Storage compartments inside the cargo area

Coupe Depending on your vehicle's equipment, the following storage spaces can be found in the cargo area:

> Left storage compartment, e.g. for storing a box of cleaning tissues or up to 12 CD jack- ets, depending on vehicle equipment ver- sion

> Net* for securing smaller objects, to be attached to the fixtures on the floor panel

> Hooks for hanging up, e.g., shopping bags or tote bags

> Rubber strap on the left trim panel for securing small objects such as a folding umbrella

> Net for small objects on the right trim panel of the cargo area

Convertible Depending on your vehicle's equipment, the following storage spaces can be found in the cargo area:

> Storage compartment on the left side of the cargo area. To open turn handle by 90

> Net* for securing smaller objects, to be attached to the fixtures on the floor panel

> Rubber strap* for subdividing the cargo area; can be hooked onto the lateral lashing eyes

> Stowage compartment under the floor panel

Folding up the floor panel Do not exceed the maximum permissible load of 55 lbs/25 kg for the storage com-

partment under the floor panel; otherwise, dam- age could result.<

Coupe Press the floor panel up and secure it with the catch.

Convertible To lift, grab hold of the floor panel at the open- ing at the rear of the panel.

Lashing eyes You will find lashing eyelets in the cargo area for securing luggage items with nets or tensioning straps, refer to page 130.

Coupe: ski bag* The ski bag is designed for safe, clean transport of up to 4 pairs of standard skis or up to 2 snowboards.

With the ski bag you can stow skis with a length of up to 6.9 ft 10 in/2.10 m. When skis of 6.9 ft 10 in/2.10 m length are loaded, the overall capacity of the ski bag is reduced due to its tapered design.

C o

n tr

o ls

121

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Loading 1. Fold down the center armrest.

2. Press the button, reach into the recess and fold down the cover.

3. Open the Velcro fastener, spread the ski bag between the front seats and insert the skis or snowboards. The zip fastener makes objects in the ski bag easier to reach.

4. Clip the hooks of the ski bag retaining strap into the eyelet.

Only place clean skis in the ski bag. Wrap sharp edges to prevent damage.

Securing cargo

After loading, secure the ski bag and its con- tents. Tighten the retaining strap on the ten- sioning buckle for this purpose.

Secure the ski bag in the manner described; otherwise, it could endanger

the car's occupants, e.g. in case of heavy brak- ing or sudden swerving.<

To store the ski bag, perform the steps described for loading in reverse order.

Removing the ski bag The ski bag can be completely removed, e.g. for faster drying or to allow you to use other inserts.

1. Fold down the center panel in the rear seat backrest.

2. Pull the handle, arrow 1.

3. Pull out the insert, arrow 2.

For more information on the various inserts available, contact your BMW cen-

ter.<

Convertible: through-loading opening with integrated transport bag* The transport bag is designed for safe, clean transport of up to 4 pairs of standard skis or up to 2 snowboards.

When the rear seat backrest is folded up, you can remove the insert and use the transport bag with the regular through-loading opening. To transport larger objects, you can fold down the rear seat backrest to create an expanded through-loading opening.

With the transport bag you can stow skis with a length of up to 6.2 ft/1.90 m. When skis of 6.2 ft/ 1.90 m length are loaded, the overall capacity of the transport bag is reduced due to its tapered design.

P ra

ct ic

al in

te ri

o r a

cc es

so ri

es

122

Loading 1. For loading using the regular through-load-

ing opening: Press the button down and remove the insert from the front. For loading with the through-loading open- ing expanded: Fold down the rear seat backrest, refer to page 119.

2. Front cover: press the two recesses together and fold the cover down until it engages.

3. In the cargo area: press the two recesses together and fold down the cover.

4. Undo the Velcro fastener and spread out the transport bag between the front seats.

5. Insert the latch plate of the retaining strap into the belt buckle under the transport bag.

6. Load the transport bag. The zipper eases access to the stored items.

Only place clean skis in the transport bag. Wrap sharp edges to prevent damage.

You can use the snaps to shorten the transport bag if you do not need its full length.

Securing cargo

After loading, secure the transport bag and its contents. Tighten the retaining strap on the tensioning buckle for this purpose.

Secure the transport bag in the manner described; otherwise, it could endanger

the car's occupants, e.g. in case of heavy brak- ing or sudden swerving.<

To store the transport bag, perform the steps described for loading in reverse order.

C o

n tr

o ls

123

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Removing the front cover

You can remove the front cover to use the full height of the through-loading opening. With the cover folded down, pull the handle, see arrow, and remove the cover toward the front. To replace, insert the cover at an angle from above and let it snap it into place.

Driving tips This section provides you with information

useful in dealing with specific driving and operating conditions.

T h

in g

s to

re m

em b

er w

h en

d ri

vi n

g

126

Things to remember when driving

Break-in period Moving parts need breaking-in time to adjust to each other. Please follow the instructions below in order to achieve the optimal service life and economy of operation for your vehicle.

Engine and differential Always obey all official speed limits.

Up to 1,200 miles/2,000 km Drive at varying engine and road speeds, but do not exceed an engine speed of 4,500 rpm or a road speed of 100 mph/160 km/h.

Avoid full-throttle operation and use of the transmission's kickdown mode.

After driving 1,200 miles/2,000 km Engine and vehicle speeds can be gradually increased.

Tires Due to technical factors associated with their manufacture, tires do not achieve their full trac- tion potential until after an initial break-in period. Therefore, drive cautiously during the first 200 miles/300 km.

Brake system Brakes require an initial break-in period of approx. 300 miles/500 km to achieve optimized contact and wear patterns between brake pads and rotors. Drive cautiously during this break-in period.

Clutch The function of the clutch reaches its optimal level only after a distance driven of approx. 300 miles/500 km. During this break-in period, engage the clutch gently.

Following part replacement The same break-in procedures should be observed if any of the components mentioned above have to be renewed in the course of the vehicle's operating life.

Saving fuel The fuel consumption of your vehicle depends on several factors. You can lower fuel consump- tion and the environmental impact by taking certain measures, adjusting your driving style and having the vehicle serviced regularly.

Remove any unneeded cargo Additional weight increases fuel consumption.

Remove any mounted parts after you have finished using them Remove unneeded additional mirrors, the roof rack and the rear luggage rack after use. Mounted parts affect the vehicle's aerodynam- ics and increase fuel consumption.

Close the windows and glass roof An open glass roof or window causes higher air resistance and thus increases fuel consump- tion.

Check tire inflation pressure regularly Check the tire inflation pressure at least twice a month and before embarking on a long journey, and correct it if necessary.

Low tire inflation pressure causes higher rolling resistance and thus increases fuel consumption and tire wear.

Set off immediately Do not let the engine warm up while the car is still standing, but set off immediately at moder- ate engine speed. This is the fastest way for the cold engine to reach its operating temperature.

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

127

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Drive defensively Avoid unnecessary acceleration and braking maneuvers. To do so, keep an adequate dis- tance between you and the vehicle in front of you. A defensive and smooth driving style keeps fuel consumption down.

Avoid high engine speeds Only use first gear when setting off. In second and higher gears, accelerate without hesitation or pauses. When accelerating, shift up before reaching high engine speeds.

When you reach the desired speed, shift into the highest applicable gear and drive with the engine speed as low as possible and at a con- stant speed.

As a rule: driving at low engine speeds lowers fuel consumption and reduces wear.

Coasting When approaching a red light, take your foot off the accelerator and coast to a stop in the high- est applicable gear.

On a downhill slope, take your foot off the accel- erator and coast in a suitable gear.

The fuel supply is interrupted when coasting.

Switch off the engine during lengthy stops Switch off the engine when stopping for lengthy periods, e.g. at traffic lights, railroad crossings or in traffic congestions. You achieve fuel sav- ings even if standing time is as short as approx. 4 seconds.

Switch off functions you do not need at the moment Functions such as the air conditioner, seat heating or rear window defroster draw large amounts of power and consume additional fuel. Especially in city traffic and in stop and go driv- ing they have a considerable impact. Therefore, switch these functions off when they are not really needed.

Have the vehicle serviced Have the vehicle serviced regularly to achieve good economy and a long vehicle life. BMW recommends having the vehicle serviced at a BMW center. Also note the BMW service sys- tem, refer to page 227.

General driving notes

Close the trunk lid Operate the vehicle only when the trunk lid is closed. Otherwise, exhaust fumes

could enter the interior of the vehicle.<

If the vehicle must be driven with the trunk lid open:

1. Close all windows and the glass roof.

2. Greatly increase the air volume of the auto- matic climate control system, refer to page 108.

Hot exhaust system In all vehicles, extremely high tempera- tures are generated in the exhaust sys-

tem. Do not remove the heat shields installed adjacent to various sections of the exhaust sys- tem, and never apply undercoating to them. When driving, standing at idle and while park- ing, take care to avoid possible contact between the hot exhaust system and any highly flammable materials such as hay, leaves, grass, etc. Such contact could lead to a fire, with the risk of serious personal injuries and property damage. Do not touch hot exhaust tail pipes. Otherwise, there is a risk of burns.<

Hydroplaning When driving on wet or slushy roads, reduce road speed. If you do not, a wedge

of water can form between tires and road sur- face. This situation, known as hydroplaning, means that the tire can completely lose contact with the road surface, so that neither the car can be steered nor the brake be properly applied.<

The risk of hydroplaning increases with declin- ing tread depth on the tires, refer also to Mini- mum tread depth on page 219.

T h

in g

s to

re m

em b

er w

h en

d ri

vi n

g

128

Driving through water Drive through water on the road only if it is not deeper than 1 ft/30 cm, and then only

at walking speed at the most. Otherwise, the vehicle's engine, the electrical systems and the transmission may be damaged.<

Use the parking brake on inclines On inclines, do not hold the vehicle for a lengthy period using the clutch; use the

parking brake instead. Otherwise, greater clutch wear will result.<

For more information about the drive-off assis- tant, refer to page 92.

Braking safely Your BMW is equipped with ABS as a standard feature. Applying the brakes fully is the most effective way of braking in situations in which this is necessary. Since the vehicle maintains steering responsiveness, you can still avoid possible obstacles with a minimum of steering effort.

Pulsation of the brake pedal, combined with sounds from the hydraulic circuits, indicate that ABS is in its active mode.

Driving in wet conditions When roads are wet or there is heavy rain, briefly exert gentle pressure on the brake pedal every few miles. Monitor traffic conditions to ensure that this maneuver does not endanger other road users. The heat generated in this process helps dry the pads and rotors to ensure that full braking efficiency will then be available when you need it.

Hills To prevent overheating and the resulting reduced efficiency of the brake system,

drive long or steep downhill gradients in the gear in which the least braking is required. Even light but consistent brake pressure can lead to high temperatures, brake wear and possibly even brake failure.<

You can increase the engine's braking effect by shifting down, all the way to first gear if neces- sary. This strategy helps you avoid placing excessive loads on the brake system. Down- shifting in manual mode of the automatic trans- mission, refer to page 59.

Sports automatic transmission with dou- ble clutch: never drive with the transmis-

sion in neutral or with the engine switched off; otherwise, there will be no engine braking action and no power assistance to the brakes and steering. Manual transmission: never drive with the clutch held down, with the transmission in neu- tral or with the engine switched off; otherwise, engine braking action will not be present or there will be no power assistance to the brakes or steering. Never allow floor mats, carpets or any other objects to protrude into the area around the pedals; otherwise, pedal function could be impaired.<

Corrosion on brake rotors When the vehicle is driven only occasionally, during extended periods when the vehicle is not used at all, and in operating conditions where brake applications are less frequent, there is an increased tendency for corrosion to form on rotors, while contaminants accumulate on the brake pads. This occurs because the minimum pressure which must be exerted by the pads during brake applications to clean the rotors is not reached.

Should corrosion form on the brake rotors, the brakes will tend to respond with a pulsating effect that even extended application will fail to cure.

When the vehicle is parked Condensation forms while the automatic cli- mate control is in operation, and then exits under the vehicle. Traces of condensed water under the vehicle are therefore normal.

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

129

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Cargo loading To avoid loading the tires beyond their approved carrying capacity, never over-

load the vehicle. Overloading can lead to over- heating and increases the rate at which damage develops inside the tires. In some situations, this can result in sudden loss of tire pressure.<

Make sure that no liquids are spilled or leak from their containers in the cargo

area, as this could result in damage to the vehi- cle.<

Determining loading limit

1. Locate the following statement on your vehicle's placard*:

The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed

XXX kg or YYY lbs. Otherwise, overloading can result in damage to the vehicle and unstable driving conditions.<

2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.

3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kilograms or YYY pounds.

4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if the YYY amount equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150-lb. pas- sengers in your vehicle, the amount of avail- able cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs: 1,400 lbs. minus 750 lbs. = 650 lbs.

5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That

weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.

6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, part of the load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult the manual for transporting a trailer to determine how this may reduce the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.

Load

The permissible load is the total of the weight of occupants and cargo/luggage. The greater the weight of the occupants, the less cargo/lug- gage can be transported.

T h

in g

s to

re m

em b

er w

h en

d ri

vi n

g

130

Stowing cargo > Position heavy objects as low and as far for-

ward as possible, ideally directly behind the respective seat backrests.

> Cover sharp edges and corners.

> For very heavy cargo when the rear seat is not occupied, secure each safety belt in the opposite buckle.

Coupe

Convertible

Securing cargo

Coupe

Convertible

> Secure smaller and lighter items using retaining straps, a cargo area net* or draw straps*.

> Heavy-duty cargo straps* for securing larger and heavier objects are available at your BMW center. Four lashing eyes are provided for attaching the cargo straps. Two are locatedon the cargo area sidewalls 1, two moreare on the rear cargo area panel 2. Please comply with the information sup- plied with the cargo straps.

Convertible: before opening the hardtop, fold down the cargo area partition. Make

sure the cargo area is loaded correctly; other- wise parts of the hardtop can be damaged, refer to page 119.<

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

131

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Always position and secure the cargo as described above, so that it cannot endan-

ger the car's occupants, for example if sudden braking or swerving is necessary. Never exceed either the approved gross vehicle weight or either of the approved axle loads, refer to page 249; otherwise, excessive loads can pose a safety hazard, and may also place you in violation of traffic safety laws. Heavy or hard objects should not be carried loose inside the car, since they could be thrown around, for example as a result of heavy braking, sudden swerves, etc., and endanger the occu- pants.

Only attach the cargo straps using the lashing eyes shown in the illustration. Do not secure cargo with the anchors for tether straps, refer to page 53; otherwise, these could be damaged.<

Coupe: roof-mounted luggage rack* A special rack system is available as an option for your BMW. Comply with the directions given in the installation instructions.

Mounting points

The mounting points are located in the roof.

Loading roof-mounted luggage rack Because roof racks raise the vehicle's center of gravity when loaded, they have a major effect on vehicle handling and steering response. You should therefore always remember not to exceed the approved roof load capacity, the approved gross vehicle weight or the axle loads when loading the rack.

You can find the applicable data under Weights on page 249.

The roof load must be distributed uniformly and should not be too large in area. Heavy items should always be placed at the bottom. Be sure that adequate clearance is maintained for rais- ing the glass roof, and that objects do not project into the opening path of the trunk lid.

Fasten roof-mounted cargo correctly and securely to prevent it from shifting or falling off during the trip.

Drive smoothly. Avoid sudden acceleration and braking maneuvers. Take corners gently.

Navigation This chapter describes how you can

enter destinations and specify your route so that your navigation system guides you

reliably to your destination.

N av

ig at

io n

s ys

te m

134

Navigation system

General information With the help of satellites and vehicle sensors, the navigation system is able to ascertain the precise position of the vehicle and reliably guide you to any destination you enter.

Enter data only when the vehicle is sta- tionary, and always give priority to the

applicable traffic regulations in the event of any contradiction between traffic and road condi- tions and the instructions issued by the naviga- tion system. Failure to take to this precaution can place you in violation of the law and put vehicle occupants and other road users in dan- ger.<

Navigation data

General information Navigation data are stored in the vehicle and can be updated.

Navigation data and authorization codes are available from your BMW center.

Depending on the data volume, a data update may take several hours.

> The data are updated while you are driving.

> The update is resumed automatically when a trip is continued after an interruption.

> Basic navigation functions are available during the trip.

> The data are stored in the vehicle.

> After the update, the system restarts.

> The medium that holds the navigation data can be removed after the update is com- pleted.

Updating the navigation data

Inserting navigation DVD 1. Insert the navigation DVD into the DVD

player with the labeled side facing up.

2. Follow the instructions on the Control Display.

3. Enter the authorization code of the naviga- tion DVD and change the DVD if needed.

Removing navigation DVD

1. Press button 1. The DVD emerges slightly from the drive.

2. Remove the DVD.

Information about navigation data 1. "Navigation"

2. Open "Options".

3. "Navigation system version": Information on the data version is displayed.

*

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

135

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Destination entry

In entering your destination you can select from the following options:

> Entering a destination manually, see below

> Selecting destination from address book, refer to page 137

> Last destinations, refer to page 138

> Special destinations, refer to page 139

> Entering a destination on the map, refer to page 140

> Selecting home address, refer to page 138

> Entering a destination by voice com- mands*, refer to page 141

> Destination entry via BMW Assist*, refer to page 140

You can also store a navigation destination on the programmable memory keys, refer to page 20.

Enter data only when the vehicle is sta- tionary, and always give priority to the

applicable traffic regulations in the event of any contradiction between traffic and road condi- tions and the instructions issued by the naviga- tion system. Otherwise, vehicle occupants and other road users may be endangered.<

Entering a destination manually The system's word-matching principle makes it easier for you to enter the names of streets or towns, refer to page 143. This allows you to enter different spellings and completes your entry automatically, so that stored names can be called up quickly.

1. Press the MENU button.

2. "Navigation"

3. "Enter address"

The system also supports you with the follow- ing features:

> If you do not enter a street, the system will guide you to the downtown area of a town or city.

> You can skip the entry of state/province and town/city if the current entries should be retained for your new destination.

Entering a state/province 1. "Navigation"

2. "Enter address"

3. Select "State/Province" or the displayed state/province.

Entering a town/city 1. Select "Town/City/Postal Code" or the dis-

played town/city.

2. Select letters, if necessary.

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

136

To delete letters:

> To delete individual letters: Turn the controller to select , and then press the controller.

> To delete all letters: Turn the controller to select , and then press the controller for an extended period.

To enter spaces:

> Select the symbol.

The list gradually grows smaller each time you enter a new letter.

3. Move the controller to the right.

4. Select the name of the town/city from the list.

If there are several towns/cities with the same name:

1. Change to the list of town/city names.

2. Highlight the town/city: a preview map is displayed.

3. Select the town/city.

Entering the postal code 1. Select "Town/City/Postal Code" or the dis-

played town/city.

2. Select the symbol.

3. Select the digits.

4. Change to the list of postal codes and towns/cities.

5. Highlight the postal code: a preview map is displayed.

6. Select the postal code.

Entering street and intersection 1. Select "Street" or the displayed street.

2. Enter a street and intersection as you would the town/city.

After the street you can also enter the intersec- tion or the house number.

If there are several streets with the same name:

1. Change to the list of street names.

2. Highlight the street: a preview map is dis- played.

3. Select the street.

Entering a street without a destination town/city You can also enter a street without specifying a town/city. In this case, all streets of the same name in the designated state/province are offered. The corresponding town/city is dis- played after the street name.

If a town/city has already been entered, you can negate this entry. This could be helpful in instances where the desired street does not exist in the entered town/city because it belongs to another suburb, for example.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Enter address"

3. Select "Street" or the displayed street.

4. Change to the list of street names.

5. Select "In" with the state/province currently displayed.

6. Select the letters.

7. Change to the list of street names.

8. Highlight the street: a preview map is displayed.

9. Select the street.

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

137

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Entering a house number You can enter any house number stored in the navigation data for the street.

1. "House number"

2. Select the digits.

3. Change to the list of house numbers.

4. Select a house number or range of house numbers.

Starting destination guidance after entering the destination 1. "Accept destination"

2. "Start guidance" or "Add as another dest.".

> Set your "Route preference", refer to page 144.

> Search for "Points of Interest at loc.", refer to page 139.

Address book To create contacts, refer to page 196.

Selecting a destination from the address book 1. "Navigation"

2. "Address book" Contacts with addresses are displayed if these have been checked as destinations.

If the contacts with addresses from the mobile phone* are not displayed, they first need to be checked as destinations, refer to page. 197.

3. Select a contact from the list or, if neces- sary, using "A-Z search".

4. If necessary, select "Business address" or "Home address".

Storing a destination in the address book Store the destination in the address book after entering the destination.

1. Open "Options".

2. "Store as new contact" or "Add to existing contact".

3. Select an existing contact, if available.

4. Select "Business address" or "Home address".

5. Enter "Last name" and, if necessary, "First name".

6. "Store in vehicle"

Storing the position Your current position can be stored in the address book.

1. "Navigation"

2. Open "Options".

3. "Store position as contact" or "Add position to contact".

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

138

4. Depending on the selection, select an exist- ing contact from the list or the type of address and enter the last and first name.

5. "Store in vehicle"

Editing or deleting an address 1. "Navigation"

2. "Address book"

3. Highlight the entry.

4. Open "Options".

5. "Edit in Contacts" or "Delete entry".

Using the home address as a destination The home address must be stored as a destina- tion. Refer to Specifying a contact as the home address, page 196.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Address book"

3. "Home"

4. "Start guidance"

Last destinations The last destinations are stored automatically. These destinations can be called up and used as a destination for destination guidance.

Opening the last destinations 1. "Navigation"

2. "Last destinations"

3. Select the destination.

4. "Start guidance"

Editing a destination Destinations can be edited, for example, to change the house number of an existing entry.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Last destinations"

3. Highlight the destination.

4. Open "Options".

5. "Edit destination"

Deleting the last destinations 1. "Navigation"

2. "Last destinations"

3. Highlight the destination.

4. Open "Options".

5. "Delete entry" or "Delete all last destina- tions".

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

139

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Special destinations You can search for a special destination, e.g. a hotel or place of interest, and start destination guidance to the corresponding location.

The scope of information provided depends on the particular set of naviga-

tion data you are using.<

Opening the search for special destinations 1. "Navigation"

2. "Points of Interest"

The search can be narrowed by entering the location and type of special destination.

Special destination location Search for a special destination according to its location relative to a locality or route.

1. "Search area"

2. Select the location where the system is to search for the special destination:

> "At current location"

> "At destination"

> "At a different destination"

> "Along route"

Special destination category 1. "Category"

2. Select "All" or a specific category, e.g. hotels or restaurants.

Category details For some special destinations, additional details can be displayed that are available in the navigation data, e.g. Italian-style restaurant.

"Category details"

Starting the search for special destinations 1. "Start search"

2. A list of the special destinations is dis- played.

> "At current location" Special destinations are listed according to their distance from the current loca- tion and are displayed with a directional arrow pointing to the destination.

> "At destination", "At a different destina- tion", "Along route" Special destinations are listed according to their distance from the location where the search is being performed.

> Destinations of the selected category are displayed in the map view as sym- bols. The display depends on the map scale and the category.

3. Highlight a special destination: the destina- tion is displayed in the preview map.

4. Select the special destination.

5. Select the symbol.

6. "Start guidance" or "Add as another dest.".

If a phone number is available, a connection can be established, if desired.

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

140

Destination entry via BMW Assist* A connection is established to the BMW Con- cierge service, refer to page 199.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Enter address"

3. Open "Options".

4. "BMW Assist dest. entry"

Entering special destinations by name 1. "Navigation"

2. "Points of Interest"

3. "Name, A-Z search"

4. Enter the letters. Depending on the distance, the search may take some time. The list can contain a max- imum of 100 entries.

5. Change to the list of special destinations.

6. Highlight a special destination: the destina- tion is displayed in the preview map.

7. Select the special destination.

8. Select the symbol.

9. "Start guidance" or "Add as another dest.".

Displaying special destinations in the map To display symbols of the special destinations in the map:

1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Display Points of Interest"

5. Select the settings.

Entering the destination via the map If you only know the location of the town or street, you can enter the destination using the map.

Opening the map 1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

A map section is displayed on the Control Dis- play. The map shows the current position of the vehicle.

Selecting the destination 1. Select the symbol.

"Interactive map" is started.

2. Select the destination with the cross-hairs.

> To change the scale: turn the controller.

> To shift the map: move the controller in the required direction.

> To shift the map diagonally: move the controller in the required direction and turn it.

3. Press the controller to display additional menu items.

> Select the symbol: "Start guidance" or "Add as another dest.".

> "Return": return to the map view.

> "Find points of interest": the search for special destinations is begun.

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

141

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Specifying the street If the system cannot recognize a street, it dis- plays a street name in the vicinity or the coordi- nates of the destination.

Interactive map In the interactive map, the scale can be adjusted and the visible map section can be shifted. In addition, pressing the controller makes further functions available:

> Select that symbol and "Start guid- ance", if necessary.

> "Exit interactive map"

> Map view

> "Display destination" The map section around the destination is displayed.

> "Display current location" The map section around your current location is displayed.

> "Find points of interest", refer to page 139.

Entering a destination by voice commands*

General information You can enter a desired destination via the voice activation system. During the destination input, you can switch between voice entry and entry via iDrive at any time. To do so, reactivate the voice activation system if necessary.

You can have the possible commands read aloud via {Voice commands}.<

Saying the entries > Countries, towns and cities, streets and

intersections can be said as whole words or spelled in the system language, refer to page 87.

Example: to enter a destination in a US state as a complete word, the system language must be English.

> The town/city, street and house number can be said as a single sentence.*

> Spell the entry if the language region and the system language differ.

> Say the letters smoothly, and avoid exag- gerating the pronunciation and inserting lengthy pauses between the letters.

Entering an address* 1. Press the button on the steering wheel.

3. Wait for a request from the system.

4. Say the town or city, street and house num- ber in a single sentence.

5. Continue making the entry as prompted by the system.

6. If necessary, individually name the separate components of the address, e.g. the town/ city.

Entering a town/city The town/city can be spelled or entered as a complete word*.

The methods of entry depend on the nav- igation data in use and the country and

language settings.<

2. Wait for the system to prompt you for the town/city.

3. Say the name of the town/city, or name at least the first three letters.

2. {Enter address}

1. {City} or {Spell city}

D es

ti n

at io

n e

n tr

y

142

Depending on the entry, up to 20 towns/cit- ies may be suggested.

Identical-sounding towns/cities that can- not be distinguished by the system are

compiled in a separate list and shown as a town/ city followed by three dots. If necessary, select this entry with {Yes}. Then select the desired town/city from that list.<

The town/city can also be selected from the list via iDrive: turn the controller until the town/city is selected and press the controller.

Entering a street or intersection The street or intersection is entered in the same manner as the town/city.

Entering a house number You can enter house numbers up to 999:

Starting destination guidance

Destination guidance starts immediately.

Adding further intermediate destinations

Further intermediate destinations can be added.

Storing destinations The destination is automatically added to the list of last destinations.

Planning a trip

New trip Various intermediate destinations can be entered for a trip.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

3. Move the controller to the left, if necessary.

4. Select the symbol.

5. "Enter new destination"

6. Select the type of destination entry and enter the intermediate destination.

7. Enter the intermediate destination.

8. "Start guidance"

Enter the intermediate destination A maximum of 30 intermediate destinations can be entered for one trip.

1. "Enter new destination"

2. Select the type of destination entry and enter the intermediate destination.

3. Select "Add as another dest.".

4. Select the location where the intermediate destination is to be inserted.

4. Select a location:

> To select a recommended town/city: {Yes}

> To select other town/city: {New entry}

> To select an entry: e.g. {Entry 2}

> To spell an entry: {Spell city}

1. {House number}

2. Say the house number.

3. {Yes} to confirm the house number.

4. {Accept destination}

{Start guidance}

{Add as another destination}

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

143

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Starting the trip After all intermediate destinations have been entered: "Start guidance"

Storing a trip Up to 30 created trips can be stored in the trip list.

1. Open "Options".

2. "Store trip"

3. Enter the letters.

4. "OK"

The trip is stored in the trip list under the entered name.

Starting a stored trip 1. "Navigation"

2. "Stored trips"

3. Select the desired trip.

4. "Start guidance"

Trips, changing

Changing the trip direction Intermediate destinations can be displayed in reverse order after destination guidance is started.

1. "Map"

2. "Guidance"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Reverse order of trip dest."

Rearranging the intermediate destinations 1. "Map"

2. "Guidance"

3. "Display all trip destinations"

4. Select an intermediate destination.

5. "Reposition dest. in the trip"

Deleting an intermediate destination 1. "Map"

2. "Guidance"

3. "Display all trip destinations"

4. Select an intermediate destination.

5. "Delete dest. in the trip"

Deleting a trip 1. "Navigation"

2. "Stored trips"

3. Select the desired trip.

4. Open "Options".

5. "Delete all trips" or "Delete trip".

Word-matching principle The system's word-matching principle makes it easier for you to enter the names of towns or streets. The system runs ongoing checks, com- paring your destination entries with the data stored in the vehicle as the basis for instant response. The benefits for you include:

> Names of towns entered may differ from the official versions if you are using a spelling that is customary in another country.

Example:

Instead of the German spelling "Mnchen" you can also enter the English spelling "Munich" or the Italian spelling "Monaco".

> When you are entering the names of towns and streets the system will complete them automatically as soon as enough letters are available to ensure unambiguous identifica- tion.

> The system offers only those letters for selection of name entries that are stored in the vehicle. Thus, entry of erroneous or unregistered names is impossible.

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

144

Destination guidance

Starting destination guidance 1. "Navigation"

2. "Enter address"

3. Select the destination.

4. "Accept destination"

5. "Start guidance"

The route is displayed on the Control Display after it is calculated.

In the map view, the distance from the destina- tion/intermediate destination and the estimated arrival time are displayed.

Terminating destination guidance 1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

3. Select the symbol.

4. "Stop guidance"

Continuing destination guidance If the destination was not reached during the last trip, destination guidance can be resumed.

"Resume guidance"

Route criteria

General information You can influence the calculated route by choosing certain route criteria. You can change the route criteria as often as you like during des- tination entry or during destination guidance.

The route is planned according to fixed rules. The type of road is taken into account, e.g. whether it is a highway or a winding road. As a result, the routes recommended by the naviga- tion system may not always be the same ones that you would choose based on personal expe- rience.

The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Changing route criteria 1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

3. "Route preference"

4. Selecting a criterion:

> "Fast route": time-optimized route, which is a combination of the shortest possible distance and the fastest roads

> "Efficient route": optimized combination of the fastest roads and shortest route

> "Short route": short distance without taking time into account

> "Alternative routes": other suggested alternative routes while destination guidance is active

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

145

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

5. Select additional route criteria, if desired. Where possible, the selected criteria will be avoided on the route.

> Avoid highways where possible: "Avoid highways"

> Avoid toll roads where possible: "Avoid toll roads"

> Avoid ferries where possible: "Avoid ferries"

The setting applies to the current route and to the planning of future routes.

Dynamic destination guidance "Dynamic guidance" is switched on: The route is automatically changed in the event of traffic obstructions. The system does not point out traffic obstructions along the original route.

Depending on the type of road and the nature and length of the traffic obstruction, the route can also be calculated so that you travel through the traffic obstruction.

Activating Dynamic destination guidance 1. "Navigation"

2. Open "Options".

3. "Dynamic guidance"

If the "Avoid highways", "Avoid toll roads" or "Avoid ferries" route criteria are

selected, route calculation may take consider- ably longer.<

Route

General information Depending on the equipment in your vehicle, various views of the route are available during destination guidance.

> List of streets and towns/cities

> Map view, refer to page 146

Displaying a list of the streets or towns/ cities on the route When destination guidance is started, a list of the streets and towns/cities on the route is dis- played. The driving distances and traffic bulle- tins are displayed for each route section.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Route information"

3. Highlight a section.

The section is displayed in the preview map.

Bypassing a section of the route During destination guidance, you can revise the navigation system's route recommendations to avoid particular stretches of road. Enter the number of miles/kilometers that you want to travel before returning to the original route.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Route information"

3. "New route for:"

4. Turn the controller: enter the desired num- ber of miles.

5. Press the controller.

Resuming the original route If the route section should no longer be bypassed:

1. "Navigation"

2. "Route information"

3. "Remove blocking"

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

146

Gas station recommendations The remaining range is calculated and gas sta- tions along the route are recommended.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Route information"

3. "Recommended refuel" A list of gas stations is displayed.

4. Select a gas station.

5. Select the symbol.

6. "Start guidance" or "Add as another dest.".

Destination guidance through voice instructions

Switching voice instructions on/off Voice instructions can be switched on or off during destination guidance.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

3. Select the symbol.

For rapid access, the feature can be stored on a programmable memory key, refer to page 20.

Repeating a voice instruction 1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

3. Highlight the symbol.

4. Press the controller twice.

Adjusting the volume of voice instructions* The volume can be adjusted only while a voice instruction is being issued.

1. Have the last voice instruction repeated, if necessary.

2. Turn the button during the voice instruction to select the desired volume.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Map view

Displaying the map view You can have your current position displayed on a map. After starting the destination guidance, the planned route is shown on the map.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

The following functions are directly available in the map view:

Symbol Meaning

Voice instructions are switched on

Voice instructions are switched off

Symbol Function

Starting/stopping destina- tion guidance

Switching voice instructions on/off

Changing route criteria or selecting route alternatives

Special destinations

Displaying traffic bulletins

Interactive map

Map view settings

Changing scale

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

147

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Information in the map view > Time, entertainment source, sound output,

map orientation

> Distance from destination/intermediate destination, estimated time of arrival, if des- tination guidance is active.

> Any traffic obstructions are highlighted in color.

To show/hide information on the map: Press the controller.

Viewing the map 1. Select the symbol.

2. Select a setting:

> "View facing north"

> "View in dir. of travel"

> "Perspective view"

> "Arrow display"

3. Press the controller.

Changing the map section Select "Interactive map".

> To shift the map: move the controller in the required direction.

> To shift the map diagonally: move the con- troller in the required direction and turn it.

Changing scale 1. Select the symbol.

2. Turn the controller to adjust the scale.

Automatic scaling of the map In the map view facing north, turn the controller in any direction until AUTO is displayed as the map scale. The map shows the entire range from your loca- tion to the destination.

Settings for the map view The map is shown on the Control Display.

1. Open "Options".

2. "Settings"

3. Set the optimized map view.

> "Day/night mode" Select and create the necessary settings depending on the light conditions. If the "Traffic conditions/gray map" is acti- vated, this setting is not taken into account.

> "Satellite images" Depending on the availability and resolu- tion, satellite images* are displayed in scales of approx. 1 mile to 600 miles/ 2 km to 1,000 km .

> "Perspective view in 3D" Displays a spatial view. Prominent areas that are contained in the navigation data are displayed on the map in 3D.

> "Traffic conditions/gray map" The map is optimized for displaying traf- fic bulletins. Symbols for the special destinations are no longer displayed.

Map view for the split screen display The map view for the split screen can be selected separately from the main screen.

1. Open "Options".

2. "Split screen" The split screen is switched on.

3. Move the controller to the right repeatedly until the split screen content is selected.

4. Select the map view:

> "Arrow display"

> "Map facing north"

> "Map direction of travel"

> "Map view with perspective"

> "Exit ramp view"

Changing scale 1. Move the controller to the right until the

split screen is selected.

2. turn the controller.

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

148

Traffic bulletins* You can display the traffic bulletins from radio stations that broadcast the TMC (Traffic Mes- sage Channel) of a traffic information service. This information from the traffic information service is continuously updated on the basis of measurement data from traffic control centers and information on traffic congestion. During destination guidance, traffic bulletins that are relevant to areas along the route are automatically displayed and taken into account in the route planning. You can open all traffic bulletins manually via iDrive.

The traffic bulletins are shown in the map view.

Real Time Traffic Information End-User Provisions Certain BMW models equipped with navigation have the capability to display real-time traffic information. If your system has this capability the following additional terms and conditions apply:

An End-User shall no longer have the right to use the Traffic Data in the event that the End- User is in material breach of the terms and con- ditions contained herein.

A. Total Traffic Network, a division of Clear Channel Broadcasting, Inc. ("Total Traffic Net- work") holds the rights to the traffic incident data and RDS-TMC network through which it is delivered. You may not modify, copy, scan or use any other method to reproduce, duplicate, republish, transmit or distribute in any way any portion of traffic incident data. You agree to indemnify, defend and hold harmless BMW of North America, LLC. ("BMW NA") and Total Traffic Network, Inrix, Inc (and their affiliates) against any and all claims, damages, costs or other expenses that arise directly or indirectly out of (a) your unauthorized use of the traffic incident data or the RDS-TMC network, (b) your violation of this directive and/or (c) any unautho- rized or unlawful activities by you in connection herewith.

B. Total Traffic Network traffic data is informa- tional only. User assumes all risk of use. Total Traffic Network, BMW NA, and their suppliers

make no representations about content, traffic and road conditions, route usability, or speed.

C. The licensed material is provided to license "as is," and "where is". Total Traffic Network, including, but not limited to, any and all third party providers of any of the licensed material, expressly disclaims, to the fullest extent permit- ted by law, all warranties or representations with respect to the licensed material (including, without limitation, that the licensed material will be error-free, will operate without interruption or that the traffic data will be accurate), express, implied or statutory, including, without limita- tion, the implied warranties of merchantability, non-infringement fitness for a particular pur- pose, or those arising from a course of dealing or usage of trade.

D. Neither Total Traffic Network, Inrix, Inc. nor BMW NA will be liable to you for any indirect, special, consequential, exemplary, or incidental damages (including, without limitation, lost rev- enues, anticipated revenues, or profits relating to the same) arising from any claim relating directly or indirectly to use of the traffic data, and even if Total Traffic Network, Inrix, Inc., or BMW NA are aware of the possibility of such damages. These limitations apply to all claims, including, without limitation, claims in contract and tort (such as negligence, product liability and strict liability). Some states do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or conse- quential damages, so those particular limita- tions may not apply to you.

Activating/deactivating reception 1. "Navigation"

2. Open "Options".

3. Activate/deactivate "Receive Traffic Info".

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

149

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Traffic bulletins in a list A list of the traffic bulletins can be opened via the menu or map view.

Opening traffic bulletins 1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

3. Move the controller to the left, if necessary.

4. Select the symbol: "Traffic Info" First, the traffic bulletins on the planned route are displayed. The traffic bulletins are sorted in the order of their distance from the current vehicle position.

5. Select a traffic bulletin.

Additional information can be displayed for some traffic bulletins:

1. Select the symbol.

2. Additional information is displayed.

3. To exit from the menu: Move the controller to the left.

Traffic bulletins in the map When the traffic bulletin map is activated, the Control Display changes to a grayscale display. This enables a better view of the traffic bulle- tins. The day/night mode is disregarded in this setting. The symbols for the special destina- tions are no longer displayed.

1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Settings"

5. "Traffic conditions/gray map"

Symbols in the map view Depending on the scale of the map and the location of the traffic obstruction along the route, the symbols for the traffic obstructions are displayed.

Additional information in the map view Depending on the map scale, a traffic obstruc- tion's length, direction and impact are displayed on the map using triangles or gray bars along the calculated route. The colors displayed depend on the information transmitted by the traffic information service.

> Red: traffic jam

> Orange: stop-and-go traffic

> Yellow: heavy traffic

> Green: traffic flowing freely

> Gray: general traffic information, e.g. con- struction zone

Filtering of traffic bulletins You can filter which traffic bulletins are to be displayed by the system:

1. "Navigation"

2. "Map"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Traffic Info categories"

5. Select the desired categories.

Traffic bulletins of the selected categories are displayed.

> Traffic bulletins on incidents along the route are always displayed.

> For your own safety, traffic bulletins that notify you of potentially dangerous situa- tions, such as wrong-way drivers, cannot be hidden.

D es

ti n

at io

n g

u id

an ce

150

Traffic bulletins during destination guidance System response will vary depending on whether or not "Dynamic guidance" is selected, refer to page 145.

During destination guidance, traffic obstruc- tions on the route are taken into consideration.

Information on sources of great danger, such as wrong-way drivers, is displayed regardless of the setting.

Displaying traffic obstructions When the navigation system receives a traffic obstruction message and "Dynamic guidance" is not selected, you will be shown certain infor- mation, such as the length of the traffic jam, when you are approx. 30 miles/50 km away from the traffic obstruction. The last possible detour exit is indicated just before you reach it.

This information is displayed even if you have called up another application on the Control Display.

Selecting a detour Select the symbol: "Detour".

"Dynamic guidance" is activated for the current destination guidance.

Dynamic route planning When "Dynamic guidance" is selected, the route will be changed automatically in the event of a traffic obstruction. The system will not point out traffic obstructions on the original route. Depending on the road type and the kind and extent of the traffic obstruction, the newly cal- culated route may lead through the traffic obstruction.

N av

ig at

io n

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

151

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

What to do if

What to do if

> The current position cannot be displayed? The position is in an unrecognized region, in a poor reception area, or the system is in the process of determining the position. Reception is generally available when you are in the open.

> The destination guidance does not accept an address without the street name? A downtown area cannot be determined for the town or city that has been entered. Input any street in the selected town/city and start destination guidance.

> The destination guidance does not accept a destination? The destination data is not contained in the navigation data. Choose a destination as close as possible to the original one.

> The letters for a destination cannot be selected during destination entry? The stored data do not contain the data of the destination. Select a destination that is as close as possible to the original.

> The map view is displayed in grayscale? When the traffic bulletin map is activated, the Control Display changes to a grayscale display. This enables a better view of the traffic bulletins.

> Voice instructions are no longer issued before intersections during destination guidance? The area has not been fully recorded yet, or you have left the recommended route and the system requires a few seconds to calcu- late a new route suggestion.

Entertainment Operation of the radio, CD equipment and

external audio devices as well as their tone settings are described in this chapter.

O n

/o ff

a n

d to

n e

154

On/off and tone

The following audio and video sources share the same control elements and adjustments:

> Radio

> CD/DVD player

> CD changer* > Video* > External devices, e.g. MP3 player

Controls The audio and video sources can be controlled using the:

> Buttons near the CD/DVD player

> iDrive

> Buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 10

> Programmable memory keys, refer to page 20

> Voice activation system

Buttons in the area of the CD/DVD player

1 Sound output for entertainment on/off, vol- ume

> Press: switch on/off When you switch on the unit, the last set radio station or track is played.

> Turn: adjusting the volume

2 Eject the CD/DVD

3 CD/DVD drive*

4 FM/AM: change the radio station wave- band

5 MODE: change the audio and video sources

6 Station scan/track search

> Change the radio station

> Select the track for the CD/DVD player, CD changer and certain multimedia devices

Switching on/off To switch the entertainment audio output on or off: Press button 1 next to the CD/DVD player.

This symbol on the Control Display indicates that sound output is switched off.

The sound output is available for approx. 20 minutes after the ignition was switched off. For sound output, switch the unit back on.

Adjusting volume Turn button 1 next to the CD/DVD player until the desired volume is obtained.

You can also adjust the volume with buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 10.

Tone control You can alter various tone settings, e.g. treble and bass or the speed-dependent volume increase. The tone settings are applied to all audio sources.

The settings are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Treble, bass, balance, fader > "Balance": left/right volume distribution

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

155

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

> "Fader": front/rear volume distribution

Adjustments 1. "CD/Multimedia", "Radio" or "Settings".

2. "Tone"

3. Select the desired tone setting.

4. To adjust: turn the controller.

5. To store: press the controller.

Equalizer* You can set individual sound frequency ranges.

1. "CD/Multimedia", "Radio" or "Settings".

2. "Tone"

3. "Equalizer"

4. Select the desired setting.

5. To adjust: turn the controller.

6. To store: press the controller.

Multi-channel playback, surround* You can choose between stereo and multi- channel playback, surround.

1. "CD/Multimedia", "Radio" or "Settings".

2. "Tone"

3. "L7 Surround"

Multi-channel playback, surround, is simulated when playing back an audio track in stereo.

Surround is automatically activated or deacti- vated, depending on the audio track selected.

LOGIC7 and the LOGIC7 logo are registered trade marks of Lexicon, Inc., a company of the Harman International Group.

Volume > "Speed volume": adjustment of volume

depending on driving speed

> "PDC"*: volume of the PDC signal tone rel- ative to the entertainment sound output

> "Gong": volume of the signal tone, e.g. for the "Fasten safety belts" reminder, relative to the entertainment sound output

Adjustments 1. "CD/Multimedia", "Radio" or "Settings".

2. "Tone"

3. "Volume settings"

O n

/o ff

a n

d to

n e

156

4. Select the desired volume setting.

5. To adjust: turn the controller.

6. To store: press the controller.

Resetting tone settings You can reset all tone settings to the default setting.

1. "CD/Multimedia", "Radio" or "Settings".

2. "Tone"

3. "Reset"

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

157

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Radio

Your radio is designed for reception of the fol- lowing stations:

> FM and AM

> HD Radio* > Satellite radio*

Selecting a station

Press the button if the sound output is switched off.

1. "Radio"

2. "FM" or "AM"

3. Select the desired station.

The selected station is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Changing stations Turn the controller and press it

or

press the button for the corresponding direction

or

press the buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 10.

Selecting a station manually Station selection using the frequency.

1. "Radio"

2. "FM" or "AM"

3. "Manual"

4. Select the frequency: turn the controller.

To store the station: press the controller for an extended period.

Storing stations

Via iDrive 1. "Radio"

2. "FM" or "AM"

R ad

io

158

3. Select the desired station.

4. Press the controller for an extended period.

5. Select the desired memory location.

The stations are stored for the remote control currently in use.

Via programmable memory keys You can store a station on the programmable memory keys, refer to page 20.

1. Select a station.

2. ... Press the desired button for a longer period.

Radio Data System RDS* In the FM waveband, additional information is transmitted via RDS. If the reception conditions are good, the station names are shown on the Control Display. Where reception is poor or in the event of interference, it may take some time before the station names appear in the display.

Switching the RDS on/off 1. "Radio"

2. "FM"

3. Open "Options".

4. "RDS"

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

HD Radio reception* Many stations broadcast both analog and digi- tal signals. If a digital radio network is available, these stations can be received digitally and thus with better sound quality.

License conditions

HD Radio technology is manufactured under license from iBiquity Digital Corp. U.S. and For- eign Patents. HD Radio and the HD and HD Radio logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiq- uity Digital Corp.

Switching digital radio reception on/off 1. "Radio"

2. "FM" or "AM"

3. Open "Options".

4. "HD Radio Reception"

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

This symbol is displayed when a station is received digitally.

In areas in which the station is not continuously received in digital mode, playback switches between analog and digital reception. Any time shift between these two broadcasts can lead to repetitions or interruptions in the output. In this case, switch off digital radio reception.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

159

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Displaying additional information Some stations broadcast additional information on the current track, such as the name of the artist.

1. Select the desired station.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Station info"

Selecting a substation This symbol indicates that a main station

includes additional subchannels. The station name of the main station ends with HD1. The station names of the subchannels end with HD2, HD3, etc.

1. Select the desired station.

2. Press the controller.

3. Select the substation.

In the event of poor reception, the substation is muted for several seconds. If reception is inter- rupted for a longer period of time, then the sys- tem switches back to the main station.

Presets It is possible to store up to 40 stations.

Calling up a station 1. "Radio"

2. "Presets"

3. Select the desired station.

Storing a station The station currently selected is stored.

1. "Radio"

2. "Presets"

3. "Store station"

4. Select the desired memory location.

The list of stored stations is stored for the remote control currently in use.

You can also store the stations on the program- mable memory keys, refer to page 20.

Deleting a station 1. "Radio"

2. "Presets"

3. Select the desired station.

4. Open "Options".

5. "Delete entry"

S at

el lit

e ra

d io

160

Satellite radio

General information The channels are offered in predefined pack- ages. The packages must be enabled by tele- phone.

Navigation bar overview

The functions of the navigation bar symbols can also be stored on the programmable memory buttons, refer to page 20.

Managing a subscription To be able to enable or unsubscribe from the channels, you must have reception. It is usually at its best when you have an unobstructed view of the sky. The channel name is displayed in the status line.

Enabling the channels The Unsubscribed Channels category contains all disabled channels.

1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. "Category"

4. Select the Unsubscribed Channels cate- gory.

5. Select the desired channel. The phone number and an electronic serial number, ESN, are displayed.

6. Select the phone number to have the chan- nel enabled.

You can also unsubscribe from the channels via this phone number.

Unsubscribing from channels 1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. Open "Options".

*

Symbol Function

Changing the list view

Selecting a category

Direct channel entry

Timeshift

Opening the favorites, opening the My Favorites category

Managing the favorites

Traffic Jump

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

161

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

4. "Manage subscription"

The phone number and an electronic serial number, ESN, are displayed.

5. Call Sirius to unsubscribe from the chan- nels.

Selecting a channel You can only listen to enabled channels.

The selected channel is stored for the remote control currently in use.

Via iDrive 1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. Select "All channels" or the desired cate- gory.

4. Select the desired channel.

Via the button in the area of the CD/ DVD player

Press the button for the corresponding direction. The next channel is selected.

Via direct channel entry 1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. "Select channel"

4. Turn the controller until the desired channel is reached and press the controller.

Storing a channel 1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. If necessary, open "All channels" or the desired category.

4. Select the desired channel.

5. Press the controller again.

6. Press the controller again to confirm the highlighted channel.

7. Select the desired memory location.

The channels are stored for the remote control currently in use.

You can also store the channels on the pro- grammable memory keys, refer to page 20.

Changing the list view The list view changes every time the first sym- bol on the navigation bar is pressed.

Information on the channel is displayed.

Symbol Function

Channel name

Artist

Track

S at

el lit

e ra

d io

162

Selecting a category 1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. "Category"

4. Select the desired category.

Timeshift Approx. one hour of the program being broad- cast on the channel currently being listened to is stored in a buffer. Prerequisite: the signal must be available.

The stored audio track can be played with a delay following the live broadcast. When the buffer is full, the older tracks are overwritten. The buffer is cleared when a new channel is selected.

Opening the timeshift function 1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. "Replay - Time shift"

> The red arrow shows the current playback position.

> The time difference to the live broadcast is displayed next to the buffer bar.

> With a live broadcast: "live".

Timeshift menu

Automatic Timeshift With the function activated, the audio playback is automatically stopped when:

> there are incoming and outgoing phone calls.

> the voice activation system is activated.

> muting function is activated.

The audio playback continues after a time delay.

Activating 1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. "Replay - Time shift"

4. "Automatic time shift"

Deactivating "Automatic time shift"

Storing favorites Up to 30 favorites can be stored in the favorites list. Available favorites are artist, track, game, league and team.

Storing the artist, track or game It is only possible to store favorites that are cur- rently being broadcast. The channel informa- tion must be available.

1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. If necessary, select "All channels" or the desired category.

4. Select the desired channel.

5. Press the controller again.

Symbol Function

Go to the live broadcast

Playback/pause

Next track

Previous track

Fast forward

Reverse

Automatic Timeshift deactivated/ activated

Symbol Function

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

163

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

6. Select the artist, track or game.

Storing the league or team Leagues or teams can be added to the favorites from a selection list.

1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. "Manage favorites"

4. "Add sports information"

5. Select the desired league.

6. Select "Add all teams" or the desired team.

Opening the favorites When an activated favorite is playing, the fol- lowing message appears for approx. 20 seconds: "Favorite alert!".

Select "Favorites" while the message is being displayed.

The displayed favorite is played.

If there is no message, the system changes to the My Favorites category. All favorites cur- rently being broadcast can be selected from a list.

Managing the favorites

Activating/deactivating the favorites Favorites can be activated and deactivated glo- bally and individually.

1. "Satellite radio"

2. "Manage favorites"

3. Select "Activate alert" or the desired favor- ite.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Deleting favorites 1. "Satellite radio"

2. "Manage favorites"

3. Highlight the desired favorite.

4. Open "Options".

5. "Delete entry"

Traffic Jump Traffic and weather information for a selected region is broadcast every few minutes.

Selecting a region 1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Set jump"

5. Select the desired region.

The region is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Activating/deactivating the jump 1. "Radio"

2. "Satellite radio"

3. "Jump to:"

Information for the selected region is broadcast as soon as it is available.

A new panel opens.

S at

el lit

e ra

d io

164

Canceling the Traffic Jump: "Cancel".

Select one of the symbols to deactivate Traffic Jump.

Automatic update About twice a year, Sirius performs an update of the channel names and positions. The update takes place automatically and may take several minutes.

Notes > Reception may not be available in some sit-

uations, such as under certain environmen- tal or topographic conditions. The satellite radio cannot influence this.

> The signal may not be available in tunnels or underground garages, next to tall buildings or near trees, mountains or other powerful sources of radio interference.

Symbol Meaning

Information will be broadcast shortly.

Information is currently being broadcast.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

165

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

CD/DVD player and CD changer

CD/DVD playback

Inserting a CD/DVD Insert the CD/DVD into the drive with the labeled side facing up. The CD/DVD is drawn in automatically. Playback starts automatically if the sound out- put is on. For CDs/DVDs with compressed audio files, it can take several minutes to read in the data, depending on the directory structure.

Playable formats CD/DVD player

> DVD: DVD-ROM, DVD-R, DVD+R, DVD- RW, DVD+RW, DVD-R DL, DVD+R DL, DVD audio (video part only), DVD video

> CD: CD-ROM, CD-R, CD-RW, CD-DA, VCD, SVCD

> Compressed audio files: MP3, WMA, AAC

CD changer* > CD: CD-ROM, CD-R, CD-RW, CD-DA

Starting playback

Via iDrive Fill the CD/DVD magazine and insert it, refer to page 169.

To start playback if a CD is already located in the player or changer:

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "CD/DVD"

3. Select the desired CD or DVD:

Eject the CD/DVD Press the button next to the CD/DVD player. The CD/DVD emerges slightly from the drive.

Audio playback

Selecting a track using the button Press the button for the appropriate direction as often as necessary until the desired track is reached.

*

Symbol Function

CD/DVD player

CD changer

C D

/D V

D p

la ye

r a n

d C

D c

h an

g er

166

Selecting a track using iDrive

Audio CDs 1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "CD/DVD"

3. Select the desired CD or DVD.

4. Select the desired track to begin playback.

CDs/DVDs with compressed audio files* Depending on the data, some letters and num- bers of the CD/DVD may not be displayed cor- rectly.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "CD/DVD"

3. Select the desired CD or DVD.

4. Select the directory, if necessary. To change to a higher level directory: move the controller to the left.

5. Select a track and press the controller.

Displaying information about the track* If information about a track has been stored, it is displayed automatically:

> Artist

> Album title

> Number of tracks on the CD/DVD

> Track file name

Random play sequence The tracks on the current CD/DVD are played once in random sequence.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "CD/DVD"

3. Select the desired CD or DVD.

4. Open "Options".

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

167

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

5. "Random"

CDs/DVDs with compressed audio files: the directories and the tracks contained therein are played back in random sequence.

Random mode is switched off when the audio source is changed or the ignition is switched off.

Fast forward/reverse Press and hold the button for the corre- sponding direction.

Automatic repeat* Selected tracks, directories or CDs/DVDs are repeated automatically.

Video playback*

Country codes Only DVDs with the code of the home region can be played back; also refer to the information on your DVD.

Starting playback For your own safety, the video image is only dis- played up to approx. 2 mph/3 km/h, and in some market-specific versions, only with the parking brake engaged or the selector lever in position P.

DVD video 1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "CD/DVD"

3. Select a DVD with video content.

4. "DVD menu"

5. Start the DVD via the DVD menu.

VCD/SVCD 1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "CD/DVD"

3. Select a CD/DVD with video content.

4. "Select track"

5. Select the desired track.

The CD/DVD is started.

Video menu To open the Video menu:

1. Turn the controller during playback.

2. Press the controller when "Back" is dis- played.

The Video menu is displayed:

Code Region

1 USA, Canada

2 Japan, Europe, Middle East, South Africa

3 Southeast Asia

4 Australia, Central and South Amer- ica, New Zealand

5 Northwest Asia, North Africa

6 China

0 All regions

Symbol Function

Open the DVD menu*

Starting playback

Pause

C D

/D V

D p

la ye

r a n

d C

D c

h an

g er

168

In fast forward/reverse: the speed increases every time the controller is pressed. To stop, start playback.

DVD menu 1. If necessary, turn the controller to open the

Video menu.

2. "DVD menu" The DVD menu is displayed. The display depends on the contents of the DVD.

> To select menu items: move and press the controller.

> To change to the Video menu: turn the con- troller and select "Back".

DVD/VCD settings For some DVDs, settings can only be made via the DVD menu; refer also to the information on your DVD.

Language* 1. Turn the controller during playback.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Audio/language"

4. Select the desired language.

The languages that are available depend on the DVD.

Subtitles* Subtitles can be selected if they are contained on the DVD.

1. Turn the controller during playback.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Subtitles"

4. Select the desired language or "Do not dis- play subtitles".

Brightness, contrast, color 1. Turn the controller during playback.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Display settings"

4. "Brightness", "Contrast" or "Color"

5. Turn the controller until the desired setting is displayed, and then press the controller.

Zoom Display the video image on the full screen.

1. Turn the controller during playback.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Additional options"

Stop

Next chapter/next track

Previous chapter/previous track

Fast forward

Reverse

Symbol Function

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

169

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

4. "Zoom mode"

Selecting track DVD video:

1. turn the controller when the DVD menu is displayed.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Additional options"

4. "Select title"

5. Select the desired track.

VCD/SVCD:

1. "Select track"

2. Select the desired track.

Camera angle* The camera angle depends on the DVD.

1. Turn the controller during playback.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Additional options"

4. "Viewing angle"

5. Select the desired camera angle.

Opening the main menu, back These functions are not contained on every DVD. Therefore, they may not be available for use.

CD changer* The BMW CD changer for six CDs is behind the left side panel in the cargo area.

Coupe

Convertible

Removing the CD magazine To insert or remove CDs from the CD magazine, you must first remove it from the CD changer:

1. Push the cover to one side, arrow 1.

2. Press the button, arrow 2. The CD magazine will be ejected.

Push the magazine back in after at least 2 seconds have passed so that the inserted CDs can be read in again.

C D

/D V

D p

la ye

r a n

d C

D c

h an

g er

170

Inserting/removing CDs from the CD magazine

When loading CDs into or removing them from the CD magazine, hold them at their edges and do not touch the reflective signal-sensing area.

Inserting CDs: Insert one CD per compartment with the labeled side up.

Removing CDs: Pull out the desired compartment and take out the CD.

Inserting the CD magazine

Insert the CD magazine all the way in the direc- tion of arrow 1 and close the cover, arrow 2.

The CD changer automatically reads in the loaded CDs and is then ready for operation.

Notes BMW CD/DVD players and changers are officially designated Class 1 laser prod-

ucts. Do not operate if the cover is damaged; otherwise, severe eye damage can result. Do not use self-recorded CDs/DVDs with labels applied as these can become detached during playback due to heat build-up and can cause

irreparable damage to the device. Only use round CDs/DVDs with a standard diameter of 4.7 in/12 cm and do not play CDs/ DVDs with an adapter, e.g. CD singles; other- wise, the CDs or the adapter might jam and no longer eject. Do not use a combined CD/DVD, e.g. DVDPlus; otherwise, the CD/DVD can jam and will no longer eject.<

General malfunctions BMW CD/DVD changers and players have been optimized for performance in vehicles. In some instances they may be more sensitive to faulty CDs/DVDs than stationary devices would be.

If a CD/DVD cannot be played, first check if it has been inserted correctly.

Humidity High levels of humidity can lead to condensa- tion on the CD/DVD or the laser's scan lens and temporarily prevent playback.

Malfunctions with individual CDs/DVDs If malfunctions occur only with particular CDs/ DVDs, this may be due to one of the following reasons.

Self-recorded CDs/DVDs Possible reasons for malfunctions with self- recorded CDs/DVDs are, for example, inconsis- tent data-creation or recording processes, or poor quality or old age of the CD/DVD blank.

Only label CDs/DVDs on the top, with a pen designed for this purpose.

Damage Avoid leaving fingerprints, as well as dust, scratches or moisture on the CDs/DVDs. Keep CDs/DVDs in protective sleeves or cases. Do not subject CDs/DVDs to temperatures above 1227/506, nor to high humidity levels or direct sunlight.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

171

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

CDs/DVDs with copy protection CDs/DVDs are often copy-protected by the manufacturer. This can mean that some CDs/ DVDs cannot be played or can only be played to a limited extent.

MACROVISION This product contains copyrighted technology that is based on multiple registered U.S. pat- ents and the intellectual property of the Macro- vision Corporation and other manufacturers. The use of this copy protection must be approved by Macrovision. Unless otherwise agreed with Macrovision, media with this pro- tection may only be used for private purposes. Copying of this technology is prohibited.

DTS Digital Surround Manufactured under license of US patent numbers: 5,451,942;

5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,487,535 & other patents granted and pending in both the USA and worldwide. DTS and the logo are reg- istered trademarks & DTS Digital Surround and the DTS logos are trademarks of DTS Inc. DTS, Inc. All rights reserved.

M u

si c

co lle

ct io

n

172

Music collection

Storing music The music tracks from CDs, DVDs and USB devices can be stored in the music collection in the vehicle and played from there.

> Audio CD: tracks are converted into a com- pressed audio format when they are stored. If available, information on the album, such as the artist, is stored as well.

> CD/DVD or USB device with compressed audio files: the entire content of the CD/ DVD or the USB device is stored in the vehi- cle as an album. After storing, the tracks and directories can be deleted individually. Files are only stored in the WMA, MP3, and AAC formats. Tracks with DRM copy protection can be stored in the vehicle but cannot be played back.

Regularly back up the music data; other- wise, it could be lost if there is a fault on

the hard drive.<

Music recognition technology and related data are provided by

Gracenote. Gracenote is the industry stan- dard in music recognition technology and related content delivery. For more information, please visit www.gracenote.com.

CD and music-related data from Gracenote, Inc., copyright 2000-2009 Gracenote. Gracenote Software, copyright 2000-2009 Gracenote. This product and service may prac- tice one or more of the following U.S. Patents: #5,987,525; #6,061,680; #6,154,773; #6,161,132; #6,230,192; #6,230,207; #6,240,459; #6,330,593; and other patents issued or pending. Some services supplied under license from Open Globe, Inc. for U.S. Patent: #6,304,523.

Gracenote and CDDB are registered trade- marks of Gracenote. The Gracenote logo and logotype, and the "Powered by Gracenote" logo are trademarks of Gracenote.

Storing files from CDs/DVDs CDs/DVDs can only be stored from the CD/ DVD player.

1. Insert a CD/DVD into the CD/DVD player.

2. "CD/Multimedia"

3. "CD/DVD"

4. Select the symbol for the CD/DVD player.

5. "Store in vehicle"

The music collection is displayed. The tracks are stored and played back in sequence from the music collection.

Observe the following during the storage pro- cess: Do not switch back to the CD/DVD player and do not remove the CD/DVD from the CD/DVD player; otherwise, the storage process will be interrupted. You can switch to the other audio sources with- out interrupting the storage process. Tracks from the current CD/DVD can also be called up, if they have been stored already.

Interrupting storage 1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "CD/DVD"

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

173

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

3. "Storing..."

4. "Cancel storing"

The storage process is interrupted and can be continued at any time.

Continuing the storage process 1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "CD/DVD"

3. Select the symbol for the CD/DVD player.

4. "Continue storing"

Storage of the CD continues at the beginning of the track at which storage was interrupted.

Album information During storage, information such as the name of the artist is stored with the track, if this infor- mation is available in the vehicle database or on the CD.

To update the database, contact your service center.

Storing from a USB device To store music, a suitable device must be con- nected to the USB interface in the glove com- partment.

> Suitable devices: USB mass storage devices, such as USB flash drives or MP3 players with a USB interface.

> Unsuitable devices: USB hard drive, USB hubs, USB memory card readers with multi- ple inserts, Apple iPod/iPhone.

Music from a USB device can be stored only via the USB interface in the glove

compartment.<

1. Connect the USB device to the USB inter- face in the glove compartment.

2. "CD/Multimedia"

3. "Music collection"

4. Open "Options".

5. "Music data import/export"

6. "Import music (USB)"

Playing music

Music search All tracks for which additional information has been stored can be accessed by the music search. Tracks without additional information can be called up via the corresponding album.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "Music collection"

3. "Music search"

M u

si c

co lle

ct io

n

174

4. Select the desired category.

5. To select the desired entry:

> Open "A-Z search" and enter the desired entry.

or

> Select the desired entry from the list.

6. Select additional categories if desired. The tracks found are listed in alphabetical order. Not all categories need to be selected. For example, to search for all tracks by a certain artist, call up that artist only. All of the tracks by that artist are then displayed.

7. "Start play"

Restarting the music search "New search"

Music search by voice* For instructions on the voice activation system, refer to page 22.

1. Press the button on the steering wheel.

To select a track directly:

Say the voice command and the name of the desired track in one sentence.

Current playback The list of tracks that was generated last by the music search or the album selected last.

1. "Current playback"

2. Select the desired track, if necessary.

Top 50 List of the 50 most frequently played tracks.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "Music collection"

3. "Top 50"

4. Select the desired track, if necessary.

Albums All stored albums, listed in order of their storage dates. Symbols indicate the format.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "Music collection"

3. Select the desired album.

2. {Music search}

3. Open the desired category, e.g. {Select artist}.

4. Say the desired entry in the list.

5. Select additional categories if desired.

{Title }

Symbol Format

Audio CD

Compressed audio files

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

175

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Depending on the album, the tracks or the subdirectories of the album are displayed. The first track is played automatically, if possible.

4. To select tracks, change directories if needed. To go up one level in the directory, move the controller to the left.

Random play sequence All tracks of the selection are played back in random order.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "Music collection"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Random"

Managing music

Albums

Renaming an album The name of the album, if available, is automat- ically entered when the album is stored. If the name is unknown, it can be changed later.

An album cannot be renamed while a track from that album is being played.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "Music collection"

3. Highlight the desired album.

4. Open "Options".

5. "Rename album"

6. Select the letters individually.

Deleting an album An album cannot be deleted while a track from it is being played.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "Music collection"

3. Highlight the desired album.

4. Open "Options".

5. "Delete album"

Deleting a track or directory A track cannot be deleted while it is being played.

A directory cannot be deleted while a track from it is being played.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "Music collection"

3. Highlight the directory or track.

4. Open "Options".

5. "Delete folder" or "Delete track".

Free memory capacity Display the free memory capacity in the music collection.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "Music collection"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Free memory"

M u

si c

co lle

ct io

n

176

Music collection

Backing up the music collection The entire music collection can be stored on a USB medium. Make sure there is enough free memory capacity on the USB device.

Depending on the number of tracks, backing up the music collection may take several hours. Therefore, it is best to perform the backup dur- ing a long trip.

1. Start the engine.

2. Connect the USB medium to the USB inter- face in the glove compartment, refer to page 115.

3. "CD/Multimedia"

4. "Music collection"

5. Open "Options".

6. "Music data import/export"

7. "Backup music on USB"

Restoring the music collection in the vehicle

When storing from the USB device, the music collection existing in the vehicle is

replaced.<

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "Music collection"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Music data import/export"

5. "Restore music from USB"

Deleting the music collection 1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "Music collection"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Delete music collection"

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

177

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

External devices

At a glance

AUX-IN port You can connect an external audio device, for instance an MP3 player, and play audio tracks over the car's loudspeaker system. You can adjust the tone using iDrive.

Connecting Lift up the center armrest.

Connection for audio playback: TRS connector 1/8 in/3.5 mm

To play audio tracks over the car's loudspeaker system, connect the headset or line-out port of the external device to the AUX-IN port.

Starting audio playback Connect the audio device, switch it on and select a track. Operate the system on the audio device.

Via iDrive 1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. If applicable, "External devices"

3. "AUX front"

Adjusting the volume The volume of the sound output depends on the audio device. If this volume differs markedly from the volume of the other audio sources, it is advisable to adjust the volumes.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. If applicable, "External devices"

3. "AUX front"

4. "Volume"

5. Turn the controller until the desired volume is set and then press the controller.

Symbol Meaning

AUX-IN port

USB audio interface*/audio inter- face mobile phone*

E xt

er n

al d

ev ic

es

178

USB audio interface*/ extended connectivity of the music player in the mobile phone* It is possible to connect external audio devices/ mobile phones. They can be operated via iDrive. Sound is output on the vehicle loudspeakers.

Options for connecting external devices > Connection via USB audio interface: Apple

iPod/iPhone, USB devices, e.g. MP3 player, USB flash drive, or mobile phones that are supported by the USB audio inter- face.

> Connection via snap-in adapter*, refer to page 184, when equipped with additional connection of music player in the mobile phone: Apple iPhone/mobile phones. Play- back is possible only if no audio device/ mobile phone is connected to the USB audio interface.

Due to the large number of different audio devices/mobile phones available on the market, it cannot be ensured that every audio device/ mobile phone is operable on the vehicle. Ask about suitable audio devices/mobile phones at your BMW center.

Audio files The system can play standard audio formats, e.g. MP3, WMA, WAV (PCM), and AAC, as well as playlists in the M3U format.

Connecting via USB audio interface Lift up the center armrest.

1 AUX-IN port for audio playback: TRS connector 1/8 in/3.5 mm

2 USB interface

Apple iPod/iPhone To connect the device, use the special cable adapter for the Apple iPod/iPhone, available from your BMW center. The cable adapter is required for a flawless connection.

Using the Apple iPod/iPhone cable adapter, connect the Apple iPod/iPhone to the AUX-IN port 1 and USB interface 2. The Apple iPod/iPhone menu structure is sup- ported by the USB audio interface.

USB device When connecting the device use a flexi- ble adapter cable, to protect the USB

interface and your USB device against physical damage.<

Connect the USB device to connector 2, using a flexible adapter cable.

After the device is connected for the first time, the information on all tracks (e.g. artist, type of music) and the playlists are transferred from the USB device to the vehicle. This procedure may take some time. The duration depends on the USB device and the number of tracks.

During transmission, the tracks can be called up via the file directory.

Information from up to four USB devices can be stored in the vehicle, or a total of about 16,000 tracks.

If a fifth USB device is connected or if more than 16,000 tracks are stored, information on exist- ing tracks may be deleted.

Music tracks with integrated Digital Rights Management (DRM) cannot be

played.<

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

179

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Starting audio playback If the audio device has a device name, the name is displayed.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "External devices"

3. Select the symbol. The name of the audio device may appear.

Playback begins with the first track. When an Apple iPhone is connected via the snap-in adapter and an audio device is connected to the AUX-IN port at the same time, the audio signal of the AUX-IN port is played.

Information about the track If information about a track has been stored, it is displayed automatically:

> Artist

> Album title

> Number of tracks

> Track file name

Track search Selection is possible via:

> Playback lists

> Information: type of music, artist, album, title

> Additionally for USB devices: file directory, composer

Track titles are displayed if they have been stored in the Latin alphabet.

Starting the track search 1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "External devices"

3. Select the symbol. The name of the audio device may appear.

4. Select the desired category, "Genre", "Artist".

All entries are displayed in a list. The "A-Z search" can be used to find specific entries.

> Open "A-Z search" and enter the desired entry. When a character is entered, a filter is applied using this character as the first letter. When several characters are entered, all results are displayed that contain this sequence of characters.

> Select the desired entry from the list.

5. Select additional categories if desired.

Not all categories need to be selected. For example, if you wish to display all of the tracks of a particular artist, then only select this artist. All of the tracks by that artist are then displayed.

6. "Start play"

Restarting a track search "New search"

E xt

er n

al d

ev ic

es

180

Playback lists To open playback lists.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "External devices"

3. Select the symbol.

4. "Playlists"

Current playback List of tracks currently being played.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "External devices"

3. Select the symbol.

4. "Current playback"

Random play sequence You can play the tracks in the selected list in random order, e.g. all tracks of a single artist.

1. "CD/Multimedia"

2. "External devices"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Random"

Fast forward/reverse Press and hold the button for the corre- sponding direction.

Notes Do not expose the audio device to extreme environmental conditions, e.g.

very high temperatures, refer to the operating instructions of the audio device. Otherwise, the audio device may become damaged, which could compromise safety while driving.<

Depending on the configuration of the audio files, e.g. bit rates greater than 256 KBit/s, the files may not play back correctly in every case.

Notes on connecting > The connected audio device is supplied

with a maximum current of 500 mA, if the device supports this. Therefore, do not connect the device to the power socket in the vehicle.

> Do not forcibly connect the plug to the USB interface.

> Do not connect devices such as fans or lamps to the USB audio interface.

> Do not connect USB hard drives.

> Do not use the USB audio interface to charge external devices.

N av

ig at

io n

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

D ri

vi n

g t

ip s

181

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls C

om m

un ic

at io

ns M

o b

il it

y

Communications This chapter describes how to use the

telephone, BMW Assist and TeleService.

T el

ep h

o n

e

184

Telephone

The concept Your BMW is equipped with a full preparation package mobile phone. After pairing a suitable mobile phone with the vehicle once, you can operate the mobile phone via the iDrive, the buttons on the steering wheel or using voice commands*.

Once a mobile phone has been paired with your vehicle, it is automatically recognized as soon as it is inside the vehicle while the engine is run- ning or the ignition is switched on. You can store the pairing data for up to four mobile phones simultaneously. If several mobile phones are detected at the same time, the mobile phone last paired can be operated via the vehicle.

Using the telephone inside the vehicle

Using the snap-in adapter* The so-called snap-in adapter, a holder for mobile phones, allows you to charge the mobile phone's battery and connect the mobile phone to your vehicle's outside antenna. This ensures better network reception and consistent repro- duction quality. Please contact your BMW center to find out for which mobile phones there are snap-in adapters available.

For your safety A car phone makes life more convenient in many ways, and can even save lives in an emer- gency. While you should consult your mobile phone's separate operating instructions for a detailed description of safety precautions and information, we request that you direct your particular attention to the following:

Only make entries when the traffic situa- tion allows you to do so. Do not hold the

mobile phone in your hand while you are driving; use the hands-free system instead. If you do

not observe this precaution, your being dis- tracted can endanger vehicle occupants and other road users.<

Suitable mobile phones Please ask your BMW center which mobile phones with Bluetooth interface are supported by the mobile phone preparation package and which mobile phones are compatible with the snap-in adapter. By virtue of their particular software versions, these mobile phones sup- port the functions described in this Owner's Manual. Malfunctions may occur with other mobile phones.

Operating options You can operate the mobile phoneusing:

> Buttons on the steering wheel, refer to page 10

> iDrive, refer to page 16

> Voice commands*, refer to page 192

> Programmable memory keys, refer to page 20

Avoid operating a mobile phone recognized by the vehicle via the mobile phone's keypad; oth- erwise, malfunctions may result.

Start-up

Pairing the mobile phone with the vehicle The following prerequisites must be met:

> Compatible mobile phone: the mobile phone is supported by the full preparation package mobile phone. You can obtain information on the Internet at: www.bmw.com/bluetooth

> The mobile phone is ready to operate.

*

185

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

> Bluetooth has been activated in the vehicle, refer to page 187, and on the mobile phone.

> Depending on the mobile phone, certain settings may be necessary on the mobile phone, e.g. via the following menu items:

> Bluetooth switched on

> Connection must be allowed without requiring further confirmation

> Reconnection

> Depending on the mobile phone type, the power-saving mode setting, for example, may result in a paired mobile phone not being detected by the vehicle.

> For pairing purposes, define any 4 to 16- digit number as a Bluetooth passkey, e.g. 25081107. A long and complex number offers the best protection against unautho- rized access. This Bluetooth passkey is no longer required after pairing is successful.

> The ignition is switched on.

Pair the mobile phone with the vehicle only when the car is stationary, to avoid

endangering the car's occupants and other road users by being distracted.<

Switch on ignition 1. Insert remote control all the way into the

ignition lock.

2. Switch on ignition without operating the brake or clutch or pressing the start/stop button.

Preparation via iDrive 3. "Telephone"

4. "Bluetooth (telephone)"

5. "Add new phone"

The Bluetooth name of the vehicle is dis- played.

Preparation via the mobile phone 6. Further steps must be carried out with the

mobile phone and vary depending on the model. Please refer to your mobile phone's operating instructions, e.g. under the topics of Searching for a Bluetooth device, Linking or Pairing. The Bluetooth name of the vehicle appears on the mobile phone display.

7. Select the Bluetooth name of the vehicle on the mobile phone display.

Pairing Depending on your mobile phone, you will see messages, first on the mobile phone display or on the iDrive, requesting you to enter the same Bluetooth passkey previously determined by you.

8. Enter the Bluetooth passkey. Depending on the mobile phone, you will have approx. 30 seconds to enter your Bluetooth passkey on the mobile phone and the Control Display.

If the pairing was successful, the mobile phone appears at the top of the list of mobile phones.

T el

ep h

o n

e

186

Following the initial pairing > The mobile phone is detected/connected in

the vehicle within a short time if the engine is running or the ignition is switched on.

> As soon as a mobile phone is detected by the vehicle, the phone book entries stored on the SIM card or on your mobile phone are transmitted to the vehicle. This transmis- sion is dependent on your mobile phone, refer to the operating instructions of the mobile phone if necessary, and can take several minutes.

> Four mobile phones can be paired.

> Specific settings may be necessary in some mobile phones, e.g. authorization or a secure connection, refer to the mobile phone operating instructions.

If not all phone book entries are displayed:

> Transfer all phone book entries from the SIM card to the mobile phone, if necessary.

> Phone book entries with special characters may not be displayed.

Checks to perform if pairing is unsuccessful > Is the mobile phone supported by the

mobile phone preparation package? You can obtain information on the Internet at: www.bmw.com/bluetooth

> Do the Bluetooth passkeys on the mobile phone and vehicle match? The same Blue- tooth passkey must be entered on the mobile phone's display and via iDrive.

> Did it take you more than 30 seconds to enter the Bluetooth passkey? Then repeat the pairing procedure.

> Are too many Bluetooth devices connected to the mobile phone? If so, delete the con- nections with other devices on the mobile phone.

> Is the mobile phone no longer responding? Switch the mobile phone off and on or briefly disconnect the power supply.

> Repeat the pairing procedure.

> If all items on the list have been checked and the mobile phone still cannot be paired, please contact Customer Relations.

Connecting a particular mobile phone If more than one mobile phone is detected by the vehicle, the mobile phone at the top of the list is connected. A different mobile phone can be connected by selecting it.

1. "Telephone"

2. "Bluetooth (telephone)"

3. Select the desired mobile phone.

Unpairing the mobile phone from the vehicle 1. "Telephone"

2. "Bluetooth (telephone)"

3. Highlight the mobile phone that is to be unpaired.

4. Open "Options".

5. "Remove phone from list"

The unpaired mobile phone is deleted from the list. The phone book entries and the lists of stored phone numbers are deleted as well.

187

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Activating/deactivating the Bluetooth link

The use of Bluetooth technology is not permitted in all countries. Observe all

applicable local regulations. Temporarily deac- tivate the Bluetooth link between the vehicle and the mobile phone, if necessary. If the Bluetooth link is deactivated, you can no longer operate the mobile phone via the vehicle, and other devices with a Bluetooth interface can be used in combination with the mobile phone, e.g. a laptop.<

To temporarily deactivate the Bluetooth link between the vehicle and your mobile phone:

1. "Telephone"

2. Open "Options".

3. "Bluetooth"

Adapting volumes

Turn the knob until the desired volume is set.

Adjusting the volume for:

> Ring volume

> Call volume

These volumes are maintained for the hands- free system, even if you set the other audio sources to minimum volume.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Operation via iDrive You can operate the following functions using iDrive:

> Accepting/rejecting calls

> dialing phone numbers

> Selecting phone numbers from the phone book

> Selecting stored phone numbers, e.g. from the list of received calls

> Ending a call

When the ignition is switched off or in radio readiness, e.g. after taking the remote control out of the ignition lock, you can continue an ongoing call via the hands-free system for sev- eral minutes.

Voice quality If the person you are talking to is having difficul- ties understanding you, this may be due to excessive background noise. The full prepara- tion package mobile phone can compensate for these noises to a certain extent. To optimize voice quality during a call, we recommend that you:

> Reduce background noise, e.g. by closing the windows, reducing air flow from the automatic climate control or pointing the open front air vents downward.

> Reduce the volume of the hands-free sys- tem.

Requirements > The mobile phone's pairing data are

stored by the vehicle and the mobile phone is operational.

> The engine is running or the ignition is switched on.

> The mobile phone is recognized by the vehicle.

T el

ep h

o n

e

188

Receiving calls If you have the phone number of the caller stored in the phone book and the phone num- ber has been transmitted, the name of the entry is displayed.

Accepting a call Press the button on the steering wheel

or

"Accept"

Rejecting a call "Reject" The caller is diverted to your mailbox if the mail- box was activated.

Ending a call Press the button on the steering wheel

or

1. "Telephone"

2. "Active calls"

3. Select an active call.

Dialing phone numbers 1. "Telephone"

2. "Dial number"

3. Select the digits individually.

4. Select this symbol to establish the con- nection

or press the button on the steering wheel.

The phone number can also be entered using voice commands*, refer to page 192.

For your phone number to be displayed to the person you are talking to, the display of phone numbers must be enabled by your provider.

Calls with multiple parties You can switch between calls and combine two calls to a single conference call. These func- tions must be supported by the mobile phone and the service provider.

Accepting a call while speaking to another party This function depends on the service provider and may have to be enabled. The mobile phone may have to be set up accordingly.

If a second call comes in during an active call, you will hear a call waiting signal.

"Accept"

The call is accepted and the existing call is put on hold.

189

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Establishing a second call Establish another call during an active call.

1. "Telephone"

2. "Active calls"

3. "Hold"

The existing call is put on hold.

4. Dial the new phone number or select it from a list.

Switching between two calls, toggling > Active call: indicated by a red handset

> Call on hold: indicated by a green handset

To switch to the call on hold, select this hand- set.

Establishing a conference call Two calls can be connected to a single tele- phone conference call.

1. Establish two calls.

2. "Conference call"

When terminating a conference call, both calls are ended. If the call is terminated by one of the other parties, the other conversation may be continued.

Phone book The phone book accesses the contacts* and shows all contacts for which a phone number has been stored. The entries can be selected to make a call.

1. "Telephone"

2. "Phone book"

All contacts with a phone number are displayed. A symbol indicates the storage location of the contacts.

Symbol Storage location

No symbol In the vehicle; the address has not been checked as a destination.

In the vehicle; the address has been checked as a des- tination.

Mobile phone

T el

ep h

o n

e

190

Calling a contact 1. Select the desired contact.

A connection is established immediately if calling contacts with one phone number.

For contacts with several phone numbers:

2. Select the desired phone number. The connection is established.

Editing a contact The entries in the contacts can be changed. When a contact from the mobile phone is changed, the changes are not stored on the mobile phone. A copy of the entry is stored in the vehicle.

1. Highlight the contact.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Edit entry"

The contact can be edited.

Redialing The eight phone numbers dialed last are stored.

Dialing the number via iDrive 1. "Telephone"

2. "Redial"

3. Select the desired entry. The connection is established.

Deleting entries individually or deleting all entries 1. Highlight an entry.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Delete entry" or "Delete list".

Saving an entry in the contacts 1. Highlight an entry.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Store as new contact" or "Add to existing contact".

4. Select the type of number: "Home", "Busi- ness", "Mobile" or "Other".

5. Complete the entries if necessary.

6. "Store contact in vehicle"

Received calls The 20 calls that were last received are dis- played.

1. "Telephone"

2. "Received calls"

Calling a number from the list Select an entry. The connection is established.

Deleting entries individually or deleting all entries 1. Highlight an entry.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Delete entry" or "Delete list".

Symbol Meaning

Contact with one phone number.

Contact with more than one phone number.

Call not possible. Mobile phone has no reception or network or does not have Teleservice Call* activated.

191

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Saving an entry in the contacts 1. Highlight an entry.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Store as new contact" or "Add to existing contact".

4. Select the type of number: "Home", "Busi- ness", "Mobile" or "Other".

5. Complete the entries if necessary.

6. "Store contact"

Messages Various types of messages can be displayed:

> Messages from My info

> Messages from the BMW Concierge ser- vice

Displaying messages 1. "Telephone"

2. "Messages"

3. Select the desired message.

My Info To start destination guidance:

1. Select the message that contains the desired destination.

2. "Start guidance" or "Add as another dest.".

To dial the number in the message:

1. Select the message that contains the desired number.

2. "Call"

Messages from the concierge service To use the address in destination guidance*:

1. Select the message.

2. "Start guidance" or "Add as another dest.".

3. Start destination guidance, if necessary.

To dial a phone number:

1. Select the message.

2. "Call"

To save an address:

1. Select the message.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Store contact in vehicle"

Deleting messages 1. Select the message to be deleted.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Delete message" or "Delete all messages"

T el

ep h

o n

e

192

Switching between mobile phone and hands-free system

From mobile phone to hands-free system* You can continue ongoing calls outside of the vehicle's Bluetooth range via the hands-free system as long as the engine is running or the ignition is switched on. Depending on your mobile phone, the system automatically switches to hands-free mode.

With mobile phones that do not automatically switch to hands-free mode:

Depending on the type of mobile phone you are using, it may be possible to continue the con- versation via the hands-free system. Refer to the display on your mobile phone and/or your mobile phone's operating instructions.

From hands-free system to mobile phone If you are making a call via the hands-free sys- tem, it may be possible to continue the call via the mobile phone, depending on your mobile phone model. Refer to the display on your mobile phone and/or your mobile phone's oper- ating instructions.

Alternatively, you can deactivate the Bluetooth link, refer to page 187.

Depending on the type of mobile phone you are using, it may occur that calls are switched from the hands-free system to the mobile phone if reception of the wireless network is poor.

Operation by voice commands*

The concept > You can operate your mobile phone without

having to take a hand off the steering wheel.

> {...} Verbal instructions to use with the voice activation system.

Requirements The same prerequisites apply as for operation via iDrive, refer to page 187.

Saying commands

Activating voice activation system 1. Briefly press the button on the steering

wheel. A sound signal indicates that you can say commands.

2. Say the command.

Ending/canceling operation by voice commands Briefly press the button on the steering wheel or

In dialogs not involving voice commands, i.e. when you are speaking only text, e.g. a name, canceling is possible only via the button on the steering wheel.

Having the possible commands read aloud The system recognizes specific commands that must be pronounced exactly word for word. You can have the possible commands for any function read aloud to you:

Digits from zero to nine are recognized.

You can say each digit individually or group them into a sequence to accelerate the input.

Using alternative commands Often there is more than a single command to run a function, e.g.:

{Cancel}.

{Help}.

{Dial name} or {Name}.

193

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Example: dialing phone numbers To start the dialog:

Press the button on the steering wheel.

Adjusting the volume of the instructions You can adjust the volume for the instructions from the system:

Turn the button during an instruction.

This volume for the instructions is maintained, even if the other audio sources are set to mini- mum volume.

The setting is stored for the remote control cur- rently in use.

Calling

Dialing phone numbers

The connection to the desired subscriber is established.

Correcting phone numbers After the last spoken sequence of digits has been repeated by the system, you can delete this sequence of digits.

You have the option of repeating the command {Correct number} until all of the digits have been deleted.

Deleting phone numbers

All digits entered up to this point are deleted.

Redialing To redial the phone number dialed last:

Voice-activated phone book* Depending on the vehicle 's equipment, it can be necessary to establish a separate voice-acti- vate phone book.

For entries in the voice-activated phone book, only use names in the language of the voice activation system and no abbreviations.

The entries must be entered using voice com- mands and are separate from the memory in the mobile phone. In this case, phone numbers stored on the mobile phone cannot be called up or saved there using voice commands. Up to 50 entries can be set up. An entry always con- sists of a name and a phone number.

You say Voice command response

{Dial number} {{Please say the number}}

e.g. {123 456 7890} Depending on your equipment version: {{123 456 7890. Continue ?}}

{Dial} The system dials the displayed phone number.

1. {Dial number}.

2. Say the phone number. For telephone calls abroad, say {Plus} and then the country code.

3. {Dial}.

{Correct number}. The digits are deleted.

{Delete}.

{Redial}.

T el

ep h

o n

e

194

Creating and editing a voice phone book To store an entry:

An entry always consists of a name and a phone number.

To delete an entry:

You can delete any entry from the voice phone book.

To delete all entries:

{Delete phonebook} deletes all entries in the phone book.

To listen to and select the entries:

You can have all entries in your voice phone book read aloud in the order in which they were entered and select a specific entry to establish a connection:

Selecting an entry The connection to the phone number of the selected entry is established.

Notes

Notes on Emergency Requests Do not use the voice activation system to ini- tiate an Emergency Request. In stressful situa- tions, the voice and vocal pitch can change. This can unnecessarily delay the establishment of a telephone connection. Use the SOS but- ton* instead, refer to page 239.

Important for voice commands For voice commands, bear in mind the follow- ing:

> Say the commands, numbers and letters smoothly and with normal volume, emphasis and speed.

> Always say commands in the language of the voice activation system.

> Keep the doors, windows, glass roof* or convertible top* closed to prevent interfer- ence from outside noise.

> Avoid ambient noise in the vehicle while speaking.

1. {Save name}.

2. Say the name. Saying the name for the voice phone book should not take longer than approx. 2 seconds.

3. Say the phone number after being prompted to do so by the system.

4. To save the phone number: {save}.

1. {Delete name}. The dialog for deleting an entry opens.

2. Say the name when prompted.

3. Confirm the query with {Yes}.

1. {Delete phonebook}. The dialog for deleting the phone book opens.

2. Confirm the query with {Yes}.

3. Confirm the query again with {Yes}.

1. {Read phonebook}. The dialog for reading the phone book opens.

2. Say {Dial number} when the desired entry is read.

1. {Dial name}. The dialog for selecting an entry is opened.

2. Say the name when prompted.

3. Confirm the query with {Yes}.

195

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Inserting/removing the snap-in adapter* 1. Press button 1 and remove the cover.

2. Insert the snap-in adapter in the front and press it downward until it engages.

To remove the snap-in adapter: Press button 1.

Inserting mobile phone 1. If applicable, remove the protective cap

from the mobile phone's antenna connector so that the mobile phone can engage in the snap-in adapter.

2. With its buttons facing upward, slide the mobile phone up towards the electrical con- tact points and press it downward until it engages.

The mobile phone's battery is charged as soon as the vehicle is in radio readiness or the steer- ing is unlocked.

To conserve vehicle battery power, you should avoid using the mobile phone

when the ignition is switched off.<

Removing mobile phone

Press the button.

C o

n ta

ct s

196

Contacts

You can create and edit contacts. The contacts from the mobile phone* are displayed as well if this function is supported by the mobile phone. The addresses can be used as destinations for navigation and the phone numbers can be dialed.

New contact 1. "Contacts"

2. "New contact"

3. If the entry fields are still filled with the pre- vious entries, select "Delete input fields".

4. To fill in the entry fields: Select the symbol next to the entry field.

5. Enter the text.

If the vehicle is equipped with a navi- gation system, it is only possible to

enter addresses that are contained in the navigation data in the vehicle. This ensures that destination guidance is possible for all addresses.<

6. If applicable, "Store"

7. "Store contact in vehicle"

Specifying a contact as the home address A contact can be stored as a home address. It is placed at the top of "My contacts".

1. "Home"

2. Create contact.

My contacts A list of all contacts in the vehicle and on the mobile phone*.

Displaying contacts 1. "Contacts"

2. "My contacts"

All contacts are listed in alphabetical order. Depending on the number of contacts, an A-Z search is offered. A symbol indicates the stor- age location of the contacts:

Displaying the detailed view* Select the desired contact. All fields that have been filled in for that contact are displayed.

*

Symbol Storage location

No symbol In the vehicle; the address has not been checked as a destination.

In the vehicle; the address has been checked as a desti- nation.

Mobile phone*

197

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Selecting name display Names can be displayed in different sequences.

1. "My contacts"

2. Highlight the contact.

3. Open "Options".

4. "Display: last, first name" or "Display: first, last name"

Depending on how the contacts were stored in your mobile phone, the name display can differ from the selected display.

Selecting a contact as the navigation destination 1. "My contacts"

2. Select the desired contact.

3. Select the desired address.

Contacts from the mobile phone* may contain addresses that do not match the navigation data contained in the vehicle and thus cannot be used for destination guidance. In this case: Manually correct the address.

Checking the address as a destination* An address that is to be used for destination guidance must match the navigation data con- tained in the vehicle. An address that is stored on the mobile phone can be matched to the navigation data.

1. Select the desired contact and highlight the address.

2. Open "Options".

3. "Check as destination"

4. Correct and store the address, if necessary.

If the address is corrected and stored, then a copy is created in the vehicle. The address is not changed on the mobile phone.

Dialing a phone number* 1. "My contacts"

2. Select the desired contact.

3. Select the desired phone number.

The connection is established.

Editing a contact 1. "My contacts"

2. Select the desired contact.

3. "Edit contact"

4. Change the entries.

5. Move the controller to the left.

6. "Yes"

If a contact from the mobile phone* is edited, the changes are not stored on the mobile phone. A copy of the entry is stored in the vehi- cle, and only this copy is displayed. When cer- tain prerequisites are met, a specifically identi- cal contact entry is established.

Deleting contacts Only contacts that are stored in the vehicle are deleted. The contacts on the mobile phone* cannot be deleted.

1. "My contacts"

2. Highlight the contact.

3. Open "Options".

4. "Delete contact" or "Delete all contacts".

B M

W A

ss is

t

198

BMW Assist

BMW Assist* BMW Assist provides a number of different ser- vices. For example, the position data of the vehicle can be transmitted to the BMW Assist Response Center when an Emergency Request* is sent.

Many BMW Assist services depend on the con- tract individually agreed upon.

After your contract has expired, the BMW Assist system will be deactivated by the BMW Assist Response Center without you having to visit a BMW center. After the BMW Assist sys- tem has been deactivated, no BMW Assist ser- vices will be available. The BMW Assist system can be reactivated by a BMW center after a new contract has been signed.

Requirements > The installed BMW Assist system is logged

in to a wireless communications network. This network must be capable of transmit- ting the services.

> To transmit position data, the vehicle must be able to determine its current position.

> To activate and update BMW Assist, a GPS signal must be available.

> The BMW Assist service contract was signed with your BMW center or with the BMW Assist Response Center. The service must have been fully enabled.

> BMW Assist is activated.

Services offered > Emergency Request: when you press the

SOS button, a connection to the BMW Assist Response Center is established. The BMW Assist Response Center then speaks with you and takes further steps to help you.

> Automatic Collision Notification: under cer- tain conditions, a connection to the BMW Assist Response Center is established after a serious accident. If possible, the BMW Assist Response Center then speaks with you and takes further steps to help you.

> Enhanced Roadside Assistance: BMW Roadside Assistance* can be contacted if assistance is needed in the event of a breakdown. If possible, the vehicle data and position data are transmitted during this call.

> Customer Relations: connection to Cus- tomer Relations for information on all aspects of your vehicle.

> TeleService: data on your vehicle's service status or required inspections are transmit- ted to your BMW center, either automati- cally before a service due date or when you request a BMW service appointment.

> Remote Door Unlock: the BMW Assist Response Center provides assistance if, for example, the remote control is not available and the vehicle needs to be opened.

> Stolen Vehicle Recovery: after you report to the police that your vehicle was stolen, the BMW Assist Response Center can deter- mine its position.

> In addition, the optional Convenience Plan offers a concierge service and information on route planning, the traffic situation and weather. Using Critical Calling, a limited number of calls can be made via the BMW Assist Response Center, for example if the mobile phone is not available or discharged. Press the SOS button to contact the BMW Assist Response Center.

*

199

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

TeleService* TeleService supports communication with your BMW center.

> Data on the vehicle's service requirements can be sent directly to the BMW center. In this way, the BMW center can plan its work in advance. This shortens the duration of the service appointment.

> In the event of a breakdown, data on the vehicle's condition can be sent directly to Roadside Assistance*.

> The service varies by country.

> Connection may incur charges.

> Services may be restricted abroad.

Requirements > BMW Assist is activated.

> Wireless reception is available.

> The engine is running.

Concierge service* When you call the BMW Assist Concierge ser- vice, you can obtain information about, for example, restaurants, emergency pharmacy services, gas stations or hotels, as well as receive the corresponding telephone numbers and addresses.

You can then dial a phone number directly or use an address for destination guidance*.

Starting the concierge service 1. "BMW Assist"

2. "Concierge"

3. "Start service"

A voice connection is established to the BMW Concierge service.

You are connected to an employee of the BMW Concierge service to obtain the required infor- mation. You can then have the phone number and address sent to you and, for example, use it for destination guidance in the navigation sys- tem. Many hotels can be booked directly through the BMW Assist Concierge service. When an information message is received, a list of the received messages is displayed automat- ically. Open the message via the message list, refer to page 191.

Roadside Assistance You can call BMW Roadside Assistance* should you require help in the event of a break- down.

Starting Roadside Assistance

Vehicle not equipped with BMW Assist or BMW TeleService 1. "BMW Assist"

2. "Roadside Assistance"

The BMW Roadside Assistance number is displayed. If a mobile phone* is paired, a connection is established to BMW Road- side Assistance.

B M

W A

ss is

t

200

Vehicle equipped with BMW Assist or BMW TeleService 1. "BMW Assist"

2. "Roadside Assistance"

3. "Start service"

TeleService Diagnosis* TeleService Diagnosis enables the wireless transmission of detailed vehicle data that are important for vehicle diagnosis. TeleService Diagnosis can be started after a prompt by Roadside Assistance and termination of the voice connection.

TeleService Help* TeleService Help enables an in-depth diagno- sis of the vehicle by Roadside Assistance via wireless transmission. TeleService Help can be started after a prompt by Roadside Assistance and termination of the voice connection.

Starting TeleService Help 1. Park the vehicle in a safe place.

2. Set the parking brake.

3. The engine is running.

4. "TeleService Help"

After completion of TeleService Help, a voice connection is established to Roadside Assis- tance.

Activating BMW Assist* If the services included in a valid BMW Assist subscription are not displayed, they may need to be activated.

1. Make sure that the vehicle can determine its current position. Reception is usually best when you have an unobstructed view to the sky.

2. Switch on the ignition.

3. "Activate BMW Assist"

Activation may take several minutes. If another menu is opened, activation continues running in the background.

BMW Search* BMW Search is an online portal that makes cer- tain services available for use in your vehicle, e.g. information on restaurants along your route.

License conditions:

This product contains NetFront Browser soft- ware of ACCESS Co., Ltd. Copyright 2007 ACCESS Co., Ltd. All rights reserved. NetFront is a trademark or registered trademark of ACCESS Co., Ltd., in Japan and other coun- tries.

This software is based in part on the work of the Independent JPEG Group.

Requirements > Subscription to the optional

Convenience Plan.

> The vehicle is located within wireless network coverage.

> The date setting on the Control Display is current.

201

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Starting BMW Search 1. "BMW Assist"

2. "BMW Search"

3. Select "OK", if necessary.

The BMW Search start page is displayed.

Using BMW Search To select and display content:

> Turn the controller to highlight an element.

> Press the controller to display an element.

Opening the start page 1. Open "Options".

2. "Display start page"

Loading a new page 1. Open "Options".

2. "Reload"

Canceling 1. Open "Options".

2. "Cancel loading"

Customer Relations

At a glance Contact Customer Relations for information on all aspects of your vehicle.

Calling Customer Relations

Vehicle equipped with BMW Assist or BMW TeleService 1. "BMW Assist"

2. "Customer Relations"

3. "Start service"

A voice connection is established to Customer Relations.

Vehicle not equipped with BMW Assist or BMW TeleService 1. "BMW Assist"

2. "Customer Relations"

The Customer Relations phone number is dis- played. If the vehicle is equipped with the mobile phone preparation package, a voice connection is established.

Service Request*

At a glance You can send a request to your BMW center to arrange a service appointment. The TeleService data is transmitted during a Service Request. If possible, your BMW center will establish contact with you.

B M

W A

ss is

t

202

Starting a Service Request 1. "BMW Assist"

2. "Service Request"

3. "Start service"

Automatic Service Request* The TeleService data necessary for servicing the vehicle are automatically sent to your BMW center prior to the service deadline. If possible, the center will contact you and a service appointment can be arranged.

You can check when the BMW center was noti- fied.

1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Vehicle status"

3. Open "Options".

4. "Last Service Request"

Data transfer* The status of the data transfer is displayed.

1. "BMW Assist"

2. Open "Options".

3. "Data transfer"

Service status*

Displaying available services Display of all services available in the vehicle.

1. "BMW Assist"

2. "Service status"

3. "Available services"

BMW Assist, activating If the services included in a BMW Assist sub- scription are not displayed, they may need to be activated.

"Activate BMW Assist"

203

E n

te rt

a in

m e

n t

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n M

o b

il it

y

Mobility This section helps you maintain your car's

mobility by supplying important information on vital topics including fuels and lubricants,

wheels and tires, service, maintenance and roadside assistance.

R ef

u el

in g

206

Refueling

Always switch off the engine before refu- eling; otherwise, fuel cannot be added to

the tank and a message will be displayed.<

Take all precautionary measures and observe all applicable regulations when

handling fuel. Do not carry any spare fuel con- tainers in your vehicle. They can develop a leak and cause an explosion or cause a fire in the event of an accident.<

Fuel filler flap

Opening

1. Open the fuel filler flap. To do so, lightly press the rear edge.

2. Turn the gas cap counterclockwise.

3. Place the gas cap in the bracket attached to the fuel filler flap.

Closing Fit the cap and turn it clockwise until you clearly hear a click.

Do not pinch the band attached to the cap; otherwise, the cap cannot be closed

properly and fuel vapors can escape. A mes- sage will be displayed if the gas cap is loose or missing.<

Manually releasing the fuel filler flap In the event of a malfunction, you can release the fuel filler flap manually:

Coupe

1. Remove the cover from the right-hand side- wall of the cargo area.

2. Pull the knob with the fuel pump symbol. The fuel filler flap is released.

Convertible

1. Loosen the right-hand cargo area trim panel by turning the screws by 90, see arrow.

2. Slightly lift the top section of the panel. It is not necessary to remove the entire panel.

3. Pull the knob with the fuel pump symbol. The fuel filler flap is released.

M o

b il

it y

207

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Observe the following when refueling When handling fuels, follow the safety instructions provided at filling stations;

otherwise, there is a risk of personal injury or property damage.<

When refueling, insert the filler nozzle com- pletely into the filler pipe. Avoid lifting the filler nozzle while filling the tank, as that would lead to

> Premature pump shutoff

> Reduced efficiency of the fuel-vapor recov- ery system.

The fuel tank is full when the filler nozzle clicks off the first time.

Fuel tank capacity Approx. 16.1 US gallons/61 liters, including the reserve capacity of 2.1 US gallons/8 liters.

Refuel as soon as possible once your cruising range falls below 30 miles/

50 km; otherwise, engine functions are not ensured and damage can occur.<

Fuel specifications

Gasoline engine: required fuel Do not refuel with leaded fuel; otherwise, the catalytic converter will be damaged.

Do not fill the tank with E85, i.e. fuel containing 85 ethanol, nor with FlexFuel. Otherwise, the engine and fuel supply system will be dam- aged.<

Super Premium Gasoline/AKI 91 This gasoline is highly recommended.

However, you may also use gasoline with less AKI. The minimum AKI Rating is:

> 328i/xDrive: 87

> 335i, 335i/xDrive: 89.

If you use gasoline with this minimum AKI Rat- ing, the engine may produce knocking sounds when starting at high outside temperatures. This has no effect on the engine life.

Do not use any gasoline below the speci- fied minimum fuel grade. Otherwise, the

engine could be damaged.<

Use high-quality brands Field experience has indicated significant dif- ferences in fuel quality: volatility, composition, additives, etc., among gasolines offered for sale in the United States and Canada. Fuels contain- ing up to and including 10 ethanol or other oxygenates with up to 2.8 oxygen by weight, that is, 15 MTBE or 3 methanol plus an equivalent amount of cosolvent, will not void the applicable warranties with respect to defects in materials or workmanship.

The use of poor-quality fuels may result in drivability, starting and stalling problems

especially under certain environmental condi- tions such as high ambient temperature and high altitude. Should you encounter drivability problems which you suspect could be related to the fuel you are using, we recommend that you respond by switching to a recognized high-quality brand such as gasoline that is advertised as Top Tier Detergent Gasoline. Failure to comply with these recommendations may also result in unscheduled maintenance.<

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

208

Wheels and tires

Tire inflation pressures

Information for your safety It is not merely the tires' service life, but also driving comfort and, to a great extent, driving safety that depend on the condition of the tires and the maintenance of the specified tire pres- sure.

Check the tire inflation pressure regularly and correct it, if necessary: at least twice a

month and before starting long trips. If you fail to observe this precaution you may be driving on tires with incorrect tire pressures, a condi- tion that can not only compromise your vehi- cle's driving stability, but also lead to tire dam- age and the risk of an accident. Do not drive with deflated, i.e. flat tires, except when using run-flat tires. A flat tire will seriously impair your vehicle's handling and braking response. Attempts to drive on a flat tire can lead to loss of control over the vehicle.<

Checking pressure Only check tire inflation pressure when the tires are cold. This means after a maximum of 1.25 miles/2 km driving or when the vehicle has been parked for at least 2 hours. When tires are warm, the tire inflation pressure is higher.

After correcting the tire inflation pressure, reset the Tire Pressure Monitor, refer to

page 95, or reinitialize the Flat Tire Monitor, refer to page 93.<

Inflation pressure specifications The tables below provide all the correct inflation pressures for the specified tire sizes at ambient temperature.

The inflation pressures apply to the tire sizes approved and tire brands recom-

mended by BMW; a list of these is available from your BMW center.<

For correct identification of the right tire infla- tion pressures, observe the following:

> Tire sizes for your vehicle

> Load conditions

> Maximum allowable driving speed

Tire inflation pressures for driving up to 100 mph or 160 km/h For normal driving up to 100 mph or 160 km/h and to achieve optimum driving comfort, adjust pressures to the respective tire inflation pres- sures listed on the following pages in the col- umns for traveling speeds up to a maximum of 100 mph or 160 km/h.

These tire inflation pressures can also be found on the driver's side door post when the driver's door is open.

The maximum permissible speed for these tire pressures is 100 mph or

160 km/h. Do not exceed this speed; otherwise, tire damage and accidents could occur.<

Tire inflation pressures for driving above 100 mph or 160 km/h

In order to drive at maximum speeds in excess of 100 mph or 160 km/h, adjust

pressures to the respective tire inflation pres- sures listed on the following pages in the col- umns for traveling speeds including those exceeding 100 mph or 160 km/h. Otherwise, tire damage and accidents could occur.<

Observe all national and local maximum speed limits; otherwise, violations of the laws could occur.

M o

b il

it y

209

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Coupe: tire inflation pressures for the 328i

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph / 160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those

exceeding 100 mph / 160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

Without Sport Package:

205/55 R 16 91 H M+S 225/50 R 16 92 H M+S 225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 225/45 R 17 91 V

32/220 38/260 36/250 44/300

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 32/220 39/270 36/250 44/300

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 36/250 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 35/240 - 39/270

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 32/220 - 36/250 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 39/270 - 42/290

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 36/250 - 36/250 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 44/300 - 44/300

With Sport Package:

205/55 R 16 91 H M+S 225/50 R 16 92 H M+S 225/45 R 17 91 H M+S

32/220 38/260 36/250 44/300

225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 38/260 42/290 49/340

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 32/220 39/270 42/290 49/340

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 35/240 - 44/300

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 32/220 - 39/270 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 39/270 - 46/320

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 36/250 - 39/270 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 44/300 - 46/320

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 249.

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

210

Coupe: tire inflation pressures for the 328xi

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph / 160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those

exceeding 100 mph / 160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

Without Sport Package:

205/55 R 16 91 H M+S 225/50 R 16 92 H M+S 225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 225/45 R 17 91 V

32/220 38/260 35/240 42/290

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 32/220 39/270 36/250 44/300

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 33/230 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 33/230 - 39/270

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 33/230 - 36/250 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 38/260 - 42/290

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 39/270 - 39/270 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 44/300 - 44/300

With Sport Package:

205/55 R 16 91 H M+S 225/50 R 16 92 H M+S 225/45 R 17 91 H M+S

32/220 38/260 35/240 42/290

225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 38/260 41/280 48/330

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 32/220 39/270 41/280 48/330

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 41/280 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 33/230 - 42/290

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 33/230 - 39/270 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 38/260 - 46/320

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 39/270 - 41/280 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 44/300 - 46/320

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 249.

M o

b il

it y

211

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Coupe: tire inflation pressures for the 335i

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph / 160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those

exceeding 100 mph / 160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

Without Sport Package:

225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 32/220 39/270 38/260 45/310

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 33/230 41/280 38/260 45/310

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 35/240 - 41/280

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 32/220 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 39/270 - 45/310

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 Y 32/220 - 35/240 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 Y - 39/270 - 41/280

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 38/260 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 45/310 - 45/310

With Sport Package:

225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 32/220 39/270 38/260 45/310

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 33/230 41/280 42/290 49/340

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 35/240 - 44/300

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 32/220 - 41/280 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 39/270 - 48/330

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 Y 32/220 - 36/250 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 Y - 39/270 - 44/300

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 38/260 - 41/280 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 45/310 - 48/330

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 249.

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

212

Coupe: tire inflation pressures for the 335xi

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph / 160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those

exceeding 100 mph / 160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

Without Sport Package:

225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 32/220 39/270 39/270 45/310

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 33/230 41/280 39/270 45/310

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 39/270 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 35/240 - 39/270

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 35/240 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 39/270 - 42/290

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 Y 35/240 - 35/240 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 Y - 39/270 - 39/270

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 39/270 - 39/270 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 45/310 - 45/310

With Sport Package:

225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 32/220 39/270 39/270 45/310

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 33/230 41/280 42/290 49/340

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 39/270 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 35/240 - 44/300

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 35/240 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 39/270 - 48/330

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 Y 35/240 - 39/270 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 Y - 39/270 - 42/290

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 39/270 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 45/310 - 48/330

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 249.

M o

b il

it y

213

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Coupe: inflation pressures 335is

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph / 160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those

exceeding 100 mph / 160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 32/220 39/270 38/260 45/310

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 35/240 42/290 44/300 49/340

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 33/230 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 41/280 - 49/340

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 Y 33/230 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 Y - 41/280 - 45/310

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 39/270 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 46/320 - 49/340

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 249.

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

214

Convertible: tire inflation pressures for the 328i

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph / 160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding 100 mph / 160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

Without Sport Package:

205/55 R 16 91 H M+S 225/50 R 16 92 H M+S

33/230 41/280 36/250 44/300

225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 33/230 41/280 39/270 46/320

225/45 R 17 91 W 33/230 41/280 36/250 44/300

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 35/240 42/290 39/270 46/320

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 36/250 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 36/250 - 42/290

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 35/240 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 42/290 - 45/310

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 Y 35/240 - 35/240 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 Y - 42/290 - 42/290

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 39/270 - 39/270 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 46/320 - 46/320

With Sport Package:

205/55 R 16 91 H M+S 225/50 R 16 92 H M+S

33/230 41/280 36/250 44/300

225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 225/45 R 17 91 W

33/230 41/280 41/280 48/330

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 35/240 42/290 42/290 49/340

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 41/280 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 36/250 - 45/310

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 35/240 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 42/290 - 49/340

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 Y 35/240 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 Y - 42/290 - 45/310

M o

b il

it y

215

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 39/270 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 46/320 - 49/340

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 249.

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph / 160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those exceeding 100 mph / 160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

216

Convertible: tire inflation pressures for the 335i

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph / 160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those

exceeding 100 mph / 160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

Without Sport Package:

225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 33/230 41/280 39/270 46/320

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 35/240 42/290 39/270 46/320

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 36/250 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 36/250 - 42/290

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 35/240 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 42/290 - 45/310

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 Y 35/240 - 35/240 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 Y - 42/290 - 42/290

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 39/270 - 39/270 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 46/320 - 46/320

With Sport Package:

225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 33/230 41/280 39/270 46/320

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 35/240 42/290 42/290 49/340

Front: 225/45 R 17 91 V 32/220 - 41/280 -

Rear: 255/40 R 17 94 V - 36/250 - 45/310

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 35/240 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 42/290 - 49/340

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 Y 35/240 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 Y - 42/290 - 45/310

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 39/270 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 46/320 - 49/340

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 249.

M o

b il

it y

217

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Convertible: inflation pressures 335is

Tire size Pressure specifications in psi/kPa

Traveling speeds up to a max. of

100 mph / 160 km/h

Traveling speeds including those

exceeding 100 mph / 160 km/h

All pressure specifications in the table are indicated in psi/kilopascal with cold tires. Cold = ambient temperature

225/45 R 17 91 H M+S 33/230 41/280 39/270 46/320

225/45 R 17 94 V M+S XL 35/240 42/290 42/290 49/340

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 W 35/240 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 W - 42/290 - 49/340

Front: 225/40 R 18 88 Y 35/240 - 38/260 -

Rear: 255/35 R 18 90 Y - 42/290 - 45/310

Front: 225/35 R 19 88 Y XL 39/270 - 42/290 -

Rear: 255/30 R 19 91 Y XL - 46/320 - 49/340

More details on the permissible load and weights can be found on page 249.

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

218

Tire identification marks Knowledge of the labeling on the side of the tire makes it easier to identify and choose the right tires.

Tire size

Speed code letter Q = up to 100 mph or 160 km/h

T = up to 118 mph or 190 km/h

H = up to 131 mph or 210 km/h

V = up to 150 mph or 240 km/h

W = up to 167 mph or 270 km/h

Y = up to 186 mph or 300 km/h

Tire Identification Number Tires with DOT codes meet the guidelines of the US Department of Transportation.

DOT code:

Tire age The manufacturing date of tires is contained in the tire coding: DOT 1010 means that the tire was manufactured in week 10 of 2010.

BMW recommends that you replace all tires after 6 years at most, even if some tires may last for 10 years.

Uniform Tire Quality Grading Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width. For example:

Tread wear 200 Traction AA Temperature A

DOT Quality Grades Tread wear Traction AA A B C Temperature A B C

All passenger car tires must conform to Federal Safety Requirements in addition

to these grades.<

Tread wear The tread wear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified gov- ernment test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half (1) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, how- ever, and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteris- tics and climate.

Traction The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test sur- faces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.

The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead braking traction

tests, and does not include acceleration, cor- nering, hydroplaning, or peak traction charac- teristics.<

Temperature The temperature grades are A, the highest, B, and C, representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate

e.g.

Nominal width in mm Aspect ratio in Radial belt construction Rim diameter in inches Load rating, not on ZR tires Speed code letter, in front of the R on ZR tires

225/45 R 17 91 V

e.g.

Manufacturer's code for tire make Tire size and tire design Tire age

DOT xxxx xxx 1010

M o

b il

it y

219

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehi- cle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.

The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly

inflated and not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either sep- arately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.<

RSC run-flat tires You will recognize run-flat tires by a circular symbol containing the letters RSC on the side of the tire, refer to page 220.

M+S Winter and all-season tires. These have better winter properties than sum- mer tires.

XL Designation for specially reinforced tires.

Tire condition Inspect your tires frequently for tread wear, signs of damage and for foreign objects lodged in the tread. Check the tread depth.

Minimum tread depth The tread depth should not drop below 0.12 in/ 3 mm, although, for example, European legisla- tion only specifies a minimum tread depth of 0.063 in/1.6 mm. At tread depths below 0.12 in/ 3 mm there is an increased risk of high-speed hydroplaning, even when only small amounts of water are present on the road surface. When winter tires wear down past a tread depth

of 0.16 in/4 mm, they become perceptibly less suitable for winter conditions. In the interest of safety, new tires should be installed.

Wear indicators in the base of the tread groove are distributed around the tire's circumference; the letters TWI, for Tread Wear Indicator, on the tire's sidewalls identify tires that incorporate these wear indicators. Once the tire tread has worn down to the wear indicators, the tire has worn to a depth of 0.063 in/1.6 mm.

Wheel/tire damage Please note that low-profile tires cause wheels, tires and suspension parts to be more suscep- tible to road hazard and consequential dam- ages. Unusual vibrations encountered during normal vehicle operation can indicate tire failure or some other vehicle defect. This can, for exam- ple, be caused by driving over curbs. The same applies to any other abnormal road behavior, such as pulling severely to the right or left.

In these cases, reduce speed immedi- ately and have wheels and tires thor-

oughly checked. To do so, drive carefully to the nearest BMW center or tire shop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel. If necessary, have the vehicle towed there. Otherwise, tire damage can pose a lethal hazard to vehicle occupants and other road users.<

W h

ee ls

a n

d ti

re s

220

Tire age For various reasons, such as the development of brittleness, BMW recommends tire replace- ment after no more than 6 years, regardless of the actual wear of the tires.

The manufacturing date of tires is contained in the tire coding: DOT ... 1010 means that the tire was manufac- tured in week 10 of 2010.

Run-flat tires

The symbol identifying run-flat tires is a circle with the letters RSC on the sidewall. Run-flat tires comprise a conditionally self-sup- porting tire and a special rim. The reinforce- ment in the sidewalls ensures that the tire can continue to be used subject to certain restric- tions, even if depressurized.

For information on continuing to drive with a flat tire, refer to Indication of a flat tire, page 93.

New wheels and tires Have new wheels and tires installed only by your BMW center or tire shop that

works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel. If this work is not carried out properly, there is a dan- ger of subsequent damage and related safety hazards. Make sure that the new wheels are bal- anced.<

Retreaded tires BMW recommends that you do not use retreaded tires, since driving safety may

be impaired. The causes for this include poten- tially different tire casing structures and often wide variations in tire age, which can result in a limited service life.<

Correct wheels and tires When mounting new tires or changing over from summer to winter tires and vice versa, mount run-flat tires for your own safety. In the event of a flat, no spare wheel is available. Your BMW center will be glad to advise you.

BMW recommends that you use only wheel and tire combinations that BMW

has tested and approved for your particular vehicle. Variations in factors such as manufac- turing tolerances mean that even wheels and tires with identical official size ratings could actually have different dimensions, which could lead to body contact and thus to severe acci- dents. If non-approved wheels and tires are used, BMW cannot evaluate their suitability, and therefore cannot guarantee their driving safety.<

You can inquire about the right wheel/tire com- bination at your BMW center.

The correct combination of wheels and tires is also necessary to ensure reliable operation of various vehicle systems such as ABS, DSC or FTM.

To maintain good handling and vehicle response, use only tires of a single brand and tread configuration. After a tire has been dam- aged, mount the previous wheel and tire combi- nation again as soon as possible.

Wheels with Tire Pressure Monitor TPM electronics When mounting new tires or changing over from summer to winter tires, or vice versa, only use wheels with TPM electronics; otherwise, the Tire Pressure Monitor may not be able to detect a puncture, refer to page 94. Your BMW center will be glad to advise you.

M o

b il

it y

221

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Recommended tire brands

Certain makes of tire are recommended by BMW for each tire size. They are marked with a clearly visible BMW designation on the sidewall of the tire.

When properly used, these tires meet the high- est standards in terms of safety and handling characteristics.

Special characteristics of winter tires BMW recommends winter tires for driving on winter roads or at temperatures below +457/ +76. Although all-season M+S tires provide better winter traction than summer tires, they generally fail to provide the same levels of cold- weather performance as winter tires.

Pay attention to speed Always comply with the speed limit for the winter tires mounted on your car; failure

to do so could result in tire damage and acci- dents.<

If the car is capable of speeds higher than that permitted for the winter tires, a label stating the maximum permitted speed for the mounted tires must be displayed in your field of view. Specialist tire dealers and your BMW center can supply these labels.

Storage Always store wheels and tires in a cool, dry place with as little exposure to light as possible. Always protect tires against all contact with oil, grease and fuels. Do not exceed the maximum tire inflation pressure indicated on the sidewall of the tire.

Swapping wheels between axles BMW advises against swapping wheels between the front and rear axles, even if all tires have the same size, as this could impair driving characteristics. If the tires are of mixed sizes, swapping wheels between the axles is not per- missible.

Snow chains* Only certain fine-link snow chains have been tested by BMW, classified as safe for use and recommended. Consult your BMW center for more information. Snow chains must be mounted in pairs and on the rear wheels only. Observe the manufac- turer's instructions when mounting snow chains. Do not exceed a speed of 30 mph or 50 km/h.

Do not initialize the Flat Tire Monitor if snow chains are mounted; otherwise, the

instrument might issue an incorrect reading. When driving with snow chains, you may find it helpful to activate DTC temporarily, refer to page 90.<

U n

d er

th e

h o

o d

222

Under the hood

Do not work on the car unless you pos- sess the necessary technical knowledge.

If you are unfamiliar with the statutory guide- lines, have any work on the vehicle performed only by a BMW center or by a workshop that work according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel. If this work is not carried out properly, there is a danger of subsequent damage and related safety haz- ards.<

Hood

Releasing

Pull the lever.

Opening

In order to avoid damage, make sure that the wiper arms are against the windshield

before you open the hood. Do not open the engine hood before the engine has cooled down; otherwise, injuries may result.<

Press the release handle and open the hood.

Closing

Let the hood drop from a height of approx. 10 in/25 cm. It must be clearly heard to engage.

Make sure that the closing path of the hood is clear; otherwise, injuries may

result. If you see any signs while driving your vehicle that the hood is not completely closed, stop at once and close it securely.<

M o

b il

it y

223

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Important parts of the engine compartment

1 Expansion tank for coolant, refer to page 226

2 Washer fluid filler neck for headlamp clean- ing system and window washer system, refer to page 66

3 Jump-starting connection, refer to page 239

4 Filler neck for engine oil, refer to Adding engine oil

Engine oil The engine oil consumption is dependent on driving style and driving conditions.

Checking oil level Your car is equipped with an electronic oil-level monitor.

For a precise measurement and display of the oil level, it is necessary that the engine be at operating temperature, i.e. after uninterrupted driving for at least approx. 6.2 miles/10 km. You can have the oil level displayed while you are driving, or while the vehicle is at a standstill on a level surface and the engine is running.

Display in the instrument cluster

1. Push button 1 in the turn indicator lever up or down repeatedly until the appropriate symbol is shown in the display, accompa- nied by the word "OIL".

2. Press button 2 in the turn indicator lever. The oil level is checked and the reading displayed.

U n

d er

th e

h o

o d

224

Possible displays

1 Oil level OK

2 Oil level is being checked. This can take about 3 minutes if the car is at a standstill on a level surface, or about 5 minutes while the car is on the move.

3 Oil level down to minimum: Add engine oil as soon as possible, but no more than 1 US quart/1 liter, refer also to Adding engine oil on page 225.

4 Oil level is too high.

Too much oil will harm the engine. Have the vehicle checked without

delay.<

5 The oil level sensor is defective. Do not add engine oil. You can continue your journey. Note the newly calculated dis- tance remaining to the next oil service, refer to page 80. Have the system checked as soon as possible.

Display via iDrive 1. "Vehicle Info"

2. "Vehicle status"

3. "Engine oil level"

Possible messages > "Engine oil level OK"

> "Measurement not possible at this time."

> "Measuring engine oil level...": This can take about 3 minutes if the car is at a standstill on a level surface and the engine is running, and about 5 minutes while the car is moving. If engine oil was added, it may take up to 30 minutes to obtain an oil level reading.

> "Engine oil level below minimum. Add 1 quart!" Add engine oil as soon as possible, but no more than 1 US quart/1 liter, refer also to Adding engine oil below. If the oil level is below the minimum value, add engine oil immediately to avoid engine damage.

> "Engine oil level too high! Have this checked."

M o

b il

it y

225

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Too much oil will harm the engine. Have the vehicle checked without

delay.<

> "Measurement inactive. Have this checked." Do not add engine oil. You can continue your journey. Note the newly calculated dis- tance remaining to the next oil service, refer to page 80. Have the system checked as soon as possible.

Adding engine oil

Add up to 1 US quart/1 liter of engine oil only after a corresponding message is shown on the Control Display.

Add oil within the next 125 miles/200 km; otherwise, the engine could be dam-

aged.<

Keep oils, greases, etc. out of the reach of children and comply with the relevant

warnings on the containers. Otherwise, health hazards may result.<

Oil change Have oil changed only at your BMW center or at a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with correspondingly trained personnel.

Oil types Do not use oil additives as this could result in engine damage.<

Specified engine oils Your service center can advise you on which engine oils have been approved by the manu- facturer of your vehicle.

The engine oil quality is critical for the life of the engine.

Approved oils can be identified by the following specification:

Approved oils belong to the following viscosity classes: SAE 0W-40, SAE 0W-30, SAE 5W-40 and SAE 5W-30.

Alternative oil types If approved oils are not available, you can use quantities of up to 1 US quart/1 liter of another oil with the following specifications:

API SM or higher

Gasoline engine

Preferred: BMW Longlife-01 BMW Longlife-01 FE

Alternatively: BMW Longlife-98

U n

d er

th e

h o

o d

226

Coolant Do not add coolant to the cooling system when the engine is hot. Escaping coolant

can cause burns.<

Coolant consists of half water and half additive. Not all commercially available additives are suitable for your BMW. Ask your BMW center for suitable additives.

Only use suitable additives; otherwise, engine damage may result. Because

additives are harmful to your health, it is impor- tant to follow the instructions on the contain- ers.<

Comply with the appropriate environ- mental protection regulations when dis-

posing of coolant additives.<

Checking coolant level 1. Do not open the engine hood before the

engine has cooled down.

2. Turn the cap of the expansion tank a little counterclockwise to allow any accumulated pressure to escape, then continue turning to open.

3. The coolant level is correct if it is between the maximum and minimum marks in the filler neck, refer also to the diagram next to the filler neck.

4. If the coolant is low, slowly add coolant up to the specified level; do not overfill.

5. Turn the cap until there is an audible click.

6. Have the reason for the coolant loss elimi- nated as soon as possible.

M o

b il

it y

227

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Maintenance

BMW Maintenance System

The BMW Maintenance System supports the preservation of the traffic and operating safety of your BMW. The objective is to optimize efforts with respect to minimal vehicle mainte- nance costs.

If and when you come to sell your BMW, a com- prehensive record of servicing will prove a sig- nificant benefit.

Condition Based Service CBS Sensors and special algorithms take the differ- ent driving conditions of your BMW into account. Condition Based Service uses this to determine the current and future service requirements. By letting you define a service and maintenance regimen that reflects your own individual requirements, the system builds the basis for trouble-free driving.

On the Control Display, you can have the remaining times or distances for selected main- tenance tasks and any legally prescribed dates displayed, refer to page 80:

> Engine oil

> Brake pads: separately for front and rear

> Brake fluid

> Vehicle check

> Legally mandated inspections depending on local regulations

Service data in the remote control Your vehicle continuously stores service- requirement information in the remote control while you are driving. Your BMW Service Advi- sor can read out this data from the remote con- trol unit, and propose an optimized mainte- nance approach. Whenever you take your car in for servicing you should therefore hand your BMW Service Advisor the remote control unit that you last used.

Make sure that the date is always set cor- rectly, refer to page 84; otherwise, the

effectiveness of Condition Based Service CBS is not assured.<

Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models Please consult your Service and Warranty Infor- mation Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models for additional information on service require- ments.

BMW recommends that you have service and repair operations performed at your

BMW center. Take the time to ensure that these service pro- cedures are confirmed by entries in your vehi- cle's Service and Warranty Information Booklet for US models and Warranty and Service Guide Booklet for Canadian models. These entries verify that your vehicle has received the speci- fied regular maintenance.<

M ai

n te

n an

ce

228

Socket for Onboard Diagnosis OBD

On the driver's side is an OBD socket for check- ing components relevant to the composition of the vehicle's emissions.

Emissions The warning lamp lights up: The vehicle is producing higher emis- sions. The trip can be continued. Have

the car checked as soon as possible.

Canadian models display this warning lamp.

The lamp flashes under certain conditions. This indicates excessive misfiring in the engine. If this happens, you should reduce your speed and visit your nearest BMW center as soon as possible. Severe engine misfiring can quickly lead to serious damage of emissions-related components, especially the catalytic converter.

The warning lamp comes on if the gas cap is not properly tightened and the OBD system assumes that fuel vapor

is escaping. Make sure that the gas cap is correctly positioned and close it until it audibly clicks.

Data memory Your vehicle records data about the operation, faults, and user settings. These data are stored in the vehicle and in extract form, in the remote control, and can be read out using suitable devices at your BMW center. The data that are read out are used to support service proce- dures and repairs or to optimize and expand vehicle functions. If you have a BMW Assist contract, certain vehicle data can also be trans- mitted directly from the vehicle in order to enable the desired services.

M o

b il

it y

229

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Care

Care products Regular cleaning and care contributes signifi- cantly to the value retention of your BMW.

BMW recommends cleaning and caring for your vehicle with products that are approved by BMW for this purpose.

Your BMW center will be happy to advise you on the products and services available for cleaning and caring for your BMW.

Original BMW Care Products have been material tested, laboratory checked and

proven in the field, and offer optimal care and protection for your vehicle.<

Do not use cleaners that contain alcohol or solvents as these may result in dam-

age.<

Cleaning agents can contain substances that are dangerous or hazardous to your

health. Therefore, follow the warning and safety instructions on the packaging. When cleaning inside the vehicle, always open the doors or windows of the vehicle. In enclosed areas, pro- vide for sufficient ventilation. Only use products designed for cleaning vehicles.<

Exterior care

Washing the vehicle Especially during the winter months, ensure that the vehicle is washed more

frequently. Heavy soiling and road salt can lead to vehicle damage.<

After washing the vehicle, apply the brakes briefly to dry them; otherwise,

water can reduce braking efficiency over the short term and the brake discs can corrode.<

Automatic car washes Preference should be given to cloth car washes.

Do not use high-pressure car washes; otherwise, water may drip into the vehicle

around the windows.<

Before driving into a car wash, ensure that it is suitable for your BMW. Check the following:

> Dimensions of your vehicle, refer to page 247.

> If necessary: fold in the exterior mirrors, refer to page 50.

> Maximum permissible tire width.

Avoid car washes with guide rail heights over 4 in/10 cm; otherwise, there is the

danger of damaging chassis parts.<

Preparations before driving into an automatic car wash:

> Unscrew the rod antenna*.

> Deactivate the rain sensor* to prevent unintentional wiping.

> Remove additional add-on parts, e.g. spoilers or phone antennas, if they could be damaged.

Automatic transmission Before driving into an automatic car wash, per- form the following steps to ensure that the vehi- cle can roll:

1. Insert the remote control into the ignition lock, even with Comfort Access.

2. Move the selector lever to position N.

3. Release the parking brake.

4. Switch off the engine.

5. Leave the remote control in the ignition lock so that the vehicle can roll.

C ar

e

230

Sports automatic transmission with double clutch Before driving into an automatic car wash, per- form the following steps to ensure that the vehi- cle can roll:

1. Insert the remote control into the ignition lock, even with Comfort Access.

2. Engage transmission position N.

3. Release the parking brake.

4. Switch off the engine.

5. Leave the remote control in the ignition lock so that the vehicle can roll.

The transmission is switched into position P:

> automatically after approx. 30 minutes

> if you remove the infrared remote control from the ignition lock

Steam jets/high-pressure washers When using steam jets or high-pressure washers, ensure that you maintain suffi-

cient clearance to the vehicle and do not exceed a temperature of 1407/606. Insufficient clearance or excessive pressure or temperature can lead to component damage or water penetration. Follow the operating instruc- tions of the high-pressure washer.<

When using high-pressure washers, do not spray against the sensors and cam-

eras, e.g. of the Park Distance Control or Rear View Camera, for an extended period and main- tain a distance of at least 1 ft/30 cm.<

Manual car wash When washing the vehicle by hand, use large quantities of water and car shampoo if neces- sary. Clean the vehicle with a sponge or wash- ing brush, applying light pressure only.

Before cleaning the windshield, deacti- vate the rain sensor or switch off the igni-

tion to prevent unintentional activation of the wipers.<

Observe local regulations pertaining to washing vehicles by hand.<

Headlamps Do not rub them dry and do not use abrasive or corrosive cleaning agents.

Loosen dirt, e.g. insects, with shampoo or insect remover and wash away with copious quantities of water.

Thaw ice with a windshield deicer and do not use an ice scraper.

Windows Clean the inside and outside surfaces of the windows and the mirrors with window cleaner.

Do not clean the mirrors with cleaners containing quartz.<

Convertible: retractable hardtop Proceed as you would in a normal car wash.

When you open a wet hardtop, water drops may run into the cargo area. If nec-

essary, remove items from the cargo area beforehand to avoid water stains or soiling.<

Paintwork care Regular care contributes to value retention and protects the paintwork against the long-term effects of damaging substances.

Region-specific environmental influences can damage the vehicle paintwork. Therefore, it is important to adapt the frequency and scope of car care accordingly.

Immediately remove aggressive materials such as spilled fuel, oil, grease, brake fluid, tree sap or bird droppings to prevent damage to the paint- work.

Repairing paintwork damage Immediately repair scratches or similar damage, such as that caused by stones

hitting the vehicle, where necessary to prevent rusting.<

BMW recommends having paintwork damage repaired by a professional paint repair work- shop according to BMW specifications using original BMW paint materials.

M o

b il

it y

231

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Preservation A preservation treatment is necessary when water no longer beads off the clean paintwork surface. Only use products for paintwork pres- ervation that contain carnauba or synthetic waxes.

Rubber seals Treat only with water or rubber care products.

Do not use silicon-containing care prod- ucts on rubber seals; otherwise, noise

and damage could occur.<

Chrome parts Carefully clean vehicle parts such as the radia- tor grill, door handles or window frames with copious quantities of water and a shampoo additive, especially when roads are treated with deicing salt. For additional treatment, use a chrome polish.

Light-alloy wheels For technical reasons, dust is generated during braking that is deposited on the light-alloy wheels. Remove the dust regularly using acid- free rim cleaner.

Do not use aggressive, acidic, strongly alkaline and abrasive cleaning agents or

steam jets over 1407/606; otherwise, dam- age may occur.<

Outside sensors/cameras Keep the sensors and cameras on the outside of the vehicle, e.g. those for Park

Distance Control, clean and free of ice to ensure that they remain fully functional.<

Interior care

Upholstery fabrics/cloth trims/ Alcantara fabrics Vacuum regularly with a vacuum cleaner to remove superficial dirt.

To remove severe spots such as stains from beverages, use a soft sponge or lint-free microfiber cloth and suitable interior cleaners. Follow the instructions on the packaging.

Clean the upholstery down to the seams using a sweeping motion. Avoid strong

rubbing.<

Opened Velcro fasteners on pants or other articles of clothing can damage the

seat covers. Ensure that Velcro fasteners are closed.<

Leather/leather trim The leather used by BMW is a high quality natural product. Slight irregularities in the

leather are a typical characteristic of natural leather.<

Dust and road grit in the pores and folds of the leather have an abrasive effect, leading to increased wear and causing the leather surface to become brittle prematurely. Therefore, fre- quently clean the leather of dust using a cloth or vacuum cleaner.

Clean light-colored leather more frequently as dust and dirt are more noticeable.

Treat the leather at least once every two months using a leather lotion as dirt and grease will gradually attack the leather's protective layer.

C ar

e

232

Carpet/floor mats* The floor mats can be removed for cleaning. When heavily soiled, clean carpets with a microfiber cloth and water or textile cleaner. Rub back and forth in the direction of travel; oth- erwise, the carpet may become matted.

Interior plastic parts > Imitation leather surfaces

> Lamp glasses

> Display pane of instrument cluster

> Matte parts

Clean with water and solvent-free plastic cleaner if necessary.

Fine wood parts Clean fine wood trim and fine wood parts with a damp cloth. Wipe dry with a soft cloth.

Safety belts Dirty belt straps impede the reeling action and thus have a negative impact on safety.

Do not clean chemically, as this may destroy the webbing.<

Interior sensors/cameras To clean interior sensors and cameras, e.g. of the high-beam assistant, use a lint-free cloth moistened with glass cleaner.

Displays To clean displays, e.g. of the radio or instrument cluster, use a cleaning cloth for displays or a soft, non-abrasive, lint-free cloth.

Avoid applying excessive pressure when cleaning the displays; otherwise, damage

may occur.<

Do not use chemical or abrasive house- hold cleaning agents. Keep all types of

fluid away from the device. Otherwise, surfaces or electrical components may be corroded or damaged.<

CD/DVD drives Do not use a cleaning CD, as it may damage parts of the drive.<

Vehicle storage If your vehicle is to be decommissioned for longer than three months, your BMW center or a workshop that operates according to BMW specifications will be glad to advise you.

M o

b il

it y

233

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Replacing components

Onboard vehicle tool kit

Coupe

The onboard vehicle tool kit is stored in a com- partment on the right-hand side of the cargo area. Remove the cover.

Convertible The onboard vehicle tool kit is stored in a pouch under the cargo area floor panel.

Wiper blades

1. Fold out the wiper arm and hold it.

2. Press together the locking spring, arrows 1, and fold out the wiper blade, arrow 2.

3. Take the wiper blade out of the catch mech- anism, pulling the blade toward the front.

To avoid damage, make sure that the wiper arms are against the windshield

before you open the engine compartment.<

Lamps and bulbs Lamps and bulbs make an essential contribu- tion to vehicle safety. They should, therefore, be handled carefully. BMW recommends hav- ing your BMW center perform any work that you do not feel competent to perform yourself or that is not described here.

Never touch the glass of new bulbs with your bare fingers, as even minute

amounts of contamination will burn into the bulb's surface and reduce its service life. Use a clean tissue, cloth or something similar, or hold the bulb by its base.<

You can obtain a selection of replacement bulbs at your BMW center.

Only change bulbs while they are cool to the touch; otherwise, you could suffer

burns.<

When working on electrical systems, always begin by switching off the con-

sumer in question; otherwise, short-circuits could result. To avoid possible injury or equip- ment damage when replacing bulbs, observe any instructions provided by the bulb manu- facturer.<

For care of the headlamps, please follow the instructions in the chapter entitled 'Care'.

If the routine for changing a particular bulb is not described here, please contact

your BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel.<

Light-emitting diodes LED Light-emitting diodes installed behind translu- cent lenses serve as the light source for many of the controls, displays, and equipment in your vehicle. These light-emitting diodes, which operate using a concept similar to that applied in conventional lasers, are officially designated as Class 1 light-emitting diodes.

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

234

Do not remove the covers or expose the eyes directly to the unfiltered light source

for several hours; otherwise, this could cause irritation of the retina.<

Headlight lenses In cool or humid weather, condensation may form on the interior of outside lamps. When the light is switched on, the condensation will dis- appear after a short time. The headlight lenses do not need to be replaced.

At high humidities, e.g. water droplets may form in the lights; have these checked by your BMW center.,

Xenon lamps These bulbs have a very long service life and are highly unlikely to fail. If a xenon lamp fails never- theless, switch on the fog lamps and continue the journey with great care, provided that local legislation does not prohibit this.

Have any work on the xenon lamp system, including bulb replacements, performed

only by a BMW center or a workshop that works according to BMW repair procedures with cor- respondingly trained personnel. Otherwise, if such work is carried out improperly, the high voltage in the system presents the danger of fatal injuries.<

Access to the lamps 1. Switch off the lamps and take the remote

control out of the ignition lock.

2. Remove the upper cover from the head- lamp. To do so, use a screwdriver to press the catches towards the rear, see arrows, and pull the cover forward and out.

Follow the same steps in reverse order to reat- tach the cover.

Be careful when installing the cover; oth- erwise, leaks could occur and cause dam-

age to the headlamp system.<

Parking lamps and roadside parking lamps, daytime running lights* These lamps use LED technology for operation. If they malfunction, please contact your BMW center.

Corner-illuminating lamp* H3 bulb, 55 watts

1. Switch off the lamps and take the remote control out of the ignition lock.

2. Remove the cover, refer to Access to the lamps.

3. Push the wire bracket out of the anchor towards the right and fold it up.

4. Disconnect the plug, change the bulb and reconnect the plug.

5. Insert the bulb.

6. Fold the wire bracket down and engage it.

7. Reattach the cover.

Turn signals, front These lamps use LED technology for operation. If they malfunction, please contact your BMW center.

M o

b il

it y

235

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Side turn signals W5W bulb, 5 watts

1. Press the front edge of the lamp toward the rear with your fingertip, arrow 1 and pivot it out, arrow 2.

2. While simultaneously lifting the retaining tab, rotate bulb holder to the left and remove.

3. Remove lamp and replace it.

To install, insert rear end of the lamp and press into place at the front.

Tail lamps

Coupe: at a glance The tail lamps are divided in two parts. One part is in the trunk lid, the other is in the fender.

1 Backup lamp

2 Brake lamp

3 Parking/tail lamps

4 Turn signal

5 Brake Force Display lamp

6 Parking/tail lamps

Convertible: at a glance The tail lamps are divided in two parts. One part is in the trunk lid, the other is in the fender.

1 Backup lamp

2 Brake lamp

3 Parking/tail lamps

4 Turn signal

5 Brake Force Display lamp

6 Parking/tail lamps

Backup lamp If these lamps malfunction, please contact your BMW center.

Turn signal, brake, license plate, parking, and tail lamps These lamps use LED technology for operation. If they malfunction, please contact your BMW center.

Coupe: two-stage brake light in the trunk lid H21W bulb, 21 watts

R ep

la ci

n g

c o

m p

o n

en ts

236

1. Pry out the plastic plugs in the trim of the trunk lid using a screwdriver and remove the trim.

2. Release the bulb holder, see arrow, and remove.

3. Apply gentle pressure to the bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replace- ment.

4. Attach the bulb holder.

5. Attach trunk lid trim.

Convertible: two-stage brake light in the trunk lid H21W bulb, 21 watts

1. Take the warning triangle out of its holder, refer to page 239. Unscrew the holder using the screwdriver from the onboard vehicle tool kit.

2. Pry out the plastic plugs in the trim of the trunk lid using a screwdriver and remove the trim.

3. Release the bulb holder, see arrow, and remove.

4. Apply gentle pressure to the bulb while turning it to the left for removal and replace- ment.

5. Attach the bulb holder.

6. Reattach the trim of the trunk lid and the holder for the warning triangle.

Changing wheels Your BMW is equipped with run-flat tires as standard. This eliminates the need to change a wheel immediately in the event of a puncture.

For information on continuing to drive with a damaged tire, refer to Indication of a flat tire on page 93.

The symbol identifying run-flat tires is a circle with the letters RSC on the sidewall, refer to Run-flat tires, page 220.

When mounting new tires or changing over from summer to winter tires and vice versa, mount run-flat tires for your own safety. In the event of a flat, no spare wheel is available. Your BMW center will be glad to advise you. Refer also to New wheels and tires, page 220.

The tools for changing wheels are avail- able as optional accessories from your

BMW center.<

Jack mounting points

The jacking points are at the positions shown in the illustration.

M o

b il

it y

237

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Vehicle battery

Battery care The battery is 100% maintenance-free, the electrolyte will last for the life of the battery when the vehicle is operated in a temperate cli- mate. Your BMW center will be glad to advise in all matters concerning the battery.

Battery replacing Only use vehicle batteries that have been approved for your vehicle by the manu-

facturer; otherwise, the vehicle could be dam- aged and systems or functions may not be fully available.<

After a battery replacement, have the battery registered on the vehicle by your service center to ensure that all comfort functions are fully available.

Charging the battery Only charge the battery in the vehicle via the terminals in the engine compartment with the engine off. Connections, refer to Jump-starting on page 239.

Disposal Have old batteries disposed of by your BMW center or bring them to a recycling

center. Maintain the battery in an upright posi- tion for transport and storage. Always secure the battery against tipping over during trans- port.<

Power failure After a temporary power loss, the functioning of some equipment may be limited and require reinitialization. Individual settings may likewise have been lost and will have to be programmed:

> Time and date These values must be updated, refer to page 83.

> Radio In some cases, stations may have to be stored again, refer to page 157.

> Navigation system Operability must be waited for, refer to page 134.

> Glass roof It may happen that the roof can only be raised. The system must be initialized. Please contact your BMW center.

> Seat and mirror memory The positions must be stored again, refer to page 48.

> Inside rearview mirror with digital compass The system must be calibrated, refer to page 114.

> Active steering The system automatically initializes itself briefly during a trip. The system is deacti- vated during this time, refer to page 96.

> xDrive The system automatically initializes itself during a trip. Indicator lamps light up during this time. If the lamps do not go out during the current trip, have the system checked.

Fuses Never attempt to repair a blown fuse and do not replace a defective fuse with a sub-

stitute of another color or amperage rating; oth- erwise, this could lead to a circuit overload, ulti- mately resulting in a fire in the vehicle.<

Open the cover in the glove compartment and remove it.

Plastic tweezers are located on the distributor box. See the rear of the cover for information on fuse assignment.

Spare fuses are available from your BMW center.

G iv

in g

a n

d re

ce iv

in g

a ss

is ta

n ce

238

Giving and receiving assistance

Emergency Request* Conditions for an Emergency Request:

> Full preparation package mobile phone: this equipment makes it possible to send an Emergency Request even if no mobile phone is paired with the vehicle.

> BMW Assist is activated. Activating BMW Assist, refer to page 200.

> Radio readiness is on.

> The BMW Assist system is logged on to a mobile phone network.

> The Emergency Request system is opera- ble.

Once your service contract for BMW Assist expires, the BMW Assist system can be deacti- vated by a BMW center without you having to visit a workshop. Once the BMW Assist system has been deactivated, Emergency Requests are not possible. The BMW Assist system can be reactivated by a BMW center after a new contract has been signed.

Sending an Emergency Request 1. Briefly press the cover flap to open.

2. Press the SOS button until the LED in the button lights up.

As soon as the voice connection to the BMW Assist Response Center has been established, the LED flashes.

Once the BMW Assist Response Center has received your Emergency Request, the BMW Assist Response Center contacts you and takes further steps to help you. Even if you are unable to respond, the BMW Assist Response Center will be able to initiate further steps to assist you under certain conditions.

If the circumstances allow this, remain in the vehicle until the connection has been estab- lished. You will then be able to provide a detailed description of the situation.

Data for determining the necessary rescue measures are transmitted to the BMW Assist Response Center, e.g. the current position of your vehicle, if it can be determined.

If the LED is flashing but the BMW Assist Response Center cannot be heard over the hands-free system, it is possible that the hands-free system is malfunctioning. You may still be heard by the BMW Assist Response Center, however.

Under certain conditions, an Emergency Request is sent automatically immediately after a severe accident. This Automatic Collision Notification is not affected by the button being pressed.

For technical reasons, the Emergency Request service cannot be guaranteed

for the most unfavorable conditions.<

Roadside Assistance BMW Roadside Assistance is available by phone around the clock in many countries. You can obtain support there in the event of a breakdown.

Phone numbers for BMW Roadside Assistance can be found in the Contact brochure.

M o

b il

it y

239

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

First aid pouch* Some of the articles contained in the first aid pouch have a limited service life. Therefore, check the expiration dates of the contents reg- ularly and replace any items in good time, if nec- essary.

Coupe

The first aid pouch is located on the right-hand side of the cargo area in a storage area.

Convertible

The first aid pouch is located in a compartment under the front passenger seat.

To open: press the button and fold the cover down. To close: fold the cover back up and press it into the catch.

Warning triangle*

Coupe

The warning triangle is located on the left-hand side of the cargo area. Press the tab to take it out.

Convertible

The warning triangle is located in a holder in the trunk lid. Press the tabs to take it out.

Jump-starting If the car's own battery is flat, your BMW's engine can be started by connecting two jumper cables to another vehicle's battery. You can also use the same method to help start another vehicle. Only use jumper cables with fully-insulated clamp handles.

Do not touch any electrically live parts when the engine is running, or a fatal acci-

dent may occur. Carefully adhere to the follow- ing sequence, both to prevent damage to one or both vehicles, and to guard against possible personal injuries.<

G iv

in g

a n

d re

ce iv

in g

a ss

is ta

n ce

240

Preparation 1. Check whether the battery of the other

vehicle has a voltage of 12 volts and approximately the same capacitance in Ah. This information can be found on the bat- tery.

2. Switch off the engine of the assisting vehi- cle.

3. Switch off any consumers in both vehicles.

There must not be any contact between the bodies of the two vehicles; otherwise,

there is a danger of shorting.<

Connecting jumper cables Connect the jumper cables in the correct order, so that no sparks which could

cause injury occur.<

Your BMW has a jump-starting connection in the engine compartment which acts as the bat- tery's positive terminal, refer also to the Engine compartment overview on page 223. The cap is marked with +.

1. Pull the cap of the BMW jump-starting con- nection up to remove.

2. Attach one terminal clamp of the plus/+ jumper cable to the positive terminal of the battery or a starting-aid terminal of the vehi- cle providing assistance.

3. Attach the second terminal clamp of the plus/+ jumper cable to the positive terminal of the battery or a starting-aid terminal of the vehicle to be started.

4. Attach one terminal clamp of the minus/ jumper cable to the negative terminal of the battery or to an engine or body ground of the assisting vehicle. Your BMW has a special nut as body ground or negative pole.

5. Attach the second terminal clamp of the minus/ jumper cable to the negative termi- nal of the battery or to the engine or body ground of the vehicle to be started.

Starting the engine 1. Start the engine of the donor vehicle and

allow it to run for a few minutes at slightly increased idle speed.

2. Start the engine on the other vehicle in the usual way. If the first start attempt is not successful, wait a few minutes before another attempt in order to allow the discharged battery to recharge.

3. Let the engines run for a few minutes.

4. Disconnect the jumper cables by reversing the above connecting sequence.

If necessary, have the battery checked and recharged.

Never use spray fluids to start the engine.<

M o

b il

it y

241

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

Tow-starting, towing away Observe the applicable laws and regulations for tow-starting and towing

vehicles.<

Do not transport any passengers other than the driver in a vehicle that is being

towed.<

Using a tow fitting The screw-in tow fitting must always be carried in the car. It can be screwed in at the front or rear of the BMW.

Coupe: it is stored in the onboard vehicle tool kit underneath the cover on the right-hand side of the cargo area, refer to page 233.

Convertible: it is stored in the onboard vehicle tool kit underneath the cargo area floor, refer to page 233.

Use only the tow fitting provided with the vehicle and screw it all the way in. Use the

tow fitting for towing on paved roads only. Avoid lateral loading of the tow fitting, e.g. do not lift the vehicle by the tow fitting. Otherwise, the tow fitting and the vehicle could be damaged.<

Access to screw thread Release the cover panel in the bumper: Press on the upper part of the cover panel.

Front

Rear

Being towed Make sure that the ignition is switched on, refer to page 55; otherwise, the low-beam

headlamps, tail lamps, turn signal indicators and windshield wipers may be unavailable.

Power steering assistance is not available when the engine is not running. Thus, braking and steering will require increased effort. Active steering is not active and it will be necessary to turn the steering wheel further.<

Manual transmission Gearshift lever in neutral position.

Automatic transmission Selector lever in position N. Changing selector lever positions, refer to page 58.

Do not exceed a towing speed of 45 mph or 70 km/h and a towing distance of

90 miles/150 km; otherwise, the automatic transmission may be damaged.<

G iv

in g

a n

d re

ce iv

in g

a ss

is ta

n ce

242

Sports automatic transmission with double clutch

Make sure that the parking lock P is not engaged; otherwise, the rear wheels are

immobilized. When using the car wash function, refer to page 230, make sure that after approx. 30 minutes, the parking lock P is automatically engaged and thus immobilizes the rear wheels. In the event of an electrical malfunction or if the vehicle must be towed for more than approx. 20 minutes, unlock the parking lock manually, refer to page 63.<

When towing, do not exceed a maximum speed of 30 mph or 50 km/h and a maxi-

mum distance traveled of 30 miles/50 km; oth- erwise, the transmission may be damaged.<

BMW recommends transporting the vehicle on a tow truck with a flatbed or towing with the rear axle raised.

Towing methods Do not lift the vehicle by a tow fitting or body and chassis parts; otherwise, dam-

age may result.<

With a tow bar The towing vehicle must not be lighter than the towed vehicle; otherwise, it may

be impossible to maintain control.<

The tow fittings used should be on the same side on both vehicles. Should it prove impossi- ble to avoid mounting the tow bar at an angle, please observe the following:

> Clearance and maneuvering capability will be sharply limited during cornering.

> The tow bar will generate lateral forces if it is attached offset.

Attach the tow bar to the tow fittings only, as attaching it to other parts of the vehicle

could result in damage.<

With a tow rope When starting off in the towing vehicle, make sure that the tow rope is taut.

To avoid jerking and the associated stresses on vehicle components when

towing, always use nylon ropes or nylon straps. Attach the tow rope to the tow fittings only, as attaching it to other parts of the vehicle could result in damage.<

With a tow truck: vehicle without xDrive Manual and automatic transmission:

Sports automatic transmission with double clutch:

Have the BMW transported with a tow truck with a so-called lift bar, or on a flatbed.

Do not tow the vehicle with just the rear axle raised as this may cause the steering to turn.

M o

b il

it y

243

R e

fe re

n ce

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t

With a tow truck: vehicle with xDrive Do not tow a BMW with xDrive with just the front or rear axle raised; otherwise, the

wheels could lock up and the transfer case could be damaged.<

Have the BMW transported on a flatbed surface only.

Tow-starting Avoid tow-starting the vehicle whenever possi- ble; instead, jump-start the engine, refer to page 239Vehicles with a catalytic converter should only be tow-started when the engine is cold; vehicles with an automatic transmission or Sports automatic transmission with double clutch cannot be tow-started at all.

1. Switch on hazard warning flashers, comply with local regulations.

2. Switch on the ignition, refer to page 55.

3. Shift into 3rd gear.

4. Have the vehicle tow-started with the clutch depressed and slowly release the clutch. After the engine starts, immediately depress the clutch completely again.

5. Stop at a suitable location, remove the tow bar or rope and switch off the hazard warn- ing flashers.

6. Have the vehicle checked.

With xDrive: do not activate Hill Descent Control HDC when the vehicle is being

tow-started, page 91.<

Reference This chapter contains technical data,

short commands for the voice activation system and an index that will help you find information most quickly.

T ec

h n

ic al

d at

a

246

Technical data

Engine data

Coupe

Convertible

328i/xDrive 335i/xDrive 335is

Displacement cu in/cm 182.8/2,996 181.8/2,979 181.8/2,979

Number of cylinders 6 6 6

Maximum power output hp 230 300 335

at engine speed rpm 6,500 5,800 5,900

Maximum torque lb ft/Nm 200/270 300/407 332/450

at engine speed rpm 2,750 1,400-5,000 1,500

328i 335i 335is

Displacement cu in/cm 182.8/2,996 181.8/2,979 181.8/2,979

Number of cylinders 6 6 6

Maximum power output hp 230 300 335

at engine speed rpm 6,500 5,800 5,900

Maximum torque lb ft/Nm 200/270 300/407 332/450

at engine speed rpm 2,750 1,400-5,000 1,500

R e

fe re

n ce

247

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Dimensions

Coupe

All dimensions given in inches/mm. Smallest turning circle dia.: 36.1 ft/11.0 m, with xDrive: 38.7 ft/11.8 m. 335i, 335i xDrive, 335is: height approx. 54.1 in/1,375 mm

T ec

h n

ic al

d at

a

248

Convertible

All dimensions given in inches/mm. Smallest turning circle dia.: 36.1 ft/11.0 m. 335is height approx. 54.0 in/1,370 mm

R e

fe re

n ce

249

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Weights

Coupe

Convertible

328i 328i xDrive

335i 335i xDrive

Approved gross weight

> with manual transmission lbs/kg 4,288/1,945 4,508/2,045 4,486/2,035 4,663/2,115

> with automatic transmission lbs/kg 4,354/1,975 4,552/2,065 4,508/2,045 4,685/2,125

Load lbs/kg 882/400 882/400 882/400 882/400

Approved front axle load lbs/kg 2,061/935 2,227/1,010 2,172/985 2,326/1,055

Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,425/1,100 2,447/1,110 2,469/1,120 2,513/1,140

Approved roof load capacity lbs/kg 165/75 165/75 165/75 165/75

Cargo area capacity cu ft/ liters

15.5/440 15.5/440 15.2/430 15.2/430

335is

Approved gross weight

> with manual transmission lbs/kg 4,497/2,040

> Sports automatic transmis- sion with double clutch

lbs/kg 4,519/2,050

Load lbs/kg 882/400

Approved front axle load lbs/kg 2,183/990

Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,513/1,140

Approved roof load capacity lbs/kg 165/75

Cargo area capacity cu ft/ liters

15.2/430

328i 335i 335is

Approved gross weight

> with manual transmission lbs/kg 4,707/2,135 4,817/2,185 4,839/2,195

> with automatic transmission lbs/kg 4,773/2,165 4,839/2,195

> Sports automatic transmis- sion with double clutch

lbs/kg 4,872/2,210

Load lbs/kg 838/380 838/380 838/380

Approved front axle load lbs/kg 2,138/970 2,205/1,000 2,227/1,010

T ec

h n

ic al

d at

a

250

Capacities

Approved rear axle load lbs/kg 2,646/1,200 2,646/1,200 2,646/1,200

Approved roof load capacity lbs/kg

Cargo area capacity cu ft/ liters

7.4-12.4/ 210-350

7.4-12.4/ 210-350

7.4-12.4/ 210-350

328i 335i 335is

Notes

Fuel tank US gal/liters approx. 16.1/61 Fuel grade: page 207

including reserve of US gal/liters approx. 2.1/8.0

Window washer system For more details: page 66

including headlamp washers US qt/liters approx. 6.3/6.0

R e

fe re

n ce

251

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Short commands for the voice activation system

With short commands you can carry out certain functions directly, regardless of which menu

item is selected. Here are the important short commands for the voice activation system.

Useful short commands

CD/Multimedia

CD/DVD drive

*

Function Command

Opening a music collection {Music collection}

Opening the tone control {Tone}

Opening the settings {Settings}

Opening the computer {Onboard info}

Opening the contacts* {Contacts}

Displaying the phone book* {Phonebook}

Opening services* {Assist}

Opening BMW Assist* {B M W Assist}

Opening the home address* {Home address}

Opening destination entry* {Enter address}

Opening destination guidance* {Guidance}

Function Command

Playing back a CD {C D on}

Selecting a CD {Select C D}

Selecting a CD and track {C D track } e.g. CD 3 track 5

Selecting a track {C D track } e.g. track 5

Opening the CD and Multimedia menu {C D and multimedia}

CD and DVD* {C D}

Displaying entertainment details on the split screen*

{Entertainment details}

S h

o rt

c o

m m

an d

s fo

r t h

e vo

ic e

ac ti

va ti

o n

s ys

te m

252

Music collection

External devices

Tone control

Radio

FM

AM

Satellite radio

Function Command

Calling up the current playback {Current playback}

Opening a music collection {Music collection}

Playing back a music collection {Music collection on}

Searching for music; opening the menu {Music search}

Playing back the most frequently played tracks {Top fifty}

Function Command

Opening external devices {External devices}

Function Command

Opening the tone control {Tone}

Function Command

Calling up the radio {Radio}

Calling up an FM station {F M}

Opening manual search {Manual}

Selecting the frequency range {Select frequency}

Calling up a station {Select station} e.g. W-PLJ

Function Command

Calling up an AM station {A M}

Opening manual search {Manual}

Function Command

Calling up the satellite radio {Satellite radio}

Switching on the satellite radio {Satellite radio on}

Selecting a satellite radio channel {Select satellite radio} e.g. channel 2

R e

fe re

n ce

253

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Presets

Telephone

Navigation

General information

Function Command

Opening the stored stations {Presets}

Choosing a stored station {Select preset}

Selecting a stored station {Preset } e.g. stored station 2

Function Command

Opening the Telephone menu {Telephone}

Displaying the phone book {Phonebook}

Redialing {Redial}

Displaying accepted calls {Received calls}

Dialing a phone number {Dial number}

Displaying the list of messages {Messages}

Displaying Bluetooth devices {Bluetooth}

Function Command

Navigation menu {Navigation}

Opening destination entry {Enter address}

Entering an address {Enter address}

Opening destination guidance {Guidance}

Starting destination guidance {Start guidance}

Ending destination guidance {Stop guidance}

Opening the home address {Home address}

Opening the route criteria {Route preference}

Opening the route {Route information}

Switching on the voice instructions {Switch on voice instructions}

Repeating a voice instruction {Repeat voice instructions}

Switching off the voice instructions {Switch off voice instructions}

Displaying the address book {Address book}

S h

o rt

c o

m m

an d

s fo

r t h

e vo

ic e

ac ti

va ti

o n

s ys

te m

254

Map

Split screen* settings

Destination guidance with intermediate destinations

Displaying the last destinations {Last destinations}

Opening the traffic bulletins {Traffic Info}

Special destinations {Points of interest}

Function Command

Function Command

Displaying the map {Map}

Map facing north {Map facing north}

Map in the direction of travel {Map in direction of travel}

Perspective map {Map perspective view}

Automatic map scaling* {Map with automatic scaling}

Changing the scale {Map scale}

Function Command

Split screen {Switch on splitscreen}

Switching off the split screen {Turn off split screen}

Adapting the split screen {Split screen content}

Split screen, current position {Split screen current position}

Split screen, map facing north {Split screen map facing north}

Split screen, direction of travel {Split screen map in direction of travel}

Split screen, perspective {Split screen perspective}

Expanded intersection zoom on the split screen {Splitscreen Exit ramp view}

Split screen scale ... meters* {Split screen scale meters} e.g. split screen scale of 100 meters

Split screen scale ... kilometers* {Split screen scale kilometers} e.g. split screen scale of 5 kilometers

Split screen, highlighting traffic bulletins {Split screen, Traffic conditions}

Split screen, computer {Split screen on board info}

Split screen, trip computer {Splitscreen trip computer}

Automatically scaling the split screen {Split screen automatic scaling}

Function Command

Entering a new destination {Enter address}

Trip list {Stored trips}

R e

fe re

n ce

255

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Contacts

BMW Assist

Vehicle information

Function Command

Opening the contacts {Contacts}

My contacts {My contacts}

New contact {New contact}

Function Command

Opening BMW Assist* {B M W Assist}

Opening BMW Search* {B M W Search}

Function Command

Opening the computer {Onboard info}

Opening the trip computer {Trip computer}

Opening the vehicle information {Vehicle info}

Opening the vehicle status {Vehicle status}

S h

o rt

c o

m m

an d

s fo

r t h

e vo

ic e

ac ti

va ti

o n

s ys

te m

256

Settings

Vehicle

Equipment

Function Command

Opening the main menu {Main menu}

Opening the settings {Settings}

Opening the options {Options}

Settings on the Control Display {Control display}

Opening the time and date settings {Time and date}

Opening the language and unit settings {Language and units}

Opening the speed limit settings {Speed}

Opening the light settings {Lighting}

Opening the door lock settings {Door locks}

Function Command

Opening the air conditioning settings {Climate}

R e

fe re

n ce

257

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

258

Everything from A to Z

Index

A ABS Antilock Brake

System 89 ACC, refer to Active cruise

control 68 Acceleration assistant, refer to

Launch Control 64 Accident, refer to Sending an

Emergency Request 238 Activated-charcoal filter for

automatic climate control 109

Active Cruise Control indicator lamp 71 malfunction 72 selecting distance 70 sensor 72 Active cruise control 68 Active steering 96 Adaptive brake light Brake Force Display 97 Adaptive light control 102 Additives coolant 226 Address, entering 135, 141 Address for navigation entering 135 Adjusting temperature inside

the car, refer to Automatic climate control 107

Adjusting the thigh support 43 Airbags 98 indicator/warning lamp 99 sitting safely 42 Air conditioning mode automatic climate

control 107 ventilation 109 Air distribution automatic 107 Airing, refer to Ventilation 109

Air pressure, refer to Tire inflation pressure 208

Air recirculation, refer to Recirculated-air mode 108

Air supply automatic climate

control 107 ventilation 109 Air vents 106 Air volume 108 AKI, refer to Fuel

specifications 207 Alarm system 32 avoiding unintentional

alarms 33 interior motion sensor 33 switching off an alarm 32 tilt alarm sensor 33 Albums of music

collection 174 ALL program 108 All-season tires, refer to

Winter tires 221 All-wheel drive, refer to

xDrive 90 AM, waveband 157 Ambient air, refer to

Recirculated-air mode 108 Antenna for mobile phone 184 Antifreeze coolant 226 washer fluid 66 Antilock Brake System

ABS 89 Anti-theft alarm system, refer

to Alarm system 32 Anti-theft system 27 Approved axle loads, refer to

Weights 249 Approved gross vehicle

weight, refer to Weights 249 Armrest, refer to Center

armrest 115

Arrival time, refer to Computer 77

Ashtray 117 Assist systems, refer to

Driving stability control 89 AUC Automatic recirculated-

air control 108 Audible instructions, refer to

Spoken instructions 146 Audio 154 controls 154 switching on/off 154 tone control 154 volume 154 Audio device, external 115 Automatic air distribution 107 air volume 107 cruise control 66, 68 headlamp control 101 Automatic car washes 229 Automatic climate control 106 Automatic curb monitor 50 Automatic high beams and

low beams, refer to High- beam assistant 103

Automatic recirculated-air control AUC 108

Automatic Service Request 202

Automatic transmission with Steptronic 58

interlock 58 overriding selector lever

lock 59 shiftlock, refer to Changing

selector lever position 58 sport program 59 towing 241 tow-starting 241 AUTO program for automatic

climate control 107

R e

fe re

n ce

259

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

AUX-IN port 115 AUX-IN port 177 Available services 202 Average fuel consumption 77 setting the units 80 Average speed 77 Avoid highways in

navigation 144 Avoiding unintentional

alarms 33 Axle loads, refer to

Weights 249

B Backrest contour, refer to

Lumbar support 44 Backrests, refer to Seat

adjustment 43 Backrest width adjustment 44 Back seats refer to Rear seats 46 Bag holder 119 Band-aids, refer to First aid

pouch 239 Bar, refer to Towing

methods 242 Base plate for telephone or

mobile phone refer to Snap-in adapter 195 refer to Snap-in adapter in

the center armrest storage compartment 115

Bass, tone setting 154 Battery 237 charging 237 disposal 35, 237 jump-starting 239 remote control 26 replacing 237 temporary power failure 237 Battery for mobile phone 195 Battery renewal remote control 35 remote control for vehicle 35 Being towed 241 Belt hand-over 49 pinch protection system 50

Belts, refer to Safety belts 49 Belt tensioner, refer to Safety

belts 49 Beverage holders, refer to

Cupholders 116 Black ice, refer to Outside

temperature warning 75 Blinds, refer to Roller sun

blinds 114 Blower, refer to Air

volume 108 Bluetooth, activating/

deactivating 187 BMW car shampoo 232 BMW Assist 198 BMW Assist,

activating 200, 202 BMW Homepage 4 BMW Maintenance

System 227 BMW Search 200 BMW webpage 4 Bottle holders, refer to

Cupholders 116 Brake Assist, refer to Dynamic

Brake Control DBC 89 Brake fluid, refer to Service

requirements 80 Brake Force Display 97 Brake lamps Brake Force Display 97 Brake pads 126 breaking in 126 Brake rotors 128 brakes 126 breaking in 126 Brakes ABS 89 BMW Maintenance

System 227 Brake Force Display 97 breaking in 126 parking brake 57 service requirements 80 Brakes, refer to Braking

safely 128

Brake system 126 BMW Maintenance

System 227 breaking in 126 disc brakes 128 Breakdown services, refer to

Roadside Assistance 238 Breaking in the clutch 126 Breaking in the differential,

refer to Engine and differential 126

Break-in period 126 Brightness of the Control

Display 87 Bulb changing, refer to Lamps

and bulbs 233 Button for starting the engine,

refer to Start/stop button 55 Buttons on the steering

wheel 11

C California Proposition 65

warning 6 Call accepting 188 ending 188 rejecting 188 Calling, refer to Phone

numbers, dialing 188 Calling, refer to Telephone

owner's manual Can holders, refer to

Cupholders 116 Capacities 250 Capacity of the cargo area 249 Car battery, refer to Vehicle

battery 237 Car care, refer to Care 229

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

260

Care 229 automatic car washes 229 care products 229 carpets 232 CD/DVD drives 232 chrome parts 231 displays 232 exterior 229 fine wood parts 232 headlamps 230 high-pressure washer 230 interior 231 leather 231 light-alloy wheels 231 paintwork 230 plastic parts 232 retractable hardtop 230 rubber seals 231 safety belts 232 sensors and cameras 232 upholstery and cloth

trim 231 washing the car

manually 230 windows 230 Cargo, securing 130 Cargo area capacity 249 Comfort Access 34 folding up the floor

panel 120 lamp, refer to Interior

lamps 105 opening from inside 31 opening from outside 31 Cargo loading 129 securing cargo 130 stowing cargo 130 vehicle 129 Car jack jacking points 236 Car key, refer to Integrated

key/remote control 26 Car phone installation location, refer to

Center armrest 115 refer to separate Owner's

Manual

Car phone, refer to Telephone 184

Car radio, refer to Radio 157 Car shampoo 232 Catalytic converter, refer to

Hot exhaust system 127 CD, audio playback 165 CD changer 165, 169 controls 154 fast forward/reverse 167 filling or emptying the

magazine 170 random play sequence 166 selecting a track 165 switching on/off 154 tone control 154 volume 154 CD player 165 controls 154 fast forward/reverse 167 random play sequence 166 selecting a track 165 switching on/off 154 tone control 154 volume 154 Center armrest 115 Center brake lamp replacing bulb 235 Center console, refer to

Around the center console 14

Central locking from inside 30 from outside 27 Central locking system 27 Comfort Access 33 hotel function 31 setting unlocking

characteristics 28 Changes, technical, refer to

For your own safety 5 Changing bulbs, refer to

Lamps and bulbs 233 Changing gears 62 Changing the language on the

Control Display 87 Changing the measurement

units on the Control Display 80

Changing wheels 236 Chassis number, refer to

Engine compartment 223 Check Control 84 Child restraint fixing system

LATCH 53 Child restraint systems 52 Child seats, refer to

Transporting children safely 52

Chrome parts 232 Chrome polish 232 Cigarette lighter, refer to

Lighter 117 Cleaning headlamps 66 washer fluid 66 Cleaning your BMW, refer to

Care 229 Climate control automatic air

distribution 107 Clock 75 12h/24h mode 83 setting the time and date 83 setting time 83 Closing from inside 30 from outside 27 Clothes hooks 116 Cockpit 10 Cold start, refer to Starting the

engine 56 Comfort Access 33 replacing the battery 35 Comfort access, refer to

Comfort Access 33 Comfort area, refer to Around

the center console 14 Compartment for remote

control, refer to Ignition lock 55

Compass 113 Computer 76 displays on Control

Display 77 Computer, refer to iDrive 16 Concierge service 199 Condensation, refer to When

the vehicle is parked 128

R e

fe re

n ce

261

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Condition Based Service CBS 227

Configuring settings, refer to Personal Profile 26

Confirmation signals for locking/unlocking the vehicle 29

Congestion refer to Route, bypassing

sections 145 Connecting vacuum cleaner,

refer to Connecting electrical appliances 118

Consumption, refer to Average fuel consumption 77

Contacts creating 196 Control Center, refer to

iDrive 16 Control Display, refer to

iDrive 16 adjusting brightness 87 switching on/off 19 Controller, refer to iDrive 16 Controls and displays 10 Control unit, refer to iDrive 16 Convenient loading in

Convertible 28 Convenient operation glass roof 28 glass roof with Comfort

Access 34 retractable hardtop 28 windows 28 windows with Comfort

Access 34 Convertible bag holder 119 convenient loading 28 enlarging cargo area 119 folding down rear

backrest 119 retractable hardtop 38 rollover protection

system 100 securing cargo 130 stowing cargo 130

Coolant 226 checking level 226 Coolant temperature 76 Cooling, maximum 107 Cooling fluid, refer to

Coolant 226 Cooling system, refer to

Coolant 226 Copyright 2 Corner-illuminating lamps replacing bulbs 234 Corner-illuminating lamps,

refer to Adaptive light control 102

Cornering lamps, refer to Adaptive light control 102

Correct tires 220 Country codes DVD 167 Courtesy lamps, refer to

Interior lamps 105 Criteria for route 144 Cross-hairs in navigation 140 Cruise control 66 active 68 malfunction 68 Cruise control, refer to Active

cruise control 68 Cruising range 77 Cupholders 116 Curb weight, refer to

Weights 249 Current playback external devices 180 of music collection 174 Customer Relations 201

D Dashboard, refer to

Cockpit 10 Dashboard, refer to

instrument cluster 12 Dashboard lighting, refer to

Instrument lighting 105 Data, technical 246 capacities 250 dimensions 247 engine 246 weights 249

Data memory 228 Data transfer 202 Date date format 84 setting 84 Daytime running lights 102 replacing bulbs 234 DBC Dynamic Brake

Control 89 Deactivating front passenger

airbags 98 Deadlocking, refer to

Locking 28 Defect door lock 30 fuel filler flap 206 glass roof 38 Destination, entering by town/

city name 135 Destination address entering 135, 141 Destination entry via BMW

Assist 140 Destination for navigation entering by voice 141 entering via map 140 entry 135 home address 138 manual entry 135 Destination guidance 144 bypassing a route

section 145 changing specified

route 144 continuing 144 starting 144 voice instructions 146 volume of voice

instructions 146 Digital clock 75 Digital compass 113 Digital radio, refer to HD

Radio 158 Dimensions 247 Directional indicators, refer to

Turn signals 64 Direction instructions, refer to

Voice instructions 146

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

262

Directory for navigation, refer to Address book 137

Displacement, refer to Engine data 246

Display, refer to iDrive controls 16

Display lighting, refer to Instrument lighting 105

Displays on the Control Display 16 Displays, refer to Instrument

cluster 12 Displays and controls 10 Disposal coolant 226 remote control battery 35 vehicle battery 237 Distance remaining to service,

refer to Service requirements 80

Distance warning, refer to Park Distance Control PDC 88

Door key, refer to Remote control with integrated key 26

Door lock 29 Doors, emergency

operation 30 DOT Quality Grades 218 Draft-free ventilation 109 Drinks holders, refer to

Cupholders 116 Drive mode 61 Drive-off assistance, refer to

Dynamic Stability Control DSC 89

Drive-off assistant 92 Driving dynamics control 62 Driving lamps, refer to Parking

lamps/low beams 101 Driving notes 126 Driving off on hills, refer to

Drive-off assistant 92 Driving stability control

systems 89 Driving through water 128 Driving tips, refer to Driving

notes 126

Dry air, refer to Cooling function 108

DSC Dynamic Stability Control 89

DTC Dynamic Traction Control 90

indicator/warning lamp 90 DVD country codes 167 settings 168 video playback 167 DVD menu 168 DVD player, refer to CD

player 165 DVD video 167 Dynamic Brake Control

DBC 89 Dynamic destination

guidance 145 Dynamic Stability Control

DSC 89 indicator/warning lamp 90 Dynamic Traction Control

DTC indicator/warning lamp 90

E EBV Electronic brake-force

distribution 89 Eject button, refer to Buttons

on the CD/DVD player 154 Electrical defect 7-gear Sports automatic

transmission with double clutch 63

Electrical malfunction door lock 30 driver's door 30 fuel filler flap 206 glass roof 38 Electric seat adjustment 44 Electric steering wheel lock with Comfort Access 34 Electronic brake-force

distribution EBV 89 Electronic oil level check 223

Electronic Stability Program ESP, refer to Dynamic Stability Control DSC 89

Emergency actuation, automatic transmission, refer to Overriding selector lever lock 59

Emergency operation fuel filler flap, manual

release 206 Emergency operation, refer to

Closing manually glass roof 38 Emergency operation, refer to

Manual operation door lock 30 Emergency release trunk lid from inside 32 Emergency Request 238 Emergency services, refer to

Roadside Assistance 238 Energy, saving saving fuel 126 Engine breaking in 126 data 246 overheated, refer to Coolant

temperature 76 speed 246 starting 56 starting, Comfort Access 33 switching off 56 Engine compartment 223 Engine coolant, refer to

Coolant 226 Engine oil adding 225 alternative oil types 225 BMW Maintenance

System 227 capacity 250 checking level 223 intervals between changes,

refer to Service requirements 80

Engine output, refer to Engine data 246

R e

fe re

n ce

263

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Engine speed, refer to Engine data 246

Engine starting, refer to Starting the engine 56

Entering special destinations by name 140

Entering the postal code for navigation 136

Entry lamps, refer to Interior lamps 105

Entry map for destination 140 Equalizer, tone setting 155 Error messages, refer to

Check Control 84 ESP Electronic Stability

Program, refer to Dynamic Stability Control DSC 89

Exhaust system, refer to Hot exhaust system 127

Extended connectivity of the music player in the mobile phone 178

Exterior mirrors 50 adjusting 50 automatic dimming

feature 51 automatic heating 50 folding in and out 50 External audio device 115 External devices random sequence 180 Eyes for tow-starting and towing

away 241 for tying down loads 130

F Failure messages, refer to

Check Control 84 Failure of an electrical

consumer 237 False alarm avoiding unintentional

alarm 33 switching off an alarm 32

Fastening safety belts, refer to Safety belts 49

Fastest route for navigation 144

Fast forward CD changer 167 CD player 167 Filter refer to Microfilter/activated-

charcoal filter for automatic climate control 109

First aid pouch 239 Fixture for remote control,

refer to Ignition lock 55 Flash when locking/

unlocking 29 Flat tire run-flat tires 220 Tire Pressure Monitor

TPM 94 Flat Tire Monitor FTM 92 indicating a flat tire 93 indicator/warning lamp 93 initializing the system 93 snow chains 92, 221 system limits 92 Flat tires, refer to Tire

condition 219 Fluid reservoir, refer to

Washer fluid reservoir 66 FM, waveband 157 Fog lamps 104 indicator lamp 13, 104 Folding up the floor panel 120 Footbrake, refer to Braking

safely 128 Footwell lamps, refer to

Interior lamps 105 For your own safety 5 Four-wheel drive, refer to

xDrive 90 Free memory capacity, music

collection 175 Front airbags 98 FTM, refer to Flat Tire

Monitor 92

Fuel 207 average consumption 77 gauge 76 high-quality brands 207 quality 207 specifications 207 tank contents, refer to

Capacities 250 Fuel clock, refer to Fuel

gauge 76 Fuel consumption indicator average fuel

consumption 77 Fuel display, refer to Fuel

gauge 76 Fuel filler flap 206 releasing in the event of

electrical malfunction 206 Fuses 237

G Garage door opener, refer to

Integrated universal remote control 111

Gasoline refer to Average

consumption 77 Gasoline, refer to Required

fuel 207 Gasoline display, refer to Fuel

gauge 76 Gas station

recommendations 146 Gear indicator, automatic

transmission with Steptronic 58

Gear indicator, refer to Displays in the instrument cluster 60

Gearshift lever 60 automatic transmission with

Steptronic 58 manual transmission 57 Gearshifts automatic transmission with

Steptronic 58 manual transmission 57 General driving notes 127

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

264

Glass roof, electric 37 closing after electrical

malfunction 38 convenient operation 28, 30 initializing 38 opening, closing 37 operation with Comfort

Access 34 pinch protection system 37 power failure 38 raising 37 remote control 28 Glove compartment 114 GPS navigation, refer to

Navigation system 134 Grills 106 Gross vehicle weight, refer to

Weights 249

H Handbrake, refer to Parking

brake 57 Hands-free system 14 Hazard warning flashers 14 HDC Hill Descent Control 91 HD Radio 158 Head airbags 98 Headlamp control,

automatic 101 Headlamp flasher 64 indicator lamp 11, 13 Head restraints 45 rear, removing 46 sitting safely 42 Heated mirrors 50 rear window 108 seats 47 steering wheel 51 Heating mirrors 50 rear window 108 seats 47 steering wheel 51 Heating and ventilation, refer

to Climate 106

Heavy loads, refer to Stowing cargo 130

Height, refer to Dimensions 247

Height adjustment seats 43 steering wheel 51 High-beam assistant 103 High beams 103 headlamp flasher 103 indicator lamp 13 High beams and low beams,

automatic, refer to High- beam assistant 103

High-pressure washer 229, 230

High water, refer to Driving through water 128

Highways, refer to Route criteria 144

Hill Descent Control HDC 91 Hills 128 Holders for cups 116 Homepage BMW 4 Hood 222 Hooks for shopping bags 120 Horn 10, 11 Hotel function, refer to

Locking or unlocking separately 31

Hot exhaust system 127 Hydraulic brake assist, refer to

Dynamic Brake Control 89 Hydroplaning 127

I IBOC, refer to HD Radio 158 Ice warning, refer to Outside

temperature warning 75 Identification marks run-flat tires 220 tire coding 218

iDrive 16 adjusting brightness 87 changing date and time 83 changing language 87 changing settings 87 changing units of measure

and display format 80 controls 16 menu guidance 17 operating principle 16 overview 16 start menu 17 status information 19 iDrive operating principle 16 Ignition 55 switched off 56 switched on 55 Ignition key, refer to Remote

control with integrated key 26

Ignition key position 1, refer to Radio readiness 55

Ignition key position 2, refer to Ignition on 55

Ignition lock 55 Imprint 2 Indicator and warning

lamps 13 Tire Pressure Monitor

TPM 95 Inflation pressure, refer to Tire

inflation pressure 208 Inflation pressure monitoring,

refer to Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 94

Initializing after power failure 237 compass, refer to

Calibrating 114 Flat Tire Monitor FTM 93 glass roof 38 radio, refer to Station,

storing 157 refer to Setting the time and

date 83 Installation location telephone 115

R e

fe re

n ce

265

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Instructions for navigation system, refer to Voice instructions 146

Instrument cluster 12 Instrument combination, refer

to Instrument cluster 12 Instrument lighting 105 Instrument panel, refer to

Cockpit 10 Integrated key 26 Integrated universal remote

control 111 Interactive map 141 Interior lamps 105 remote control 28 Interior motion sensor 33 Interior rearview mirror 51 automatic dimming

feature 51 compass 113 Interlock, refer to Disengaging

the remote control 58 Intermittent mode of the

wipers 65 Intersection, entering,

navigation 136 iPod, connecting, refer to

AUX-IN port 177 iPod, connecting, refer to USB

audio interface 178

J Jacking points 236 Joystick, refer to iDrive 16 Jumpering, refer to Jump-

starting 239 Jump-starting 239

K Key, refer to Integrated key/

remote control 26 Keyless go, refer to Comfort

Access 33 Keyless opening and closing,

refer to Comfort Access 33 Key Memory, refer to Personal

Profile 26

Kickdown 58 automatic transmission with

Steptronic 58 Knock control 207

L Lamps automatic headlamp

control 101 parking lamps/low

beams 101 Lamps and bulbs, replacing

bulbs 233 Lap-and-shoulder belt, refer

to Safety belts 49 Lashing eyes, refer to

Securing cargo 130 Last destinations 138 LATCH child restraint fixing

system 53 Launch Control 64 Leather care 231 LED Light-emitting

diodes 233 Length, refer to

Dimensions 247 License plate lamp, replacing

bulb 235 Light high-beam assistant 103 Light-alloy wheels 231 Light-emitting diodes

LED 233 Lighter 117 connecting electrical

appliances 118 Lighting instruments 105 lamps and bulbs 233 vehicle, refer to Lamps 101 Light switch 101 Limit, refer to Speed limit 86 Load 129 Load securing equipment,

refer to Securing cargo 130 Lock buttons, doors, refer to

Locking 31

Locking adjusting confirmation

signal 29 from inside 31 from outside 28 without remote control, refer

to Comfort Access 33 Locking and unlocking doors confirmation signals 29 from inside 30 from outside 27 Low beam control, refer to

High-beam assistant 103 Low-beam headlamps 101 automatic 101 Lower back support, refer to

Lumbar support 44 Luggage rack, refer to Roof-

mounted luggage rack 131 Lumbar support 44

M M+S tires, refer to Winter

tires 221 Maintenance, refer to Service

Booklet Maintenance system 227 Malfunction automatic transmission with

Steptronic 59 tires 93 Malfunction warnings, refer to

Check Control 84 Manual car wash 230 Manually unlocking parking

lock 63 Manual mode, automatic

transmission with Steptronic 59

Manual operation door lock 30 driver's door 30 fuel filler flap 206 glass roof 38 parking lock 63 parking lock, automatic

transmission 59

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

266

Manual transmission 57 Map for navigation changing scale 147 entering destination 140 Map view 146 Master key, refer to Remote

control with integrated key 26

Maximum cooling 107 Maximum speed with winter tires 221 Measurements, refer to

Dimensions 247 Memory, refer to Seat and

mirror memory 48 MENU button 16 Menus, refer to iDrive 16 Messages 191 Messages from the concierge

service 191 Microfilter BMW Maintenance

System 227 for automatic climate

control 109 Microfilter/activated-charcoal

filter BMW Maintenance

System 227 Microphone telephone 14 voice commands 14 Mirror dimming feature 51 Mirrors 50 automatic curb monitor 50 exterior mirrors 50 heating 50 interior rearview mirror 51 memory, refer to Seat and

mirror memory 48 Mirrors, folding in before

entering a car wash 50

Mobile phone adjusting volume 187 connecting, refer to Mobile

phone, pairing 184 installation location, refer to

Center armrest 115 operation via iDrive 187 pairing 184 refer to separate Owner's

Manual Mobile phone, installation

location, refer to Center armrest 115

Mobile phone, refer to Telephone 184

Mobile phone, refer to the separate Owner's Manual

Modifications, technical, refer to For your own safety 5

Monitor, refer to iDrive controls 16

Monitoring system for tire pressures, refer to Flat Tire Monitor 92

MP3 player, connecting, refer to AUX-IN port 177

MP3 player, connecting, refer to USB audio interface 178

Multi-channel playback 155 Multifunctional steering

wheel, refer to Buttons on the steering wheel 11

Multifunction switch refer to Turn signals/

headlamp flasher 64 refer to Wiper system 65 Multimedia screen, refer to

iDrive 16 Music, managing 175 Music collection 172 backup 176 deleting 176 random sequence 175 restoring 176 Music player, connecting,

refer to AUX-IN port 177

Music player, connecting, refer to USB audio interface 178

Music search 173 My Info 191

N Navigation starting destination

guidance after entering a destination 137

storing current position 137 voice activation 141 Navigation announcements,

refer to Switching voice instructions on/off 146

Navigation data 134 Navigation system 134 address book 137 bypassing a route

section 145 continuing destination

guidance 144 destination entry 135 dynamic destination

guidance 145 entering a destination by

voice 141 entering a destination

manually 135 frequently asked

questions 151 gas station

recommendations 146 planning a trip 142 route list 145 selecting destination via

map 140 selecting route criteria 144 special destinations 139 starting destination

guidance 144 terminating destination

guidance 144 traffic bulletins 148 voice instructions 146 volume adjustment 146

R e

fe re

n ce

267

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Neck support, refer to Head restraints 45

Nets, refer to Storage compartments 116

Neutral 61 New tires 220 Next Service indicator, refer to

Condition Based Service CBS 227

North-facing map 146 Nozzles 106 Number of cylinders, refer to

Engine data 246 Nylon rope, refer to Tow

rope 242

O OBD socket, refer to Socket

for Onboard Diagnosis 228 Octane ratings, refer to Fuel

specifications 207 Odometer 75 Oil, refer to Engine oil 223 Oil consumption 223 Oil level 223 Old batteries, refer to

Disposal 237 Onboard vehicle tool kit 233 Opening and closing Comfort Access 33 from inside 30 from outside 27 using the door lock 29 using the remote control 27 Options, selecting for

navigation 144 Orientation menu, refer to

Start menu 17 Outlets refer to Ventilation 109 Output, refer to Engine

data 246 Outside-air mode automatic climate

control 108

Outside temperature display 75

changing unit of measure 80 in computer 80 Outside temperature

warning 75 Overheated engine, refer to

Coolant temperature 76 Overriding selector lever

lock 59 Overview radio control 154

P Paintwork care 230 Park assistant, refer to Park

Distance Control 88 Park Distance Control PDC 88 Parked car ventilation 110 preselecting switch-on

times 110 switching on and off

directly 110 Parking vehicle 56 Parking aid, refer to Park

Distance Control PDC 88 Parking brake 57 indicator lamp 57 Parking lamps 101 replacing bulbs 234 Parking lamps/low beams 101 Passenger side mirror tilt

function 50 Pathway lighting 102 Personal Profile 26 Phone book 187 Phone numbers dialing 188 Pinch protection system glass roof, electric 37 windows 36 Playing music 173 Polish 232 Pollen refer to Microfilter/activated-

charcoal filter for automatic climate control 109

Power failure 237 Power windows 36 Power windows, refer to

Windows 35 Pressure, tires 208 Pressure monitoring, tires 92 Flat Tire Monitor 92 Pressure monitoring of tires,

refer to Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 94

Programmable buttons on the steering wheel 11

Protection function, refer to Pinch protection system

glass roof, electric 37 windows 36 Providing medical assistance,

refer to First aid pouch 239 Puncture Flat Tire Monitor 92

R Radio controls 154 HD Radio 158 satellite radio 160 selecting waveband 157 storing stations 157 switching on/off 154 tone control 154 volume 154 Radio position, refer to Radio

readiness 55 Radio readiness 55 switched off 56 switched on 55 Radio-remote key, refer to

Remote control with integrated key 26

Rain sensor 65 Random sequence external devices 180 music collection 175 Reading lamps 105 Rear lamps, refer to Tail

lamps 235

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

268

Rear seats adjusting head restraints 46 folding down backrests 118 Rear ventilation 109 Rearview mirror, refer to

Mirrors 50 Rear window defroster 108 Rear window roller blind, refer

to Roller sun blinds 114 Receiving level of mobile

phone, refer to Status information 19

Reception quality 158 radio station 158 Recirculated-air mode 108 Recirculation of air, refer to

Recirculated-air mode 108 Reclining seat, refer to

Backrest 43 Refueling 206 Releasing hood 222 Remaining distance, refer to

Cruising range 77 Remote control 26 battery renewal 35 Comfort Access 33 garage door opener 111 malfunction 29, 35 removing from the ignition

lock 55 service data 227 trunk lid 28 Replacement fuses, refer to

Fuses 237 Replacement remote

control 26 Replacing bulbs, refer to

Lamps and bulbs 233 Replacing tires 220 Replacing tires, refer to New

wheels and tires 220 Reporting safety defects 7 Reserve warning, refer to Fuel

gauge 76

Reset, refer to Resetting tone settings 156

Restraint systems for children 52 refer to Safety belts 49 Retractable hardtop 38 care, refer to Caring for your

vehicle brochure convenient operation 28 opening and closing 39 remote control 28 Reverse CD changer 167 CD player 167 Reverse gear 61 automatic transmission with

Steptronic 58 manual transmission 58 Road map 146 Roadside

Assistance 199, 238 Roadside parking lamps 103 replacing bulbs 234 Roadworthiness test, refer to

Service requirements 80 Roller sun blinds 114 Rollover protection system,

Convertible 100 resetting 100 Roof load capacity 249 Roof-mounted luggage

rack 131 Rope, refer to Tow-starting,

towing away 242 Rotary/pushbutton, refer to

iDrive 16 Route 144, 145 bypassing sections 145 changing 144, 145 changing criteria 144 displaying streets or towns/

cities 145 map view 146 selecting 144 Route instructions, refer to

Destination guidance through voice instructions 146

Route map, refer to Map view 146

Route section, changing 145 Route selection 144 RSC Runflat System

Component, refer to Run- flat tires 220

Runflat System Component RSC, refer to Run-flat tires 220

Run-flat tires 220 continuing driving with a

damaged tire 93 flat tire 93 Flat Tire Monitor 93 Inflation pressure 208 new tires 220 tire replacement 220 winter tires 221 Runflat tyres, refer to Run-flat

tires 220

S Safety-belt height

adjustment 49 Safety belts 49 belt hand-over 49 damage 49 indicator/warning lamp 49 reminder 49 sitting safely 42 Safety systems airbags 98 Antilock Brake System

ABS 89 brake system 89 driving stability control 89 Dynamic Stability Control

DSC 89 rollover protection system,

Convertible 100 safety belts 49 Safety tires, refer to Run-flat

tires 220

R e

fe re

n ce

269

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Satellite radio 160 enabling or unsubscribing

from a channel 160 favorites 162 selecting channel 161 storing channel 161 timeshift 162 Traffic Jump 163 Saving fuel 126 Screen, refer to iDrive

controls 16 Screw thread for tow

fitting 241 SDARS, refer to Satellite

radio 160 Seat adjustment electric 44 mechanical 43 Seat and mirror memory 48 Seat belt reminder, refer to

"Fasten safety belts" reminder 49

Seat heating 47 Seats 43 adjusting electrically 44 adjusting the seats 43 heating 47 memory, refer to Seat and

mirror memory 48 saving a setting, refer to Seat

and mirror memory 48 sitting safely 42 Securing cargo 121, 122 Securing the vehicle from inside 30 from outside 27 Selecting a detour 150 Selecting distance for active

cruise control 70 Selecting new scale for

navigation 147 Selector lever automatic transmission with

Steptronic 58 Selector lever lock, refer to

Changing selector lever positions, shiftlock 58

Selector lever positions 60 automatic transmission with

Steptronic 58 Service, refer to Roadside

Assistance 238 Service car, refer to Roadside

Assistance 238 Service data in the remote

control 227 Service Interval Display, refer

to Condition Based Service CBS 227

Service Request 201 Service requirements 80 Service status 202 Settings changing on the Control

Display 87 clock, 12h/24h format 83 DVD 168 language 87 Settings and information 79 Settings for the map view 147 Setting times, refer to

Preselecting switch-on times 110

Shifting 62 7-gear Sports automatic

transmission with double clutch 61

Shifting gears automatic transmission with

Steptronic 59 manual transmission 57 Shift into a drive position, refer

to selector lever positions 60

Shiftlock automatic transmission,

refer to Changing selector lever positions 58

Shift paddles on the steering wheel 62

Short commands for the voice activation system 251

Short route in navigation, refer to Selecting route 144

Shuffled, refer to Random CD changer 166 CD player 166 Side airbags 98 Side windows, refer to

Windows 35 Signal horn, refer to

Horn 10, 11 Sitting safely 42 with airbags 42 with head restraint 42 with safety belts 42 Ski bag 120 Ski bag for Convertible, refer

to Through-loading opening with integrated transport bag 121

Sliding/tilt sunroof, refer to Glass roof, electric 37

Slot for remote control 55 Smokers' package, refer to

Ashtray 117 Snap-in adapter inserting/removing 195 use 184 Snap-in adapter, refer to

Center armrest storage compartment 115

Socket, Onboard Diagnosis OBD 228

Socket, refer to Connecting electrical appliances 118

SOS, refer to Sending an Emergency Request 238

Sound, adjusting during audio playback, refer to Tone control 154

Sound output for entertainment on/off 154

Spare fuses 237 Special destinations 139 Special destinations,

displaying 140 Speed Run-flat tires 93 with winter tires 221

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

270

Speed limit 86 Speed limit warning, refer to

Speed limit 86 Speedometer 12 Speed reading, refer to

Speedometer 12 Speed Volume 155 Split screen, refer to Control

Display, switching on/off 19 Split screen content, refer to

Display for split screen content, selecting 20

Sport program with 7-gear Sports automatic transmission with double clutch 61

Sports automatic transmission with double clutch 60

driving dynamics control 62 Kick-down 61 Launch Control 64 manually unlocking parking

lock 63 neutral 61 reverse gear 61 Spray nozzles, refer to

Cleaning windshield and headlamps 66

Stability control, refer to Driving stability control systems 89

Start/stop button 55 starting the engine 56 switching off the engine 56 Starting, refer to Starting the

engine 56 Starting assistance, refer to

Jump-starting 239 Starting difficulties jump-starting 239 Starting the engine start/stop button 55 Start menu 17

State/province, for navigation 135

Station, selecting radio 157 Status of this Owner's Manual

at time of printing 5 Steam jet 229, 230 Steering wheel 51 adjustment 51 buttons on steering

wheel 11 heating 51 lock 55 locking with Comfort

Access 34 shift paddles 62 Steering wheel buttons, refer

to Shift paddles 62 Steering with variable ratio,

refer to Active steering 96 Steptronic, refer to Automatic

transmission with Steptronic 58

Storage 232 Storage compartments 116 Storage nets 120 Stored trip, calling up 143 Storing a destination in the

address book 137 Storing music 172 Storing seat positions, refer to

Seat and mirror memory 48 Storing tires 221 Stowage, refer to Storage

compartments 116 Street, entering,

navigation 136 Summer tires, refer to Wheels

and tires 208 Surround 155 SVCD 167 SW, waveband 157 Switches, refer to Cockpit 10 Switching off engine 56

Switching off the engine start/stop button 55 Switching on audio 154 CD changer 154 CD player 154 radio 154 Switching the cooling function

on and off 108 Switch-on times of parked car

ventilation, preselecting 110 Symbols 4 status information 19

T Tachometer 75 Tailgate, refer to Trunk lid 31 Tail lamp replacing bulb 235 Tail lamp, refer to Tail

lamps 235 Tail lamps 235 replacing bulb 235, 236 Tank contents, refer to

Capacities 250 Technical data 246 dimensions 247 Technical modifications, refer

to For your own safety 5 Telephone 184 installation location, refer to

Center armrest 115 refer to separate Owner's

Manual voice commands 192 TeleService 199 TeleService Diagnosis 200 TeleService Help 200 Temperature automatic climate

control 107 changing unit of measure 80 coolant, refer to Coolant

temperature 76

R e

fe re

n ce

271

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Temperature display outside temperature 75 outside temperature

warning 75 setting the units 80 Tempomat, refer to Cruise

control 66 Tensioning straps, refer to

Securing cargo 130 The individual vehicle 5 Third brake lamp, refer to

Center brake lamp 235 Through-loading opening with

integrated transport bag 121

Through-loading system 118 Tilt alarm sensor 33 Tilt function, passenger side

mirror 50 Timer, refer to Preselecting

switch-on times 110 Tire inflation pressure 208 loss 93, 94 Tire pressure monitoring,

refer to Flat Tire Monitor 92 Tire Pressure Monitor

TPM 94 resetting the system 95 system limitations 94 warning lamp 95 Tire puncture, refer to Flat Tire

Monitor 93 Tire Quality Grading 218

Tires age 218, 220 air loss 95 breaking in 126 changing, refer to Changing

wheels 236 condition 219 damage 219 inflation pressure 208 labels 218 minimum tread depth 219 new wheels and tires 220 pressure monitoring, refer to

Flat Tire Monitor 92 pressure monitoring, refer to

Tire Pressure Monitor TPM 94

puncture 93 replacing 220 size 218 storage 221 tread depth 219 wear indicators, refer to

Minimum tread depth 219 wheel/tire combination, refer

to Correct wheels and tires 220

winter tires 221 TMC station, refer to Traffic

bulletins 148 Tone control 154 middle setting 156 Tools, refer to Onboard

vehicle tool kit 233 Top, refer to Retractable

hardtop 38 Top 50 of music

collection 174 Torque, refer to Engine

data 246 Tow bar 242 Tow fitting 241 screw thread 241

Tow fittings for tow-starting and towing away 241

Towing 241 car with automatic

transmission 241 methods 242 with 7-gear Sports

automatic transmission with double clutch 242

Towing and tow-starting 241 Town/city, for navigation 135 Tow rope 242 Tow-starting 241, 243 TPM, refer to Tire Pressure

Monitor 94 Track selecting on CD 165 Traction control, refer to

Dynamic Stability Control DSC 89

Traffic bulletins categories 149 Traffic bulletins, filtering 149 Traffic bulletins for

navigation 148 display in map view 149 during destination

guidance 150 Traffic jam displaying traffic

bulletins 148 Transmission 7-gear Sports automatic

transmission with double clutch 60

automatic transmission with Steptronic 58

idle position 61 Launch Control 64 manually unlocking parking

lock 63 manual transmission 57 overriding selector lever lock

for automatic transmission with Steptronic 59

reverse gear 61

E ve

ry th

in g

fr o

m A

to Z

272

Transmission interlock refer to Changing selector

lever position 58 refer to P Park 58 Transporting children

safely 52 Transport securing devices,

refer to Securing cargo 130 Tread depth, refer to Minimum

tire tread 219 Trip, deleting 143 Trip, storing 143 Trip computer, refer to

Displays on the Control Display 77

Trip-distance counter, refer to Trip odometer 75

Triple turn signal activation 65 Trip odometer 75 Trips, changing 143 Trunk lid 31 Comfort Access 34 emergency release 32 locking or unlocking

separately 31 opening from inside 31 opening from outside 31 remote control 28 Turning circle, refer to

Dimensions 247 Turn signal indicators indicator/warning lamp 12 Turn signals 64 triple turn signal 65 Tying down loads, refer to

Cargo loading 130

U Uniform Tire Quality Grading/

UTQR 218 Units average fuel

consumption 80 Units of measure temperature 80 Universal garage door opener,

refer to Integrated universal remote control 111

Universal mobile phone preparation package, refer to separate Owner's Manual

Unlatching, refer to Unlocking 33

Unlocking from inside 31 from outside 27 setting unlocking

characteristics 28 trunk lid 34 without remote control, refer

to Comfort Access 33 Updating the navigation

data 134 USB audio interface 178

V VCD 167 Vehicle battery 237 breaking in 126 cargo loading 129 Identification Number, refer

to Engine compartment 223 measurements, refer to

Dimensions 247 parking 56 weight 249 Vehicle jack 236 Vehicle storage 232 Ventilation 109 draft-free 109 in the rear 109 Ventilation, refer to

Climate 106 Ventilation while at a

standstill 110 Vents, refer to Ventilation 109 Video menu 167 Video playback 167 Voice, refer to Destination

guidance through voice instructions 146

Voice commands overview 22 short commands 251 telephone 192

Voice instructions from navigation system 146

repeating 146 switching on/off 146 volume 146 Voice phone book 193 Volume 154 audio sources 154 fuel tank, refer to

Capacities 250 mobile phone 187 voice instructions 146 Volume balance, tone

setting 155

W Warning and indicator

lamps 13 Warning messages, refer to

Check Control 84 Warning triangle 239 Washer fluid 66 content of the reservoir 66 Washer fluid reservoir 66 Waste tray, refer to

Ashtray 117 Water on roads, refer to

Driving through water 128 Water penetration 229, 230 Waveband with the radio 157 Wear indicators in tires, refer

to Minimum tread depth 219 Weights 249 Welcome lamps 101 Wheel/tire combination, refer

to Correct wheels and tires 220

Wheelbase, refer to Dimensions 247

Wheels, new 220 Wheels and tires 208 Width, refer to

Dimensions 247 Wind deflector 40

R e

fe re

n ce

273

A t

a g

la n

ce C

o n

tr o

ls D

ri vi

n g

t ip

s C

om m

un ic

at io

ns N

av ig

at io

n E

n te

rt a

in m

e n

t M

o b

il it

y

Windows 35 convenient operation 28 convenient operation with

Comfort Access 34 opening, closing 36 pinch protection system 36 Windows, indicator on Control

Display 16 Windshield cleaning 66 Windshield wash 65 filling capacity, reservoir 250 nozzles 66 reservoir for washer fluid 66 washer fluid 66 Windshield wiper blades,

changing 233 Windshield wipers, refer to

Wiper system 65 Winter tires 221 setting speed limit 86 storage 221 Wiper blade replacement 233 Wiper system 65 Word-matching principle for

navigation 143 Work in the engine

compartment 222 Wrench/screwdriver, refer to

Onboard vehicle tool kit 233

X xDrive 90 Xenon lamps replacing bulb 234

Y Your individual vehicle settings, refer to Personal

Profile 26

01 41

2 60

4 61

9 U

e iD

riv e

*BL2604619008* </

Manualsnet FAQs

If you want to find out how the 3 Series BMW works, you can view and download the BMW 335i Sedan 3 Series 2011 Owner's Manual on the Manualsnet website.

Yes, we have the Owner's Manual for BMW 3 Series as well as other BMW manuals. All you need to do is to use our search bar and find the user manual that you are looking for.

The Owner's Manual should include all the details that are needed to use a BMW 3 Series. Full manuals and user guide PDFs can be downloaded from Manualsnet.com.

The best way to navigate the BMW 335i Sedan 3 Series 2011 Owner's Manual is by checking the Table of Contents at the top of the page where available. This allows you to navigate a manual by jumping to the section you are looking for.

This BMW 335i Sedan 3 Series 2011 Owner's Manual consists of sections like Table of Contents, to name a few. For easier navigation, use the Table of Contents in the upper left corner.

You can download BMW 335i Sedan 3 Series 2011 Owner's Manual free of charge simply by clicking the “download” button in the upper right corner of any manuals page. This feature allows you to download any manual in a couple of seconds and is generally in PDF format. You can also save a manual for later by adding it to your saved documents in the user profile.

To be able to print BMW 335i Sedan 3 Series 2011 Owner's Manual, simply download the document to your computer. Once downloaded, open the PDF file and print the BMW 335i Sedan 3 Series 2011 Owner's Manual as you would any other document. This can usually be achieved by clicking on “File” and then “Print” from the menu bar.